Ricoh MPC3001 Service Manual
Ricoh MPC3001 Service Manual
Ricoh MPC3001 Service Manual
5
Machine Code: D086/D087
Field Service Manual
1 November, 2010
Keep the machine away from flammable liquids, gases, and aerosols. A fire or an explosion might
occur.
The Controller board on this machine contains a lithium battery. The danger of explosion exists if a
battery of this type is incorrectly replaced. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type
recommended by the manufacturer. Discard batteries in accordance with the manufacturer's
instructions and local regulations.
The optional fax and memory expansion units contain lithium batteries, which can explode if replaced
incorrectly. Replace only with the same or an equivalent type recommended by the manufacturer. Do
not recharge or burn the batteries. Used batteries must be handled in accordance with local
regulations.
Laser Safety
The Center for Devices and Radiological Health (CDRH) prohibits the repair of laser-based optical units
in the field. The optical housing unit can only be repaired in a factory or at a location with the requisite
equipment. The laser subsystem is replaceable in the field by a qualified Customer Engineer. The laser
chassis is not repairable in the field. Customer engineers are therefore directed to return all chassis and
laser subsystems to the factory or service depot when replacement of the optical subsystem is required.
Use of controls, or adjustment, or performance of procedures other than those specified in this manual
may result in hazardous radiation exposure.
WARNING: Turn off the main switch before attempting any of the procedures in the Laser Optics
Housing Unit section. Laser beams can seriously damage your eyes.
CAUTION MARKING:
A Caution indicates a potentially hazardous situation. Failure to obey a Caution could result in minor
or moderate injury or damage to the machine or other property.
Obey these guidelines to avoid problems such as misfeeds, damage to originals, loss of valuable
data and to prevent damage to the machine.
This information provides tips and advice about how to best service the machine.
LEF
Trademarks
Microsoft, Windows, and MS-DOS are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United
States and /or other countries.
PostScript is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems, Incorporated.
PCL is a registered trademark of Hewlett-Packard Company.
Ethernet is a registered trademark of Xerox Corporation.
PowerPC is a registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.
Other product names used herein are for identification purposes only and may be trademarks of their
respective companies. We disclaim any and all rights involved with those marks.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Important Safety Notices...................................................................................................................................1
Prevention of Physical Injury..........................................................................................................................1
Health Safety Conditions...............................................................................................................................1
Observance of Electrical Safety Standards.................................................................................................1
Safety and Ecological Notes for Disposal...................................................................................................2
Laser Safety.....................................................................................................................................................2
Warnings, Cautions, Notes...........................................................................................................................3
Symbols, Abbreviations and Trademarks.........................................................................................................4
Trademarks.....................................................................................................................................................4
1. Product Information
Specifications....................................................................................................................................................17
Product Overview.............................................................................................................................................18
Component Layout.......................................................................................................................................18
Paper Path....................................................................................................................................................20
Drive Layout..................................................................................................................................................21
Machine Configuration....................................................................................................................................23
Guidance for Those Who are Familiar with Predecessor Products..............................................................27
2. Installation
Installation Requirements.................................................................................................................................29
Environment..................................................................................................................................................29
Machine Level..............................................................................................................................................30
Machine Space Requirements....................................................................................................................30
Machine Dimensions...................................................................................................................................31
Power Requirements....................................................................................................................................31
Optional Unit Combinations............................................................................................................................33
Machine Options.........................................................................................................................................33
Controller Options.......................................................................................................................................34
Other Options..............................................................................................................................................35
Fax Options..................................................................................................................................................35
Copier Installation............................................................................................................................................36
Power Sockets for Peripherals....................................................................................................................36
Installation Flow Chart.................................................................................................................................36
Installation Procedure..................................................................................................................................37
5
Installation Procedure................................................................................................................................127
Controller Options.........................................................................................................................................138
Overview....................................................................................................................................................138
SD Card Appli Move................................................................................................................................139
PostScript3 Unit Type C5501..................................................................................................................141
IPDS Unit Type C5501.............................................................................................................................142
File Format Converter Type E...................................................................................................................143
IEEE 1284 Interface Board Type A.........................................................................................................144
IEEE 802.11a/g Interface Unit Type J....................................................................................................145
Bluetooth Interface Unit Type 3245........................................................................................................149
Camera Direct Print Card Type I..............................................................................................................150
Browser Unit Type E..................................................................................................................................151
Gigabit Ethernet Type B............................................................................................................................153
Check All Connections..............................................................................................................................154
3. Preventive Maintenance
Maintenance Tables......................................................................................................................................155
PM Parts Settings............................................................................................................................................156
Before Removing the Old PM Parts.........................................................................................................156
After installing the new PM parts..............................................................................................................157
Preparation before operation check........................................................................................................157
Operation check........................................................................................................................................157
Controller Cover........................................................................................................................................173
Left Cover...................................................................................................................................................173
Rear Cover.................................................................................................................................................174
Right Rear Cover.......................................................................................................................................174
Operation Panel........................................................................................................................................175
Paper Exit Cover........................................................................................................................................176
Inner Tray...................................................................................................................................................176
Ozone Filter and Dust Filter......................................................................................................................177
Scanner Unit...................................................................................................................................................180
Exposure Glass..........................................................................................................................................180
Original Length Sensors............................................................................................................................180
Exposure Lamp..........................................................................................................................................181
Scanner Motor...........................................................................................................................................184
Sensor Board Unit (SBU)..........................................................................................................................184
Exposure Lamp Stabilizer.........................................................................................................................185
SIO (Scanner In/Out) Board...................................................................................................................186
Scanner HP Sensor....................................................................................................................................186
Platen Cover Sensor..................................................................................................................................187
Front Scanner Wire...................................................................................................................................188
Rear Scanner Wire....................................................................................................................................192
Touch Panel Position Adjustment..............................................................................................................193
Laser Optics....................................................................................................................................................195
Caution Decal Location............................................................................................................................195
LD Safety Switch........................................................................................................................................196
Laser Optics Housing Unit........................................................................................................................196
Polygon Mirror Motor and Drive Board..................................................................................................202
Airflow Fans...............................................................................................................................................203
Image Creation..............................................................................................................................................205
PCDU..........................................................................................................................................................205
Drum Unit and Development Unit............................................................................................................206
Toner Collection Bottle..............................................................................................................................211
Second Duct Fan.......................................................................................................................................212
Third Duct Fan............................................................................................................................................213
10
11
5. System Maintenance
Service Program Mode.................................................................................................................................325
SP Tables....................................................................................................................................................325
Enabling and Disabling Service Program Mode....................................................................................325
Types of SP Modes....................................................................................................................................325
Remarks......................................................................................................................................................329
Main SP Tables-1..........................................................................................................................................331
SP1-XXX (Feed).........................................................................................................................................331
Main SP Tables-2..........................................................................................................................................357
SP2-XXX (Drum).........................................................................................................................................357
Main SP Tables-3..........................................................................................................................................427
12
SP3-XXX (Process).....................................................................................................................................427
Main SP Tables-4..........................................................................................................................................457
SP4-XXX (Scanner)....................................................................................................................................457
Main SP Tables-5..........................................................................................................................................475
SP5-XXX (Mode).......................................................................................................................................475
Main SP Tables-6..........................................................................................................................................538
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)...............................................................................................................................538
Main SP Tables-7..........................................................................................................................................548
SP7-XXX (Data Log)..................................................................................................................................548
Main SP Tables-8..........................................................................................................................................582
SP8-xxx: Data Log2..................................................................................................................................582
Main SP Tables-9..........................................................................................................................................627
Input Check Table.....................................................................................................................................627
Output Check Table..................................................................................................................................638
Printer Service Mode.................................................................................................................................648
Scanner SP Mode.....................................................................................................................................656
Firmware Update...........................................................................................................................................658
Type of Firmware.......................................................................................................................................658
Before You Begin.......................................................................................................................................659
Updating Firmware...................................................................................................................................659
Updating the LCDC for the Operation Panel..........................................................................................661
Update Procedure for App2Me Provider...............................................................................................662
Browser Unit Update Procedure..............................................................................................................664
Handling Firmware Update Errors...........................................................................................................665
Installing Another Language.........................................................................................................................667
Reboot/System Setting Reset.......................................................................................................................670
Software Reset...........................................................................................................................................670
System Settings and Copy Setting Reset..................................................................................................670
Downloading Stamp Data............................................................................................................................672
NVRAM Data Upload/Download..............................................................................................................673
Uploading Content of NVRAM to an SD card.......................................................................................673
Downloading an SD Card to NVRAM....................................................................................................673
Address Book Upload/Download..............................................................................................................675
13
Information List...........................................................................................................................................675
Download..................................................................................................................................................675
Upload.......................................................................................................................................................676
Using the Debug Log.....................................................................................................................................677
Overview....................................................................................................................................................677
Switching ON and Setting UP Save Debug Log.....................................................................................677
Retrieving the Debug Log from the HDD.................................................................................................681
Recording Errors Manually.......................................................................................................................681
Debug Log Codes.....................................................................................................................................682
Card Save Function.......................................................................................................................................683
Overview....................................................................................................................................................683
Procedure...................................................................................................................................................683
Error Messages..........................................................................................................................................687
6. Troubleshooting
SC Tables.......................................................................................................................................................689
Service Call Conditions.............................................................................................................................689
SC1xx: Scanning.......................................................................................................................................692
SC 2xx: Exposure......................................................................................................................................696
SC3xx: Image Processing 1..................................................................................................................701
SC3xx: Image Processing 2..................................................................................................................702
SC4xx: Image Processing - 3...................................................................................................................705
SC5xx: Paper Feed and Fusing................................................................................................................709
SC6xx: Device Communication...............................................................................................................727
SC7xx: Peripherals....................................................................................................................................736
SC8xx: Overall System.............................................................................................................................748
SC9xx: Miscellaneous..............................................................................................................................759
Process Control Error Conditions..................................................................................................................765
Developer Initialization Result..................................................................................................................765
Process Control Self-Check Result............................................................................................................766
Line Position Adjustment Result.................................................................................................................768
Troubleshooting Guide..................................................................................................................................770
Image Quality............................................................................................................................................770
Line Position Adjustment............................................................................................................................772
14
7. Energy Saving
Energy Save...................................................................................................................................................803
Energy Saver Modes................................................................................................................................803
Energy Save Effectiveness........................................................................................................................804
Paper Save.....................................................................................................................................................806
Effectiveness of Duplex/Combine Function............................................................................................806
INDEX...........................................................................................................................................................809
15
16
1. Product Information
Specifications
17
1. Product Information
Product Overview
1
18
Component Layout
Product Overview
1. Scanner HP sensor
2. ADF exposure glass
3. 2nd scanner (2nd carriage)
4. Exposure glass
5. 1st scanner (1st carriage)
6. Scanner lamp
7. Original width sensor
8. Original length sensor
9. Scanner motor
10. Lens block
11. Sensor board unit (SBU)
12. Decurler roller
13. Duplex unit
14. Fusing unit
19. Tray 1
20. Toner collection bottle
21. Laser optics housing unit
22. PCDU (4 colors)
23. Image transfer belt cleaning unit
24. Image transfer belt unit
25. Toner bottle (4 colors)
26. ID sensor
27. IH coil unit
19
1. Product Information
Paper Path
1. Original tray
2. Original exit tray
3. Duplex inverter
4. Duplex feed
5. By-pass tray feed
6. Tray 1 feed
7. Tray 2 feed
8. Tray 3: Optional paper feed unit/LCT
The 1000-sheet finisher and 1000-sheet booklet finisher require the bridge unit and one from the two-tray
paper feed unit or the LCT.
20
Product Overview
Drive Layout
1. Scanner motor:
Turns on/off the drive power to the toner supply unit (K and CMY).
Moves the ITB into contact and away from the color PCUs.
Drives the toner attraction pumps and the toner collection coils
from the PCUs, from the transfer belt unit, and inside the toner
collection bottle. Also rotates the toner bottles.
21
1. Product Information
22
Drives the color drum unit and development unit (K, Y, M, C).
Turns on/off the drive power to the by-pass pick-up, feed and
separation rollers.
Moves the paper transfer roller in contact with the image transfer
belt.
Machine Configuration
Machine Configuration
1
Machine
Code
Call
out
Mainframe
D086/D087
[1]
Platen cover
G329
[2]
ARDF
D541
[3]
500-sheet finisher
D372
[16]
Requires [14]
1000-sheet booklet
finisher
B793
[12]
B807-17
B807-27
B807-30
Item
Remarks
One from the two
Requires [12].
23
1. Product Information
Machine
Code
Call
out
Remarks
B408
[11]
D538-57/6
7
[7]
D537-57
[8]
D387
[9]
Envelope feeder
D547
[5]
Caster table
D446
[10]
D539-57/6
7
[6]
1-bin tray
D536
[4]
Shift tray
D388
[15]
Bridge unit
D386
[14]
Side tray
D542
[13]
Scanner accessibility
option
D423
ADF handle
B862
D547
Optional counter
interface unit
B870
A674
Item
1000-sheet finisher
2000-sheet LCT
Two-tray paper feed unit
1200-sheet LCT
24
Machine Configuration
Item
Machine code
Call out
USB2.0/SD Slot
D422-01
[B]
In USB A (front)
Gigabit Ethernet
D546-23
[G]
IEEE 1284
B679-17
[D]
Wireless LAN
D377-01 (NA)
(IEEE 802.11a/g)
D377-02 (EU/AA)
[E]
Bluetooth
B826-17
[F]
D377-04
[C]
Remark
25
1. Product Information
D546-09 (NA)
PostScript 3
D546-10 (EU)
D546-11 (AA)
Security SD Card (Standard)
PictBridge
D546-21
[A]
D546-05 (NA)
IPDS Unit
D546-06 (EU)
D546-07 (AA)
PDF Direct
Browser Unit
D403-06 (EU)
In SD card slot 2
-
D403-07 (AA)
VM Card (Standard)
26
D023/D025
Security Card
Standard
Optional
VM Card
Standard
Optional
Available
Not available
Fusing method
27
1. Product Information
28
2. Installation
Installation Requirements
Environment
29
2. Installation
The toner bottle must be kept at a temperature of 35C (95F) or less. Be careful not to leave the
toner bottle in a hot place when transporting or storing it.
Machine Level
This machine, which uses high voltage power sources, can generate ozone gas. High ozone density
is harmful to human health. Therefore, the machine must be installed in a well-ventilated room.
30
Installation Requirements
Machine Dimensions
Power Requirements
2. Installation
32
No.
Options
Remarks
Platen cover
ARDF
Envelope feeder*1
1200-sheet LCT
33
2. Installation
10
Caster table
11
1000-sheet finisher
12
13
Side tray
14
Bridge unit
15
Shift tray
16
500-sheet finisher
Requires No.14
*1: The Envelope Feeder EF3000 (D547) cannot be used in the one-tray paper feed unit (D387).
Controller Options
No.
34
Options
Remarks
Bluetooth
IEEE 802.11a/g
IEEE 1284
I/F Slot B
Gigabit Ethernet
I/F Slot C
PostScript 3
PictBridge Option
10
11
SD card slot 2
12
VM Card (Standard)
Other Options
No.
Options
Remarks
USB2.0/SD Slot
Fax Options
No.
Options
Remarks
Requires No.1
Requires No.1.
35
2. Installation
Copier Installation
Make sure that the image transfer belt is in its correct position (away from the PCDUs) before you
move the machine. Otherwise, the image transfer belt and the black PCDU can be damaged.
36
Copier Installation
You need the optional paper tray unit or the LCT if you want to install the finisher (B408 or B793) or 1200sheet LCT (D539).
The punch unit is for the booklet finisher (B793).
Installation Procedure
Remove the tape from the development units before you turn the main switch on. The development
units can be severely damaged if you do not remove the tape.
Put the machine on the paper tray unit or the LCT first if you install an optional paper tray unit or the optional
LCT at the same time. Then install the machine and other options.
37
2. Installation
Keep the shipping retainers after you install the machine. You may need them in the future if you
transport the machine to another location.
38
Copier Installation
39
2. Installation
Paper Trays
1. Pull each paper tray out. Then adjust the side guides and end guide to match the paper size.
To move the side guide, first pull out the tray fully. Then push down the green lock at the rear
inside the tray.
40
Copier Installation
2. Pull out the feeler [A] for the output tray full detection mechanism.
1. Attach the correct emblem [A] and the cover [B] to the front door [C] of the machine, if the emblem
is not attached.
2. Attach the correct paper tray number and size decals to the paper trays [D].
Paper tray number and size decals are also used for the optional paper tray or the optional LCT.
Keep these decals for use with these optional units.
41
2. Installation
3. Turn the main power switch on. The machine automatically starts the initialization procedure. The Start
button LED ( ) turns green when this procedure has finished.
4. Make copies of image samples (text, photo, and text/photo modes).
5. Do the Automatic Color Calibration process (ACC) as follows:
1). Print the ACC test pattern (User tools > Maintenance > ACC > Start).
2). Put the printout on the exposure glass.
3). Put 10 sheets of white paper on top of the test chart.
4). Close the ARDF or the platen cover.
5). Press Start Scanning on the LCD panel. The machine starts the ACC.
6. Check that the sample image has been copied normally.
42
SP No.
SP5-045-001
Function
Specifies if the counting method used in
meter charge mode is based on
developments or prints.
Default
0: Developments
A3/11" x 17"
double
SP5-104-001
counting
Service Tel.
No. Setting
SP5-812-001
through 004
Copier Installation
Prepare and check the following check points before you visit the customer site. For details, ask the
@Remote key person.
Check points before making @Remote settings
1. The setting of SP5816-201 in the mainframe must be "0".
2. Device ID2 (SP5811-003) must be correctly programmed.
6 spaces must be put between the 3-digit prefix and the following 8-digit number (e.g.
xxx______xxxxxxxx).
ID2 (SP5811-003) and the serial number (SP5811-001) must be the same (e.g. ID2:
A01______23456789 = serial No. A0123456789)
3. The following settings must be correctly programmed.
Proxy server IP address (SP5816-063)
Proxy server Port number (SP5816-064)
43
2. Installation
Meaning
Solution/ Workaround
Succeeded
Communication error
Other error
5. Make sure that the screen displays the Location Information with SP5816-205 only when it has been
input at the Center GUI.
6. Click [EXECUTE] to execute the registration with SP5816-206.
7. Check the registration result with SP5816-207.
Value
44
Meaning
Solution/ Workaround
Succeeded
Already registered
Copier Installation
Value
Meaning
Solution/ Workaround
Other error
Operation Error,
Incorrect Setting
Code
Meaning
Solution/ Workaround
Execute registration.
45
2. Installation
Cause
Code
Meaning
2
Operation Error,
Incorrect Setting
-12009
Solution/ Workaround
Check Request No.
Check the mainframe condition.
If the mainframe is in use, try
again later.
-12010
Certification area is not initialized.
46
Copier Installation
VM Card Installation
The App2Me application must be enabled before it can be used. The VM SD card including App2Me is
provided with the main machine.
Do the following procedure if a customer wants to use "App2Me".
1. Turn off the machine if it is in use.
x 1).
x 1).
Enabling App2Me
The following procedure basically should be done by a customer.
1. Press the [User Tools] key on the operation panel.
2. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice.
3. Touch the "App2Me" line under the Startup Setting tab.
4. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on the LCD.
5. Touch the "App2Me" line.
6. Set "Auto Start" to "On".
7. Touch the "Exit" button.
47
2. Installation
48
Description
Qty
Securing bracket
Screw (M4x10)
Knob screw
Installation Procedure
Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause human injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.
The one-tray paper feed unit must be installed on the caster table (D446). Prepare the caster table
first before installing this unit.
The Envelope Feeder EF3000 (D547) cannot be used in this unit. Do not install the Envelope Feeder
EF3000 (D547) in this unit.
49
2. Installation
2
1. Remove all tape on the paper feed unit.
2. Remove the paper tray and remove all tapes and padding.
50
One of the securing brackets is used as a securing tool (the cutout [F] is used in step 6). But the
cutout [G] is for attaching the tray heater. Therefore, attach the securing brackets [E] after
installing the tray heater if you install the tray heater.
9. Load paper into the paper feed unit.
10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
11. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.
51
2. Installation
No.
Description
Caster Table
Stud Screw
Installation Procedure
1. Put the caster table on a flat place.
52
Qty
2. Grasp the handle [A] and grips [B] of the machine, if the copier is to be installed on the caster table.
3. Lift the copier or one-tray paper feed unit [C], and then install it on the caster table [D].
Hold the handle and grips of the machine when you lift and move the machine.
4. Pull out tray 2 of the mainframe or the tray of the one-tray paper feed unit.
5. Secure the machine or one-tray paper feed unit to the caster table (stud screw x 1)
6. Reinstall the tray in the mainframe or one-tray paper feed unit.
7. Adjust the five leveling adjustors of the caster table.
53
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Qty
Securing bracket
Screw (M4x10)
Installation Procedure
Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.
54
55
2. Installation
x 1 each; M4x10).
One of the securing brackets is used as a securing tool (the cutout [F] is used in step 6). But the
cutout [G] is for attaching the tray heater. Therefore, attach the securing brackets [E] after
installing the tray heater if you install the tray heater.
9. Load paper into the paper feed unit.
10. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
11. Check the paper feed unit operation and copy quality.
56
Description
Qty
Envelope feeder
Installation Procedure
This tray can be installed in tray 2 of the copier, or tray 3 or tray 4 of the paper feed unit (D537).
There is no automatic paper size detection in the envelope feeder (D547). Adjust the paper size for
the tray where the envelope feeder is to be installed with User Tools.
1. Remove all tape from the envelope feeder.
57
2. Installation
3. Install the envelope feeder [A] into tray 2 of the main machine.
4. Press the "User/Tools" key on the operation panel.
5. Enter "Small Paper Size Tray" under "General Features".
Initial Settings > General Features > Small Paper Size Tray
6. Select "On" for the tray where the envelope feeder is installed.
7. Turn the main machine off and on.
58
Description
Qty
Front Bracket
Rear Bracket
Stud Screw
Joint Pin
LCT
Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
59
2. Installation
The Paper Tray Unit (D537) or LCT 2000-sheet (D538) must be installed before installing this 1200sheet LCT.
5. Remove the paper path cover [A], connector cover [B] and six hole covers [C].
60
x 2 each).
8. Pull out the front and rear rails [A], and then hang them on each bracket [B].
9. Connect the LCT cable [C] to the main machine.
10. Slide the LCT [D] into the main machine.
11. Make sure that the front and rear sides of the LCT are closely attached to the main machine.
61
2. Installation
x 1 each).
4. Install the side fences in the correct position (A4 LEF/ LT LEF/ B5 LEF).
62
63
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Qty
Securing bracket
Screw (M4x10)
Installation Procedure
Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
You need two or more persons to lift the copier. The copier is highly unstable when lifted by one
person, and may cause injury or property damage.
Do not lift the copier with the paper feed unit installed. The handle and grips may be damaged.
64
2
1. Remove all tapes and retainers in the LCT.
65
2. Installation
x 1 each; M4x10).
One of the securing brackets is used as a securing tool (the cutout [F] is used in step 5). But the
cutout [G] is for attaching the tray heater. Therefore, attach the securing brackets [E] after
installing the tray heater if you install the tray heater.
8. Load paper into the LCT.
9. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
10. Check the LCT operation and copy quality.
66
Description
Qty
ARDF
Stamp Cartridge
Knob Screw
Stud Screw
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
67
2. Installation
4. Mount the ARDF [B] by aligning the screw keyholes [C] in the ARDF support plate over the stud screws.
5. Slide the ARDF toward the front of the machine.
6. Secure the ARDF with the two knob screws [D].
68
8. Peel off the platen sheet [G] and place it on the exposure glass.
9. Align the rear left corner of the platen sheet with the corner [H] on the exposure glass.
10. Close the ARDF.
11. Open the ARDF and check that the platen sheet is correctly attached.
69
2. Installation
12. Attach the decal [I] to the top cover as shown. Choose the language you want.
13. Plug in and turn on the main power switch of the machine, and then check the ARDF operation.
14. Make a full size copy. Check that the registrations (side-to-side and leading edge) and image skew
are correct. If they are not, adjust the registrations and image skew referring to "Copy Adjustments"
in the "Replacements and Adjustments section.
70
Description
Qty
Handle Unit
Holder
Stud Bracket
Securing Bracket
Handle Bracket
Spacer
Bushing: M6
10
Bushing: 6MM
11
Tapping Screw: M3 x 12
12
13
Screw: M3 x 8
14
Tapping Screw: M4 x 8
15
Operation Decal
16
Stud Decal
71
2. Installation
Installation Procedure
Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
72
2. Hold the securing bracket [A] at the location [B], inside the ADF cover.
3. Secure the stud bracket [C] to the outside of the ADF cover at location [D] with two screws ( x 2:
M3x8).
The two screws must go through the ADF cover and the securing bracket [A].
73
2. Installation
4. Make two screw holes [E] in the scanner right cover with an M3x12 tapping screw from the
accessories.
1. Attach the holder [A] to the scanner right cover (Tapping Screw - M3x12: x 2).
At first, secure the screw at the rear side (away from the operation panel) temporarily and then
at the front side temporarily. After that, secure them fully.
2. Install the bushing: 6MM [B] in the inside of the handle unit.
3. Attach the handle unit to the stud bracket on the left side of the ADF.
74
4. In the outside of the handle unit, install the bushing - M6 [C] first, and then the spacer [D].
6. Clean the handle unit with alcohol. Then attach the stud decal [E] at the location that was cleaned.
75
2. Installation
7. Attach the handle bracket [F] at the front right side on the bottom of the ADF unit (Tapping Screw [Self
Binding] x 2: M3x12).
8. Close the ADF unit.
9. Attach the hinge stoppers (left [G] and right [H]) to the left and right hinges (Tapping screw x 2: M4x8
each).
76
10. Clean the front side of the duplex unit with alcohol. Then attach the operation decal [I] at the location
that was cleaned.
77
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Qty
End-fence
Tray
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
If the bridge unit (D386) or side tray (D542) has already been installed in the machine, remove it before
installing 1 bin tray unit (D536). This will make it easier for you to do the following procedure.
1. Remove all tapes.
2. Open the right door of the machine.
78
x 1).
x 1).
x 1,
x 1,
79
2. Installation
2
6. Attach the tray support bar [D] to the tray [E] as shown, and then attach the end-fence [F].
7. Install the tray [G] (with the tray support bar) in the machine (M3 x 16:
x 2).
8. Reinstall the front right cover in the machine, and then close the right door of the machine.
9. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
10. Check the 1 bin tray unit operation.
80
Description
Qty
Connector Cover
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
81
2. Installation
x 1).
82
5. Attach the connector cover [D] to the shift tray unit [E].
6. Install the shift tray unit [E] to the machine.
7. Push down the left edge [F] of the shift tray.
8. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
9. Check the shift tray unit operation.
83
2. Installation
84
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Qty
Screw
Knob screw
Frame Cover
Holder bracket
Installation Procedure
Turn off the main switch of the copier and unplug the power cord before you start the installation
procedure.
If you will install the 1-bin tray (D536) on the machine, install the 1-bin tray first before installing the
side tray (D542). This makes it easier to do the following procedure.
x 1).
x 1).
85
2. Installation
7. Attach the main output tray [A] and sub output tray [B] to the side tray unit.
86
x 1)
87
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Bridge Unit
Frame Cover
Knob screw
Holder bracket
Guide
Installation Procedure
Unplug the copier power cord before starting the following procedure.
88
Qty
1. If you will install the 1-bin tray (D536) in the machine, install the 1-bin tray before you install the
bridge unit (D386). This will make it easier for you to do the following procedure.
2. If you will install a finisher (B408, B804 or B805) in the machine, install the finisher after you install
the bridge unit (D386).
x 1).
x 1).
89
2. Installation
8. Secure the bridge unit with the knob screw [F] and screw [H].
9. Attach the frame cover [I].
10. Reinstall the front right cover in the machine. Then close the right door of the machine.
Open the bridge unit cover [J] when installing the front right cover. Otherwise, the bridge unit
cover is an obstacle for attaching the front right cover.
11. Install the optional finisher (refer to the finisher installation procedure).
90
If you will not install the finisher at this time, install the holder bracket [G]. Otherwise, the customer
will damage the bridge unit if they pull up the bridge unit tray. When you install the finisher, you
will need this bracket during the installation procedure.
12. Pull the extension tray [K] only if the 1000-sheet finisher (B408) is to be installed in the main machine.
13. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
14. Check the bridge unit operation.
91
2. Installation
92
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No
Description
Qty
Unit Holder
Shift Tray
Holder Bracket
Screw: M3 x 8
Screw: M3 x 6
Screw: M4 x 14
Screw: M4 x 20
Support Bracket
Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
Before you install the 500-sheet finisher, the optional bridge unit (D386) must be installed.
93
2. Installation
x 3 - M4 x 14).
x 2 each: M4 x 20)
x 1 each: M3 x 8)
x 1; M3 x 6).
x 2 - M3 x 8).
9. Turn on the main power switch and check the finisher operation.
94
SR790 (B408)
SR790 (B408)
Accessory Check
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Qty
Grounding Plate
Copy Tray
Screw - M4 x 14
Knob Screw - M4 x 10
Screw - M3 x 8
10
Knob Screw - M3 x 8
95
2. Installation
Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
If this finisher will be installed on the D086 or D087 copier, the following options must be installed before
installing this finisher.
- Bridge Unit (D386)
- Paper Feed Unit (D537) or LCT (D538)
1. Unpack the finisher, and then remove the stopper [A] and tapes (
x 1).
SR790 (B408)
The holder bracket [C] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [B]. The holder bracket is
provided with the bridge unit (D386).
x 2 - M3 x 8).
Use the screw removed in step 1 and the screw from the accessory box.
2. Open the front door [F] of the finisher, and then pull the locking lever [G] (1 knob screw - M3 x 8).
3. Align the finisher on the joint brackets, and lock it in place by pushing the locking lever.
4. Secure the locking lever (1 knob screw - M3 x 8).
5. Close the front door.
6. Install the copy tray [H] (1 knob screw - M4 x 10).
7. Connect the finisher cable [I] to the main machine below the right rear handle.
97
2. Installation
2
8. Attach the staple position decal [J] to the ARDF as shown.
9. Turn on the main power switch and check the finisher operation.
98
Description
Qty
Grounding Plate
Cushion
Screw (M3 x 8)
10
99
2. Installation
Installation Procedure
Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
The bridge unit (D386) and optional paper feed unit (D537 or D538) must be installed before installing
this finisher (B793).
100
1. Unpack the finisher and remove all tapes and packing materials from the finisher.
2. Open the front door [A] of the 1000-sheet booklet finisher, and then pull out the jogger unit [B].
3. Remove all tapes and packing materials from the inside of the finisher.
x 2; M3 x 8).
101
2. Installation
x 2, M4 x 14).
7. Attach the front joint bracket [G] and the holder bracket [H] (
x 2; M4 x 14).
The holder bracket [H] must be placed outside the front joint bracket [G]. The holder bracket is
provided with the bridge unit (D386).
102
13. Install the upper output tray [M] (Short knob screw x 1).
14. Install the lower output tray [N].
15. Turn on the main power switch of the machine.
16. Check the 1000-sheet booklet finisher operation.
103
2. Installation
104
Check the quantity and condition of the components against the following list.
No.
Description
Qty
Punch Unit
Hopper
Screw
Step Screw
10
Spring
Installation
Unplug the main machine power cord before starting the following procedure. If the 1000-sheet
booklet finisher has been installed, disconnect it and pull it away from the machine.
105
2. Installation
106
x 2).
x 1).
x 1)
8. Remove the paper guide plate [I] from the rear side (
9. Install the punch unit stay [J] from the front side (
x 4).
x 3).
10. Install the sub-scan registration sensor guide [K] from the top (
x 1).
107
2. Installation
x 1).
12. Install the punch unit [M] along the punch unit stay from the rear side.
13. Make sure to put the punch unit stay pin [N] through the hole [O].
108
16. Install the punch drive motor [S] on the rear frame (
x 1).
x 2).
17. Connect the drive motor harness [T] to the harness from the punch unit (
x 1).
18. Connect the home position sensor harness from the punch unit to the home position sensor [U].
109
2. Installation
19. Install the sub-scan registration sensor unit [V] from the rear side (
20. Route and connect the harnesses as shown (
x 2).
x 2).
x 1, spring x 1).
22. Connect the harness from the sub-scan registration sensor unit to the hopper full sensor [X].
110
x 2).
111
2. Installation
1. Hold the key counter plate nuts [A] on the inside of the key counter bracket [B] and insert the key
counter holder [C].
2. Secure the key counter holder to the bracket (
3. Install the key counter cover [D] (
4. Rear cover (
p.174)
112
x 2).
x 2).
2
6. Connect the harness to the connector [F] inside the machine.
7. Peel off double sided tape on the key counter bracket and attach the key counter to the scanner right
cover [G].
8. Reassemble the machine.
113
2. Installation
1. Rear cover (
2. IOB bracket (
p.174)
p.309 "Controller Box")
3. Install the four stud stays in the location [A] in the controller box.
4. Install the key counter interface board on the four stud stays in the controller box.
5. Connect the harness to CN3 on the key counter interface board.
6. Close the IOB bracket and connect the other terminal to CN215 [B] on the IOB.
114
2
7. Cut off the part [C] of the rear cover.
8. Clamp the harness from the counter device with the clamp [D] and put it as shown by the blue arrow
( x 1).
9. Route the harness from the counter device in the same way as the other harnesses [E] (
x 3).
10. Connect the harness from the counter device to CN4 on the key counter interface board.
11. Reattach the IOB bracket (
115
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Qty
USB2.0/SD Slot
Ground Plate
USB Cable
Screw: M3 x 6 blue
Screw: M3 x 8
Screw: M3 x 6
Bracket
*1: If the PostScript 3 option is used in this machine, this card is not necessary.
Installation Procedure
1. Connect the USB cable [B] to the USB slot [A] in the USB2.0/SD Slot as shown above.
2. Attach the ground plate [C] to the bracket of the USB2.0/SD Slot (
116
x 1: M3x6 blue).
x 8)
x 2).
x 1).
6. Remove the part [A] of the left frame cover with pliers or a similar tool.
7. Reinstall the left frame cover (
x 1).
117
2. Installation
2
9. Make four holes in the scanner left cover with a screwdriver as shown [A].
Smooth the four holes in the scanner left cover as shown [B].
10. Route the USB cable [A] through the gaps in the left scanner cover.
11. Secure the USB2.0/SD Slot [B] with the left scanner cover as shown above (
Use the screw holes [C] as shown above.
118
x 4: M3x8).
12. Attach the bracket [A] with its two hooks [B] as shown above (
x 1: M3x6).
13. Put the USB cable [A] through the cutout [B] of the left frame cover.
14. Attach the scanner left cover [C] to the mainframe, and then connect the USB cable [A] to USB-A
(front side) as shown above.
Make sure that the USB cable is inserted in USB-A (front side).
15. Reinstall the rear cover (
x 8).
If PostScript 3 is already installed, go to step 25. If not, follow the steps from 16 to 24.
119
2. Installation
20. Move HDD Security Applications (HDD Encryption unit and Data Overwrite Security Unit) from the
SD card in slot 2 to the SD card in slot 1 with SP5-873-001 "Move Exec".
21. Enter the Scanner SP mode, and then change the setting of SP1013-001 from 0 to 1.
22. Enter the Printer SP mode, and then change the setting of SP1110-001 from 0 to 1.
23. Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the machine.
24. Remove the SD card in slot 2, and then attach the SD slot cover (
Keep this card in the safe place (
x 1).
26. Attach the decal [A] to the USB2.0/SD Slot as shown above.
121
2. Installation
Check the quantity and condition of the accessories against the following list.
No.
Description
Screw: M3 x 8
Screw: M3 x 14
Screw: M3 x 25*1
Tapping Screw: M3 x 10
Upper Tray
Lower Tray
Tray Bracket
Clamp
122
Qty
Installation Procedure
[C] x 2: M3x10,
[D] x 1: M3x14).
For this model, use the screw holes marked "2" on the table bracket.
x 2: M3x8).
x 1: M3x8).
5. Use the clamps as necessary to clamp the cable of the card read/writer device.
123
2. Installation
The smart card reader must be placed on this card reader table. If not, some antenna or transmitter
in the main machine may be interrupted.
124
Installation Procedure
1. Rear cover (
x 4)
x 3)
125
2. Installation
7. Move the scanner carriage to the right side by rotating the scanner motor [E].
8. Install the heater [F] in the scanner unit (
x 1, hook)
126
Component Check
No.
Description
Qty
Tray heater
On-standby decal
Screw M4 x 10
Installation procedure
1 (-90) or 2 (-91)
Installation Procedure
Unplug the machine power cord before starting the following procedure.
127
2. Installation
x 1).
3. Connect the connector [B] of the heater to the connector of the main machine.
4. Install the heater [C] inside the machine (
5. Reassemble the machine.
128
x 1).
x 8)
2. Pull out the two trays in the optional paper feed unit.
3. Install the tray heater [B] in the optional paper feed unit (
x 1).
129
2. Installation
x 1 each), and then the rear cover [D] of the optional paper
x 1).
130
x 1).
8. Connect the harness [I] to the connector [J] of the tray heater.
9. Route the harness [I] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (
x 4).
10. Connect the harness [I] to the connector [K] of the mainframe.
11. Reassemble the mainframe and optional paper feed unit.
12. Attach the on/standby decal [L] to the right-hand side of the main power switch.
131
2. Installation
2
3. Left tray [A] (
x 2)
4. Remove the right tray [B] while pressing down the stopper [C].
When reinstalling the right tray, set the right tray on the guide rail and carefully push the tray in,
making sure to keep the tray level.
132
x 1).
x 1 each), and the then rear cover [F] of the optional LCT
x 1).
133
2. Installation
x 1).
10. Connect the harness [K] to the connector [L] of the tray heater.
11. Route the harness [K] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (
x 4).
12. Connect the harness [K] to the connector [M] of the mainframe.
13. Reassemble the mainframe and optional LCT.
134
x 1).
x 1 each), and then the rear cover [C] of the optional paper
x 1).
135
2. Installation
x 1).
1. Connect the harness [H] to the connector [I] of the tray heater.
2. Route the harness [H] as shown and clamp it with four clamps (
x 4).
Make sure that the harness [H] is placed below the harness [J].
3. Connect one harness [K] of the two-way harness to the connector [L] of the mainframe.
The harness [K] of the two-way harness, which has two binds, is for the connector of the
mainframe. The harness [M], which has one bind, is for another optional paper feed unit.
4. Clamp the other harness [M] of the two-way harness as shown [N] if you do not install another optional
paper feed unit.
5. Reassemble the mainframe and optional paper tray.
136
2
6. Attach the on/standby decal [O] to the right-hand side of the main power switch.
137
2. Installation
Controller Options
Overview
This machine has I/F card slots for optional I/F connections and SD card slots applications.
After you install an option, check that the machine can recognize it (see "Check All Connections" at the
end of this section).
SD Card Slots
Slot 1 is already occupied by the Security SD Card by factory default, and is also used for optional
applications (e.g.: PostScript 3, PictBridge, IPDS unit, PDF direct, etc).
Slot 2 is used for installing the Browser Unit, VM card or for service only (for example, updating the
firmware).
138
Controller Options
Remove the cover [A] ( x 2), and then keep the SD card in the place [B] after you move the
application program from one card to another card. This is done for the following reasons:
The SD card can be the only proof that the user is licensed to use the application program.
You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a problem in the future.
You cannot move the PostScript or PDF Direct application to another SD card. You have to move the
other application (PictBridge, Security Applications, IPDS unit) to the SD card that stores the PostScript
or PDF Direct application.
Move Exec
The menu "Move Exec" (SP5-873-001) lets you move application programs from the original SD card to
another SD card.
139
2. Installation
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine.
If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.
2. Make sure that a target SD card is in SD Card Slot 1. The application program is moved to this SD
card.
3. Insert the source SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 2.The application program
is copied from this source SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-001 "Move Exec".
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
9. Remove the source SD card from SD Card Slot 2.
10. Turn the main switch on.
11. Check that the application programs run normally.
Undo Exec
"Undo Exec" (SP5-873-002) lets you move back application programs from an SD card in SD Card Slot
1 to the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. You can use this program when, for example, you have
mistakenly copied some programs by using Move Exec (SP5-873-001).
Do not turn ON the write protect switch of the system SD card or application SD card on the machine.
If the write protect switch is ON, a download error (e.g. Error Code 44) occurs during a firmware
upgrade or application merge.
1. Turn the main switch off.
2. Insert the original SD card in SD Card Slot 2. The application program is copied back into this card.
3. Insert the SD card with the application program in SD Card Slot 1.The application program is copied
back from this SD card.
4. Turn the main switch on.
5. Start the SP mode.
6. Select SP5-873-002 "Undo Exec."
7. Follow the messages shown on the operation panel.
8. Turn the main switch off.
140
Controller Options
1. Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (
x 1).
141
2. Installation
4. Attach the "Adobe PostScript 3" decal [A] to the front door.
5. Plug in, and then turn on the machine.
6. Move security applications from the SD card in SD slot 2 to the SD card in SD slot 1 with SP5-873-001.
7. Turn off the machine.
8. Remove the SD card from SD slot 2, and then keep it in a safe place (
x 1).
11. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
142
Controller Options
1. Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (
x 1).
x 1).
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
143
2. Installation
x 2).
2. Install the file format converter [B] into slot B and then fasten it with screws.
3. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
4. Check or set the following SP codes with the values shown below.
SP No.
Title
Setting
SP5-836-001
"1"
SP5-836-002
Panel Setting
"0"
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
144
Controller Options
x 2).
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at one time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g, (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
145
2. Installation
x 2).
2. Install the wireless LAN board [B] (Knob-screw x 2) into the board slot.
3. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).
4. Peel off the double-sided tapes on the Velcro fasteners [A], and then attach them [A] at the front left
and rear left of the machine.
5. Attach "ANT1" (having a black ferrite core) [B] to the front left of the machine.
6. Attach "ANT2" (having a white ferrite core) [C] to the rear right of the machine.
146
Controller Options
x 7).
Make sure that the cables are not slack. Keep them wired tightly along the covers.
You may have to move the machine if the reception is not clear.
Make sure that the machine is not located near an appliance or any type of equipment that generates
strong magnetic fields.
Put the machine as close as possible to the access point.
Installing Various Hardware Combinations
147
2. Installation
148
Controller Options
WEP Key
SP Mode and UP Mode Settings for IEEE 802.11 a/g Wireless LAN
The following SP commands and UP modes can be set for IEEE 802.11 a/g.
SP No.
Name
Function
5840-006
Channel MAX
Sets the maximum range of the channel settings for the country.
5840-007
Channel MIN
Sets the minimum range of the channels settings allowed for your
country.
5840-011
UP mode
Name
Function
SSID
WEP Key
WEP Mode
Used to show the maximum length of the string that can be used
for the WEP Key entry.
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
You can only install one of the following network interfaces at a time: (IEEE 802.11 a/g (Wireless LAN),
IEEE1284, Bluetooth).
149
2. Installation
x 2).
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
150
Controller Options
1. Remove the SD-card slot cover [A] from the SD card slots (
x 1).
x 1).
10. Make sure that the machine can recognize the option (see Check All Connections at the end of this
section).
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
151
2. Installation
x 1).
152
Controller Options
22. Install the key for "Browser Unit" to the place, where you want.
23. Remove the SD card of the browser unit from SD slot 2.
24. Reinstall the VM card in SD slot 2.
25. Attach the slot cover [A] (
x 1).
26. Keep the SD card in the place ( p.139 "SD Card Appli Move") after you install the application
program from the card to HDD. This is because: The SD card can be the only proof that the user is
licensed to use the application program. You may need to check the SD card and its data to solve a
problem in the future.
Unplug the main machine power cord before you do the following procedure.
153
2. Installation
x 3).
x 5).
x 1).
4. Attach the Gigabit Ethernet controller [A] into the slot [B] (
x 2).
154
3. Preventive Maintenance
Maintenance Tables
See "Appendices" for the following information:
Preventive Maintenance Items
Other Yield Parts
155
3. Preventive Maintenance
PM Parts Settings
Before Removing the Old PM Parts
1. Enter the SP mode.
2. Output the SMC logging data with SP5-990-004.
3. Set the following SPs to "1" before you turn the power off. Then, the machine will reset the PM counters
automatically. In the case of developer, the developer initialization will also be done automatically.
4. Exit the SP mode.
Item
SP
Black: 3902-005
Developer
Yellow: 3902-006
Cyan: 3902-007
Magenta: 3902-008
Black: 3902-009
Drum Unit
Yellow: 3902-010
Cyan: 3902-011
Magenta: 3902-012
Heating Roller and Pressure Roller (not necessary Heating roller: 3902-018
for complete fusing units; see below)
Pressure roller: 3902-019
Image Transfer Belt Cleaning Unit
3902-015
PTR Unit
3902-016
3902-017
For the following units, there is a new unit detection mechanism. It is not necessary to reset PM counters.
PCDU
Development unit
Toner Collection Bottle (if full or near-full)
Fusing unit
156
PM Parts Settings
6. Make sure that the unit replacement date is updated with SP7-950.
Operation check
Check if the sample image has been copied normally.
157
3. Preventive Maintenance
158
Always touch a grounded surface to discharge static electricity from your hands before you handle
SD cards, printed circuit boards, or memory boards.
159
Special Tools
Part Number
Description
Q'ty
B645 5010
SD Card
B645 6705
B645 6820
USB Reader/Writer
VSSM9000
G021 9350
C401 9503
A257 9300
5203 9502
A092 9503
A184 9501
B679 5100
B132 9700
Lubricant Powder
The "Loop-back ConnectorParallel" requires the "Plug-IEEE1284 Type A", and the optional
IEEE1284 interface option must also be installed.
160
Image Adjustment
Image Adjustment
Scanning
Check the printing registration/side-to-side adjustment and the blank margin adjustment before you do
the following scanner adjustments.
Use S-2-1 test chart to do the following adjustments.
A: Sub-scan magnification
1. Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the magnification ratio. Adjust with SP4-008 if necessary.
Standard: 1.0%.
161
4
A: Leading Edge Registration
1. Put the test chart on the exposure glass. Then make a copy from one of the feed stations.
2. Check the leading edge and side-to-side registration. Adjust the following SP modes if necessary.
Standard: 0 2mm for the leading edge registration, 0 2.5mm for the side-to-side registration.
SP mode
Leading Edge Registration
SP4-010-001
Side-to-Side Registration
SP4-011-001
ARDF
ARDF side-to-side, leading edge registration and trailing edge
162
Image Adjustment
What It Does
Adjustment Range
SP6-006-001
3.0 mm
SP6-006-003
5.0 mm
SP6-006-005
3.0 mm
SP6-006-006
2.5 mm
SP6-006-007
10.0 mm
163
Registration
Image Area
Leading Edge
Adjusts the leading edge registration for each paper type and process line speed.
Side to Side
Adjusts the side-to-side registration for each paper feed station. Use SP mode (SP1-002) to adjust the sideto-side registration for the optional paper feed unit, LCT, and duplex unit.
Adjustment Standard
Leading edge (sub-scan direction): 5.2 2 mm
Side to side (main-scan direction): 2 1 mm
164
Image Adjustment
Adjustment Procedure
1. Enter SP2-109-003.
2. Print out the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern) with SP2-109-003.
Registration can change slightly as shown on the previous page. Print some pages of the 1-dot
trimming pattern for step 3 and 4. Then average the leading edge and side-to-side registration
values, and adjust each SP mode.
3. Do the leading edge registration adjustment.
1) Check the leading edge registration and adjust it with SP1-001.
2) Select the adjustment conditions (paper type and process line speed).
3) Input the value. Then press the
key.
key.
Adjust the erase margin C and D only if the registration (main scan and sub scan) cannot be adjusted
within the standard values. Do the registration adjustment after adjusting the erase margin C and D,
and then adjust the erase margin A and B.
165
1. Enter SP2-109-003.
2. Print out the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern) with SP2-109-003.
3. Check the erase margin A and B. Adjust them with SP2-103-001 to -015 if necessary.
Leading edge: 0.0 to 9.0 mm (default: 4.2 mm)
Side-to-side: 0.0 to 9.0 mm (default: 2.0 mm)
Trailing edge: 0.0 to 9.0 mm (default: 4.2 mm)
Color Registration
Line Position Adjustment
The automatic line position adjustment usually is done for a specified condition to get the best color prints.
Do the following if color registration shifts:
Do "Auto Color Registration" as follows to do the forced line position adjustment.
1. First do SP2-111-3.
2. Then do SP2-111-1.
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is displayed
at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
You should also do the line position adjustment at these times:
166
Image Adjustment
After you transport or move the machine (you should do the forced line position adjustment if
you install the machine at the user location.) if the machine is pre-installed at the workshop and
moved to the user location,
When you open the drum positioning plate
When you remove or replace the motors, clutches, and/or gears related to the drum/
development/transfer sections
When you remove or replace the image transfer belt, image transfer belt unit or laser optical
housing unit
4
The ACC is usually sufficient to adjust the color balance to get the best print output. You only need
the printer gamma correction to fine-tune to meet user requirements.
Use SP modes if you want to modify the printer gamma curve created with ACC. You can adjust the gamma
data for the following:
Highlight
Middle
Shadow areas
IDmax.
The adjustable range is from 0 to 30 (31 steps).
Copy Mode
- KCMY Color Balance Adjustment The adjustment uses only "Offset" values.
Never change "Option" values (default value is 0).
Highlight (Low ID)
ID max
Level 10 in the C4 chart 10-level scale (affects the entire image density.)
Offset
The higher the number in the range associated with the low ID, middle ID,
high ID, and ID max, the greater the density.
167
- Adjustment Procedure 1. Copy the C-4 chart in the mode that you want to adjust.
2. Enter the SP mode.
3. Select "System SP."
4. Select SP4-918-009.
5. Adjust the offset values until the copy quality conforms to the standard (see the table below).
1. Never change "Option" value (default value is "0").
2. Adjust the density in this order: "ID Max", "Middle", "Shadow", "Highlight".
- Photo Mode, Full Color Item to Adjust
1
168
ID max:
(K, C, M, and Y)
Adjustment Standard
Adjust the offset value so that the
density of level 10 matches that
of level 10 on the C-4 chart.
Image Adjustment
Adjustment Standard
ID max: (K)
Item to Adjust
1
4
4
Adjustment Standard
Adjust the offset value so that the
density of level 10 matches that
of level 10 on the C-4 chart.
Adjustment Standard
ID max: (K)
170
Image Adjustment
Text parts of the test pattern cannot be printed clearly after you adjust "shadow" as shown above. At
this time, check if the 5 line/mm pattern at each corner is printed clearly. If it is not, adjust the offset
value of "shadow" again until it is.
Printer Mode
There are six adjustable modes (select these modes with printer SP1-102-001):
1200 x 1200 photo mode
1200 x 1200 text mode
2400 x 600 photo mode
SP1-104-1
SP1-104-21
SP1-104-41
SP1-104-61
SP1-104-2
SP1-104-22
SP1-104-42
SP1-104-62
SP1-104-3
SP1-104-23
SP1-104-43
SP1-104-63
SP1-104-4
SP1-104-24
SP1-104-44
SP1-104-64
Exterior Covers
Front Door
2. Remove the two pins [B], and then remove the front cover.
172
Exterior Covers
Controller Cover
x 3)
Left Cover
1. Controller cover (
p.173)
x 6)
173
Rear Cover
x 8)
p.174)
174
Exterior Covers
x 3)
Operation Panel
175
x 2)
x 1)
x 1)
x 3)
x 2,
x 1,
x 1)
x 1)
Inner Tray
1. Image transfer belt unit (
176
p.221)
Exterior Covers
p.176)
p.173)
x 2)
x 2)
x 1)
177
178
Exterior Covers
179
Scanner Unit
Exposure Glass
x 4)
x 3)
180
p.180)
Scanner Unit
x 1,
x1,
x 2)
Exposure Lamp
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
2. Operation panel (
3. Exposure glass (
p.175)
p.180)
181
x 1)
x 2)
x 2)
182
x 4,
x All)
Scanner Unit
4
10. Release the clamp [A] (
x 1).
Reassembling
Run the cable so there is no slack. Slide the clamp [A] to adjust the cable slack.
183
Scanner Motor
4
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
x 2,
x 2, spring x 1)
x 1,)
1. Exposure glass (
p.180)
184
x 9)
Scanner Unit
x 4, Grand screw x 1,
x 2,
x 2)
When reassembling
Adjust the following SP modes after you replace the sensor board unit:
SP4008 (Sub Scan Mag): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4010 (Sub Mag Reg.): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4011 (Main Scan Reg): See "Image Adjustment: Scanning".
SP4688 (DF: Density Adjustment): Use this to adjust the density level if the ID of outputs made in the
DF and Platen mode is different.
p.174)
185
4
2. Exposure lamp stabilizer [A] (
x 2,
x 2)
2. SIO [A] (
p.174)
x 4,
x All)
Scanner HP Sensor
1. Scanner left cover and scanner rear cover (
2. Exposure glass (
186
p.180)
Scanner Unit
x 1, three snaps)
187
x 1,
p.180)
188
x 5)
x 3)
x 1)
Scanner Unit
4
4. Front scanner wire clamp [A]
5. Front scanner wire bracket [B] (
x 1)
x 1)
1. Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2. Pass the right end (with the ball) [B] through the square hole. Pass the left end (with the ring) [C] through
the notch.
189
3. Wind the right end counterclockwise (shown from the machines front) five times. Wind the left end
clockwise twice.
The two red marks [D] come together when you have done this. Stick the wire to the pulley with
tape. This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.
190
Scanner Unit
4
6. Hook the right end onto the front scanner wire bracket [A]. The end should go via the front track of
the right pulley [B] and the front track of the movable pulley [C].
Do not attach the scanner wire bracket with the screw at this time.
9. Insert two more scanner positioning pins through the holes in the rear rail.
10. Screw the drive pulley to the shaft [G].
11. Screw the scanner wire bracket to the front rail [H].
12. Install the scanner wire clamp [I].
13. Pull out the positioning pins.
Make sure the 1st and 2nd carriages move smoothly after you remove the positioning pins. Do
steps 8 through 13 again if they do not.
p.180)
p.188 "Front Scanner Wire")
x 9, ground screw x 2,
x All)
4. Follow the steps 3 through 5 in the Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire Section. You can remove
the rear scanner wire with the same manner for replacing the front scanner wire.
192
Scanner Unit
4
1. Position the center ball [A] in the middle of the forked holder.
2. Pass the left end (with the ball) [B] through the drive pulley notch. Pass the right end (with the ring) [C]
through the drive pulley hole.
3. Wind the left end [B] clockwise (shown from the machines front) five times. Wind the right end [C]
counterclockwise three times.
The two red marks [D] come together when you do this. Attach the wire to the pulley with tape.
This lets you easily handle the assembly at the time of installation.
4. Install the drive pulley on the shaft.
Do not attach the pulley on the shaft with the screw at this time.
5. Install the wire.
The winding of the wire on the three pulleys at the rear of the scanner should be the same as the
winding on the three pulleys at the front. This must show as a mirror image.
Example: At the front of the machine, the side of the drive pulley with the three windings must face the
front of the machine. At the rear of the machine, it must face the rear.
6. Do steps 7 through 13 again in the Reinstalling the Front Scanner Wire Section.
4
2. On the touch screen press Touch Screen Adjust (or press "1").
3. Use a pointed (not sharp) tool to press the upper left mark "
".
" shows.
6. Touch [#] Exit on the screen to close the Self-Diagnostic menu. Save the calibration settings.
194
Laser Optics
Laser Optics
Turn off the main switch and unplug the machine before beginning any of the procedures in this section.
Laser beams can cause serious eye injury.
Be sure to turn off the main switch and disconnect the power plug from the power outlet before
beginning any disassembly or adjustment of the laser unit. This copier uses a class IIIb laser beam
with a wavelength of 655 nm and an output of 7 mW. The laser can cause serious eye injury.
195
LD Safety Switch
A relay on the PSU ensures technician and user safety. It also prevents the laser beam from turning on
during servicing. This relay turns off when the front cover, upper left cover, or right door is opened. At this
time it cuts the power (+5V) supplied to the LD board for each color through the BICU.
Two safety switches are turned on or off by the front door or right door, and this opens the relay.
LD Driver: Precise Pulse Modulation ASIC on C-MOS technology
LDB: LD Drive Board (included in the LD Unit)
Error Messages
Along with other switches, the LD safety switches help show error messages related to external covers.
When one or more covers are open, the messages, "Cover is open." and "Close the indicated cover," show
with a diagram. The diagram shows which cover is open.
Before installing a new laser optics housing unit, remove the sponge padding and the tag from the
new unit.
196
Laser Optics
A new laser optics housing unit has a bracket to protect the LD units. When you install the new unit,
do not remove the bracket until near the end of the installation procedure (the correct time is stated
in the manual).
This bracket protects a capacitor on the unit. If the bracket is removed too early, you could break the
capacitor on the corner of the main frame when you install the new unit.
x 4)
7. Turn off the main power switch and disconnect the power cord of the copier.
198
Laser Optics
x 3)
x 6)
3. Airflow fan bracket [A] for the laser housing optics unit (
x 4,
x 2)
199
x 2, All
's,
x 3)
A new laser optics housing unit has a bracket to protect the LD units. When you install the new unit,
do not remove the bracket until near the end of the installation procedure (the correct time is stated
in the manual).
This bracket protects a capacitor on the unit. If the bracket is removed too early, you could break the
capacitor on the corner of the main frame when you install the new unit.
1. Push the new laser optics housing unit [A] slowly into the copier until the bracket [B] bumps against
the frame of the copier.
2. Remove the bracket [B], and then push the new laser optics housing unit fully into the copier (
All
's, x 3).
3. Reassemble the machine.
200
x 2,
Laser Optics
Print the test pattern (14: 1-dot trimming pattern in the SP2-109-003).
Check that the left trim margin is within 2 1 mm. If not, change the registration value for the
main scan registration adjustment.
5. Select "0" with SP2-109-003 after printing the "1-dot trimming pattern.
6. Do the line position adjustment.
First do SP2-111-3.
Then do SP2-111-1.
To check if SP 2-111-1 was successful, watch the screen during the process. A message is
displayed at the end. Also, you can check the result with SP 2-194-10 to -12.
202
p.196)
Laser Optics
2. Polygon mirror motor cover [A] of the laser optics housing unit (
x 4,
x 4)
x 2)
x 1)
Airflow Fans
1. Controller cover (
p.173)
203
2. Left cover (
p.173)
4
3. Airflow fan bracket [A] for the laser housing optics unit (
204
x 4,
x 2)
Image Creation
Image Creation
PCDU
Do not touch the OPC drum. Do not let metal objects touch the development sleeve.
1. Open the front door.
x 1)
3. Turn the drum positioning plate lever [B] and the image transfer unit lock lever [C] counter-clockwise.
4. Open the drum positioning plate [D].
5. Pull out the PCDU (hold the grip while you pull it out).
205
Magenta: 3902-012
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the drum unit automatically, after
you turn the power on again.
2. Turn the machine power off.
3. PCDU (
p.205)
206
x 2)
Image Creation
4
Do not touch the bearing [A] after removing the front cover. The bearing is properly applied with
lubricant.
5. Remove the bushing [A] of the development roller at the rear of the PCDU (
x 1).
Do not put too much weight on the PCDU. Otherwise, the plastic frame [B] of the development
unit may be damaged.
207
x 2,
x 1).
The front joint [A] is firmly set. Remove it with a flat screwdriver.
208
Image Creation
8. Rotate the development roller [A] five or six times in the counterclockwise direction.
This step removes developer that has stuck to the development roller, which would cause color
unevenness.
9. If you change the development unit, do the ACC procedure.
10. Execute the drum phase adjustment with SP1902-001 twice.
When reassembling the PCDU:
Developer
1. Set SP 3902-xxx to "1".
Black: 3902-005
Yellow: 3902-006
Cyan: 3902-007
209
Magenta: 3902-008
2. Turn the machine power off.
3. Development unit (
p.206)
4
4. Hopper cover [A] (4 hooks)
Release the three hooks first in the correct order (from to ).
Put the head of a screwdriver in the groove gap [B] as shown, and then release the hook
Follow the correct order
breaks easily.
to
5. Shake a bag of developer and pour it into the development hopper [A].
6. Reattach the hopper cover (hook x 3).
Keep the developer off at both ends of the development unit enclosed in red lines in the diagram.
210
Image Creation
7. Turn the machine power on. The machine initializes the developer and resets the PM counter for the
developer. (For details of the developer initialization result, see "Developer Initialization Result" in the
"Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" chapter.
8. Do the ACC procedure.
211
p.174)
p.174)
x 2,
x 1,
212
x 2)
Image Creation
p.174)
p.174)
213
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
214
p.205)
p.221)
Image Creation
4. Put a sheet of paper (A3/DLT) inside the machine as shown and on the floor.
The sheet of paper on the floor is used in a later step.
4
5. Release the harness [A] from the clamp (
the harness.
x 1 for YCM,
x 2)
215
Make sure that a sheet of paper is attached to the frame of the rear side. The picture on the left
shows a sheet of paper that is correctly set, but the picture on the right shows a sheet of paper
that is not correctly set. This sheet of paper prevents toner and screws from falling into the laser
optics housing unit through cutouts.
8. Slowly remove the toner supply tube [A] from the toner pump unit by pulling the tube right and left.
9. Turn up the openings of the toner pump unit and toner supply tube just after removing the tube.
If not, the toner may scatter away and fall down.
216
Image Creation
10. Put the toner pump unit on the sheet of paper, which has been put in step 4, with its opening [A] up.
11. Keep the opening [A] of the toner supply tube up, and then clip the opening of the toner supply.
217
4
1. Put a sheet of paper (A3/DLT) inside the machine.
2. Turn up the opening of the toner supply tube, and then remove the object that was used to clip the
opening of the toner supply tube.
3. Insert the opening of the toner pump unit [A] into the opening of the toner supply tube [B] as far as
possible.
218
Image Creation
On the above picture, the magnified picture of the connector shows the easiest way to connect
it.
5. Clamp the harness [A] (
x 1 for YCM,
x 2 for K).
6. Pass the harness of the toner pump unit behind the hook [A], while pressing at [B].
7. Secure the toner supply tube with the holder [C], lifting up the edge of the holder "very gently".
Be careful when you lift the edge of the holder, because the holder is easily broken.
8. Insert the toner pump unit [A] into the rear frame of the machine (
x 2).
219
4
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
A toner end sensor is not installed in the entrance of the toner supply tube for black.
220
Image Transfer
Image Transfer
Image Transfer Belt Unit
1. Open the right door.
2. Open the front door.
3. Open the drum positioning plate. (
p.205 "PCDU")
4. Turn the image transfer belt unit lock lever [A] counterclockwise.
5. Pull out the image transfer belt unit [B] halfway.
221
6. Grasp the handles [A], and then pull out the image transfer belt unit fully.
p.205)
222
p.221)
p.222)
Image Transfer
3. Turn the image transfer unit contact lever [A] counterclockwise (as seen from the rear).
x 1).
x 6)
223
4
7. Guide plate [A] (as seen from the right side of the machine) (
x 2)
8. Remove the two screws and then the rear holder bracket [A] (as seen from the rear).
224
Image Transfer
9. Remove the two screws and then the front holder bracket [A] (as seen from the front).
4
10. Put the front side of the image transfer belt unit on a corner of the table or a box as shown.
225
There is a rim [A] at each edge of the transfer belt. The ends of all the rollers ([B] for example) in the
transfer belt unit must be between the two rims.
There are two rims (width [C]: about 5 mm) on the underside of the front and rear edges of the
image transfer belt.
226
Image Transfer
This belt must be installed the correct way around. When you reinstall the image transfer belt unit,
install it with the number [A] on the belt at the rear side of the unit.
Put "Lubricant Powder" (B132 9700) on the surface of the image transfer belt [A], while you turn the
drive gear [B] at a constant speed, as shown. (The straight arrow in the picture shows belt movement
direction.) Lubricant powder prevents the image transfer cleaning blade from turning up.
Do not put the lubricant powder at the right side of the image transfer belt unit (the above picture
is taken from the rear). Otherwise, lubricant powder may damage the encoder sensor.
227
Paper Transfer
Paper Transfer Roller Unit
If you will install a new paper transfer unit, then set SP 3902-016 to 1.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the paper transfer unit automatically,
after you turn the power on again.
1. Open the right door.
228
Paper Transfer
4
2. Open the duplex door [A].
3. Open the by-pass tray [B]
4. Right door cover [C] (
x 4)
x 1)
229
x 1)
x 1, 2 springs)
ID Sensor Board
1. K PCDU (
p.205)
p.257)
230
x 2,
p.221)
x 2,
x 1)
Paper Transfer
x 4)
x 2)
1. K PCDU (
2. Fusing unit (
p.205)
p.257)
p.221)
231
3. Input two correction coefficients [A] for the ID sensor with SP3-362-013 and SP3-362-016 on the
barcode sheet provided with the new ID sensor unit/board.
For example, input "1.03" with SP3-362-013.
SP numbers other than SP3-362-013 and -016 are not required for this procedure.
4. Exit the SP mode.
p.174)
p.174)
232
x 1,
x 1)
Drive Unit
Drive Unit
There are some motors and clutches that are not shown in the above drawing:
Tray lift motor 1 and 2
Shutter motor
Duplex/By-pass Motor
By-pass clutch
233
Gear Unit
1. All PCU's
2. Image transfer belt unit (
3. Rear cover (
p.221)
p.174)
4. Controller box (
p.309)
p.213)
7. Left cover (
p.173)
8. PSU bracket (
p.314 "PSU")
234
x 3).
Drive Unit
235
13. Disconnect two connectors (red arrows) and put these harnesses inside the machine.
14. Disconnect each connector (red circles) from the drum/development drive motors (
each).
15. Disconnect each connector (blue circles) from the development clutches (
x 2)
x 1,
x 1 each).
x1
Drive Unit
17. Disconnect eight connectors from the high voltage supply board (
x 8,
x 2).
18. Release four clamps (red circles) and turn the harnesses aside.
x 5).
x 3)
237
238
x 8)
Drive Unit
4
Make sure that the bushing [A] is fully set in the frame of the gear unit before installing the timing belt and
pulley to the shaft [B].
Registration Motor
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
239
p.174)
3. Ventilation duct (
p.314 "PSU")
x 5)
x 2, timing belt)
p.174)
p.174)
x 3,
x 2)
x 2,
x 1)
x 1)
Drive Unit
x 1,
x 2, timing belt)
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
x 4,
x 1 each)
241
Drum/Development Motor-K
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
2. PSU bracket (
p.314 "PSU")
3. Controller box (
x 2,
x 1)
x 4,
p.174)
2. Controller box (
242
x 1)
Drive Unit
4
3. ITB drive motor [A] (
x 4,
x 1)
p.174)
2. Controller box (
x 3,
x 1)
p.174)
2. Controller box (
x 2,
x 2)
244
x 3, 2 hooks)
Drive Unit
7. Gear [A] (
x 3,
x 2,
x 1,
x 2)
x 1)
x 1, belt x 1)
x 4)
245
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
4
4. Disconnect the connector [A] (
x 1).
x 4)
Duplex/By-pass Motor
1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
246
p.246)
Drive Unit
x 1,
x 1)
x 2)
247
x 4, belt x 1)
p.174)
2. PSU bracket (
p.314 "PSU")
4. Stay [A] (
x 4)
248
p.246)
p.246)
Drive Unit
x 1)
x 2)
NOTE:
The picture below shows how to use the screwdriver to remove the screws of the paper transfer
contact motor.
249
p.174)
250
p.234)
x 3,
x 1)
Drive Unit
x 6,
x 1)
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
3. Release five clamps, and then turn the harness [A] aside.
251
x 2,
x 1,
x 1,
x 2,
x 1,
x 1)
252
x 1)
Drive Unit
Development Clutch-Y
1. Rear cover (
2. PSU bracket (
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
4. Drum/development motor-Y (
p.241)
x 1).
253
7. Turn the development clutch unit [A] counter-clockwise and then pull it out (
8. Development clutch-Y [B] (
x 1)
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
p.241)
254
x 1).
x 1).
Drive Unit
4
6. Turn the development clutch unit [A] counter-clockwise and then pull it out (
7. Development clutches for M and C [B] (
x 1).
x 1)
Development Clutch-K
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
2. PSU bracket (
3. Controller box (
p.314 "PSU")
p.309 "Controller Box")
4. Drum/development motor-K (
p.242)
5. Turn the development clutch unit [A] counter-clockwise and then pull it out (
x 1).
255
256
x 1)
Fusing
Fusing
Fusing Unit Maintenance Parts
In the fusing unit, there are some maintenance parts. However, these parts are defined as EM parts. Refer
to the following list to check the maintenance parts.
Maintenance Parts
Replacement Procedure
Heating Roller
p.260
-Bearing
p.260
Pressure Roller
p.268
-Bearing
p.268
Fusing Unit
Turn off the main switch and wait until the fusing unit cools down before beginning any of the
procedures in this section. The fusing unit can cause serious burns.
1. If you will replace the heating roller or pressure roller in the fusing unit (at PM for example), then reset
each counter.
Set SP 3902-018 to "1" for the heating roller replacement.
Set SP 3902-019 to "1" for the pressure roller replacement.
If you do this, then the machine will reset the PM counter for the heating roller or pressure roller
automatically, after you turn the power on again.
It is not necessary to clear the PM counter for the fusing unit with SP mode when you replace the
fusing unit. This is because the fusing unit has a new unit detection mechanism.
2. Turn off the main power switch.
3. Open the right door.
257
x 1)
x 1)
258
p.257)
Fusing
x 2)
Cleaning Requirement
The fusing entrance guide plate requires cleaning maintenance every fusing unit maintenance interval.
Clean the fusing entrance guide plate at the place shown above with a dry cloth, and then clean the fusing
entrance guide plate again with a cloth moistened with alcohol.
p.257)
259
4
2. Open the exit guide plate [A].
3. Clean the exit guide plate with a dry cloth, and then clean the exit guide plate again with a cloth
moistened with alcohol at the points shown above.
p.257)
260
Fusing
x 2; Stepped screws)
x 2; Stepped screws)
4
5. Fusing right cover [A] (
x 2; Stepped screws)
6. Pressure roller contact shaft actuator [A] and pressure roller contact shaft gear [B] (
x 1,
x 1)
7. Turn both pressure levers [A] [B], and pull out pins [C] [D].
261
If the pins [C] [D] are not pulled out in this step, the fusing unit frames may become bent.
262
x 4)
x 4)
Fusing
4
10. Top stay [A] (
x 4)
4
14. Heating roller bearing [A] at the rear side
15. Keep the heating roller stripper plate [A] open, and then remove the heating roller [B].
264
Fusing
The surface of the heating roller is fragile, so the heating roller must be covered with a sheet of
paper when it is placed on a table or floor.
1. Apply three spots of "Barrierta S552R" (the diameter of each spot must be about 3 mm in diameter,
and approximately 0.1 g in weight) to the front shaft of the heating roller at 2 - 3 mm from the notch
[A].
2. Apply three spots of "Barrierta S552R" (the diameter of each spot must be about 3 mm in diameter,
and approximately 0.1 g in weight) to the rear shaft of the heating roller at 2 - 3 mm from the edge
[B] (rear side of the heating roller).
Do not wipe off the grease of the new fusing drive gear when replacing the fusing drive gear
[A].
265
The heating roller stripper plate may come off the fusing unit frame after removing the heating roller.
When reinstalling the heating roller stripper plate:
1. Set the heating roller stripper plate [A] on the fusing frame first.
2. Attach the springs [B] (front and rear) correctly as shown above.
3. Turn the springs as shown above so that the springs hook the fusing unit frame and heating roller
stripper plate.
4. Hold the heating roller stripper plate, and then install the heating roller.
The heating roller stripper plate is not supported before installing the heating roller in the fusing
unit frame. If you stop holding, the heating roller stripper plate can fall down.
266
p.257)
p.260)
Fusing
4
Attach the fusing cleaning felt [A], aligning both edges of the fusing cleaning felt with the red lines on the
bottom cover.
Make sure that the fusing cleaning felt is correctly attached to the frame. Otherwise, dust from the IH
coil unit may fall on the paper in the fusing unit and the output becomes dirty.
Fusing Lamp
1. Fusing unit (
p.257)
2. Front bracket (
p.260)
3. Rear bracket (
p.260)
267
x 1)
x 1,
4
6. Fusing lamp rear bracket [A] (
x 3)
x 1)
268
p.260)
p.267)
Fusing
x 1)
x 1)
269
4
9. Keep the pressure roller stripper plate [A] open.
10. Pressure roller [B]
270
Fusing
1. Apply "Barrierta S552R" to the front shaft of the pressure roller at 2 mm from the notch [A], and to
the rear shaft of the pressure roller at 2 mm from the edge [B]. (Apply the lubricant to half of the
circumference of the pressure roller, as shown in the lower of the three above diagrams.)
4
2. Make sure that pressure roller bearing [C] at the front side is set as shown above.
Pressure Roller Stripper Plate Installation
271
Stripper Plates
1. Fusing unit (
p.257)
2. Heating roller (
p.260)
272
p.268)
Fusing
4
5. Pressure roller stripper plate [A] (spring x 2)
Cleaning Requirement
The stripper plates require cleaning maintenance every fusing unit maintenance interval. Clean the stripper
plates with a dry cloth, and then clean the stripper plates again with a cloth moistened with alcohol at the
points shown above.
p.257)
273
x 5)
274
x 1)
x 1,
x 1)
Fusing
p.257)
x 2)
The entrance guide plate must be removed with the orientation of the fusing unit as shown above,
to protect the surface of the heating roller from damage.
x 4)
275
p.257)
x 1)
p.257)
276
Fusing
x 1,
x 1)
Fusing Fan
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
p.174)
x 1,
x 1)
277
x 1, hook x 3)
Make sure that the paper exit fan is installed with its decal facing the rear of the machine.
p.174)
278
p.174)
Fusing
x 2,
x 1)
x 2)
Thermopile
1. Open the right door.
2. Front right cover (
3. Pull out trays 1 and 2, and the image transfer belt unit.
279
5. Bracket [A] (
x 1)
280
Fusing
x 2,
x 1,
x 3)
x 2)
Do this cleaning procedure after the fusing unit has completely cooled down. Otherwise, you may
get a serious burn.
Do not push the thermostats on the IH coil unit. If you do, the thermostats will be opened. In that case,
the IH coil unit must be replaced.
1. Fusing unit (
p.257)
281
p.257)
x 1,
x 1)
IH Coil Fan
1. Open the right door.
2. Front right cover (
3. Pull out trays 1 and 2, and the image transfer belt unit (
4. Right front cover and front inner cover (
282
p.279)
p.279)
Fusing
x 1,
x 1,
x 1)
x 2)
IH Coil Unit
Do not push the thermostats on the IH coil unit. If you do, the thermostats will be opened. In that case,
the IH coil unit must be replaced.
1. Fusing unit (
p.257)
2. Rear cover (
p.174)
p.174)
p.277)
p.317)
283
x 3)
x 1,
x 1)
284
Fusing
x 1)
12. IH coil unit [A] (First, release the front side of the IH coil unit.)
285
Paper Feed
Paper Feed Unit
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
p.174)
p.301)
286
x 1)
Paper Feed
x 2,
x 1)
p.286)
x 1)
x 1)
287
4
4. Feed roller [A]
5. Pick-up belt unit [B]
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
x 2,
p.316)
x 3,
x 1 each)
Vertical Transport, Paper Overflow, Paper End and Paper Feed Sensor
1. Rear cover (
288
p.174)
Paper Feed
p.174)
p.286)
x 1,
x 1 each)
x 1)
x 1, hook)
x 1)
x 1, hook)
Registration Sensor
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
p.174)
289
4
3. Paper guide plate 1 [A] and 2 [B] (
4. Registration sensor [C] (
x 2 each)
x 1, hook)
290
x 4)
Paper Feed
x 1).
x 1)
1. Adjust the projection [A] of the left side fence bar (it must be centered).
2. Install the by-pass paper size detection switch so that the hole [B] in this switch faces the projection
[C] of the left side fence bar.
3. Reassemble the copier.
4. Plug in and turn on the main power switch.
5. Check this switch operation with SP5803-011 (By-pass paper size < Input Check).
- Display on the LCD Paper Size
Display
Paper Size
Display
A3 SEF
00001110
A5 SEF
00001011
291
B4 SEF
00001100
B6 SEF
00000011
A4 SEF
00001101
A6 SEF
00000111
B5 SEF
00001001
Smaller A6 SEF
00001111
p.290 "By-pass Paper Size Sensor and By-pass Paper Length Sensor")
292
x 4)
Paper Feed
x 3)
4
6. Remove the screw at the front side (
x 1).
293
x 1 each).
294
Paper Feed
4
2. By-pass feed unit cover [A] (
x 2).
x 1, hook)
295
x 1)
p.294 "By-pass Paper End Sensor")
x 1)
296
Paper Feed
4
3. By-pass feed clutch holder [A] (
4. By-pass feed clutch [B] (
x 2)
x 1,
x 1)
p.257)
p.176)
5. Thermopile (
p.279)
6. Rear cover (
p.174)
p.221)
p.174)
297
4
10. Gear cover [A] (
11. Paper exit unit [B] (
x 1)
x 2,
x 2)
Fusing Exit, Paper Overflow, Junction Paper Jam and Paper Exit Sensor
298
p.297)
Paper Feed
x 1,
x 1)
3. Remove the fusing exit sensor from the fusing exit sensor bracket (
x 1)
x 1, hook)
x 1,
x 1)
299
6. Remove the junction paper jam sensor from the junction paper jam sensor bracket (hook)
7. Paper exit sensor bracket [B] (
x 1,
x 1)
8. Remove the paper exit sensor from the paper exit sensor bracket (hook)
300
Duplex Unit
Duplex Unit
Duplex Unit
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
p.174)
x 1).
301
9. Hold the right door, and then release the wire [A] (
x 1).
Keep holding the right door before removing the right door completely. Otherwise, the right
door can fall down and injure you.
10. Press the projection [B] to pull the right door shaft into the unit, and then remove the duplex unit [C]
x 1,
x 4, ground cable x 1).
( x 1,
302
Duplex Unit
4
3. Duplex door sensor [A] (
x 1, hook)
x 1,
x 1)
303
p.228)
304
x 1, hook)
Electrical Components
Electrical Components
Boards
Controller Box closed
[A]
IOB
[B]
FCU (Option)
[C]
[D]
PSU
[E]
305
306
[F]
BICU
[G]
Controller Board
[H]
HDD
Electrical Components
[I]
Controller Unit
1. Control cover (
p.173)
307
x 5)
p.174)
308
Electrical Components
4
3. Controller box right cover [A] (
x 8)
Controller Box
When opening the controller box
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
309
4
4. Open the controller box [A].
p.174)
310
p.308)
Electrical Components
x 4).
4
6. Move the IOB bracket [A] aside (
x 4,
x All).
311
11. Lift up the controller box [A], and then remove it.
p.174)
4. IOB [A] (
x 6, All
p.308)
s)
BICU
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
312
Electrical Components
p.308)
6. BICU [A] (
x 5,
x All)
Make sure the NVRAM is correctly installed on the BICU. Insert the NVRAM in the NVRAM slot
with the "half-moon" pointing [B] to the upward side.
313
PSU
PSU bracket
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
x 2)
x 6,
x All,
x All)
PSU board
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
314
x 11, all
s, all
s)
Electrical Components
p.314 "PSU")
4
2. Tray left rail cover [A] (
x 1)
x 2).
x 2)
p.174)
315
x 5,
x 6)
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
x 8, All
316
p.174)
p.314 "PSU")
s,
x 2)
Electrical Components
x 3,
x All,
x 2)
IH Inverter
1. Rear cover (
p.174)
p.174)
4. IH inverter [A] (
x 6,
x 5)
Controller Board
1. Controller unit (
p.307)
317
x 7,
x 3)
318
Electrical Components
HDD Fan
1. Controller unit (
p.307)
x 2,
x 1)
HDD
1. Controller unit (
p.307)
319
x 4,
x 4).
x 2).
320
Electrical Components
during copy job sorting and jam recovery. Such data is stored on the HDD in a special format so it
cannot normally be read but can be recovered with illegal methods.
Reinstallation
Explain to the customer that the following information stored on the HDD is lost when the HDD is replaced:
Document server documents
Custom-made stamps
Document server address book
The address book and document server documents (if needed) must be input again.
If you previously backed up the address book to an SD card with SP5846 051, you can use SP 5846
052 to copy the data from the SD card to the hard disk.
If the customer is using the Data Overwrite Security feature, the DOS function must be set up again. For
more, see Section 1 (Installation).
If the customer is using the optional Browser Unit, this unit must be installed again. For more, see Section
1 (Installation).
SP5-990-001) if possible.
SP5-824-001) if possible.
6. Turn off the main switch. Then unplug the power cord.
7. Replace the NVRAM on the BICU and reassemble the machine.
8. Plug in the power cord. Then turn the main switch on.
9. Select a paper-size type (
SP5-131-001).
10. Specify the serial number and destination code of the machine.
Contact your supervisor for details on how to enter the serial number and destination code.
SC 999 or "Fusing Unit Setting Error" can be shown until the serial number and destination code
are correctly programmed.
321
13. Turn the main switch off. Then remove the SD card from SD card slot 3.
14. Turn the main switch on.
15. Specify the SP and UP mode settings.
16. Do the process control self-check.
17. Do ACC for the copier application program.
18. Do ACC for the printer application program.
322
OFF
ON
2 to 8
BICU Board
DIP SW No.
OFF
ON
1 and 2
323
324
5. System Maintenance
Service Program Mode
Make sure that the data-in LED ( ) is not on before you go into the SP mode. This LED indicates that
some data is coming to the machine. When the LED is on, wait for the copier to process the data.
SP Tables
See "Appendices" for the following information:
System SP Tables
Printer SP Tables
Scanner SP Tables
The Service Program Mode is for use by service representatives only. If this mode is used by anyone
other than service representatives for any reason, data might be deleted or settings might be changed.
In such case, product quality cannot be guaranteed any more.
Entering SP Mode
For details, ask your supervisor.
Exiting SP Mode
Press "Exit" on the LCD twice to return to the copy window.
Types of SP Modes
System SP: SP modes related to the engine functions
Printer SP: SP modes related to the controller functions
Scanner SP: SP modes related to the scanner functions
Fax SP: SP modes related to the fax functions
325
5. System Maintenance
Select one of the Service Program modes (System, Printer, Scanner, or Fax) from the touch panel as shown
in the diagram below after you access the SP mode. This section explains the functions of the System/
Printer/Scanner SP modes. Refer to the Fax service manual for the Fax SP modes.
5
SP Mode Button Summary
Here is a short summary of the touch-panel buttons.
326
Closes all open groups and sublevels and restores the initial SP mode display.
Opens the copy window (copy mode) so you can make test copies. Press SP Mode (highlighted)
in the copy window to return to the SP mode screen,
Enter the SP code directly with the number keys if you know the SP number. Then press . (The
required SP Mode number will be highlighted when pressing . If not, just press the required
SP Mode number.)
Press two times to leave the SP mode and return to the copy window to resume normal operation.
Press to scroll to the previous or next display in segments the size of the screen display (page).
Press to scroll the show the previous or next line (line by line).
10
Press to move the highlight on the left to the previous or next selection in the list.
4. Press SP Mode (highlighted) to return to the SP mode screen and repeat from step 1.
327
5. System Maintenance
to enter the setting. (The value is not registered if you enter a number that is out of range.)
328
The CE can service the machine and turn the machine off and on. It is not necessary to ask the
Administrator to log in again each time the machine is turned on.
2. Go into the SP mode and set SP5169 to "1" if you must use the printer bit switches.
3. After machine servicing is completed:
Change SP5169 from "1" to "0".
Turn the machine off and on. Tell the administrator that you have completed servicing the
machine.
The Administrator will then set the "Service Mode Lock" to ON.
Remarks
Display on the Control Panel Screen
The maximum number of characters which can show on the control panel screen is limited to 30 characters.
For this reason, some of the SP modes shown on the screen need to be abbreviated. The following are
abbreviations used for the SP modes for which the full description is over 20 characters.
Paper Weight
Thin paper: 52-59 g/m2
Plain Paper: 60-90 g/m2, 16-24lb.
Middle Thick: 91-105 g/m2, 24-28lb.
Thick Paper 1: 106-169 g/m2, 28.5-44.9lb.
Thick Paper 2: 170-220 g/m2, 45-58lb.
Thick Paper 3: 221-256 g/m2, 59lb-68lb
Thick 4: 257 g/m2-300 g/m2, 68.4-79.8lb
Paper Type
N: Normal paper
MTH: Middle thick paper
TH: Thick paper
329
5. System Maintenance
Print Mode
Process Speed
S: Simplex
D: Duplex
Others
The following symbols are used in the SP mode tables.
FA: Factory setting
(Data may be adjusted from the default setting at the factory. Refer to the factory setting sheets enclosed.
You can find it under the jammed paper removal decal.)
DFU: Design/Factory Use only
Do not touch these SP modes in the field.
A sharp (#) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that the main switch must be turned
off and on to effect the setting change.
An asterisk (*) to the right hand side of the mode number column means that this mode is stored in the
NVRAM. If you do a RAM clear, this SP mode will be reset to the default value. "ENG" and "CTL" show
which NVRAM contains the data.
ENG: NVRAM on the BICU board
CTL: NVRAM on the controller board
The settings of each SP mode are explained in the right-hand column of the SP table in the following way.
[Adjustable range / Default setting / Step] Alphanumeric
If "Alphanumeric" is written to the right of the bracket as shown above, the setting of the SP mode
shows on the screen using alphanumeric characters instead of only numbers. However, the settings
in the bracket in the SP mode table are explained by using only the numbers.
SSP: This denotes a "Special Service Program" mode setting.
330
Main SP Tables-1
Main SP Tables-1
SP1-XXX (Feed)
[Leading Edge Registration] Leading Edge Registration Adjustment
1001
(Tray Location, Paper Type, Color Mode), Paper Type -> Plain, Thick 1or Thick 2
Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration motor operation timing for
each mode.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
331
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each
mode.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
006 Duplex
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
Main SP Tables-1
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1007
[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
333
5. System Maintenance
LG
001
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass tray.
This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5.
0: OFF (Letter/SEF), 1: ON (Legal/SEF)
1101
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
004 Temp.:Delta:Cold:Center
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
005 Temp.:Delta:Cold:End
*ENG
006 Temp.:Delta:Cold:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
009 Temp.:Delta:Warm:End
*ENG
010 Temp.:Delta:Warm:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
334
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
Main SP Tables-1
013 Temp.:Delta:Hot:End
*ENG
014 Temp.:Delta:Hot:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
017 Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW:End
*ENG
018 Temp.Delta:Cold:BW:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 70 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the setting of the forced reload permit for cold temperature in BW mode.
019 Time:Cold:BW
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:Cent
er
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
021 Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:End
*ENG
022 Temp.Delta:Cold:BW2:Press
*ENG
1102
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
007
Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.1
013
Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.1
Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.2
1105
Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.2
001
336
Plain1:FC:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Main SP Tables-1
002
003
004
005
006
007
008
Plain1:FC:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing..
Plain1:BW:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain1:BW:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:FC:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Plain2:FC:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full coloe printing.
Plain2:BW:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:BW:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
009 Thin:FC:Center
*ENG
010 Thin:FC:Press
*ENG
011 Thin:BW:Center
*ENG
012 Thin:BW:Press
*ENG
013 M-thick:FC:Center
*ENG
014 M-thick:FC:Press
*ENG
015 M-thick:BW:Center
*ENG
016 M-thick:BW:Press
*ENG
017 Thick1:FC:Center
*ENG
018 Thick1:FC:Press
*ENG
019 Thick1:BW:Center
*ENG
020 Thick1:BW:Press
*ENG
5. System Maintenance
021 Thick2:FC:Center
*ENG
022 Thick2:FC:Press
*ENG
023 Thick2:BW:Center
*ENG
024 Thick2:BW:Press
*ENG
025 Thick3:FC:Center
*ENG
026 Thick3:FC:Press
*ENG
027 Thick3:BW:Center
*ENG
028 Thick3:BW:Press
*ENG
029 Special1:FC:Center
*ENG
030 Special1:FC:Press
*ENG
031 Special1:BW:Center
*ENG
032 Special1:BW:Press
*ENG
033 Special2:FC:Center
*ENG
034 Special2:FC:Press
*ENG
035 Special2:BW:Center
*ENG
036 Special2:BW:Press
*ENG
037 Special3:FC:Center
*ENG
038 Special3:FC:Press
*ENG
039 Special3:BW:Center
*ENG
040 Special3:BW:Press
*ENG
041 Envelop:Center
*ENG
042 Envelop:Press
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
103
338
Plain1:BW:Center:Low
Speed
Main SP Tables-1
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Plain2:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
*ENG
M-thick:FC:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Thick1:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
*ENG
107
109
111
115
M-thick:BW:Center:Low
Speed
117
Special1:FC:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
118
Special1:FC:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
119
Special1:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
120
Special1:BW:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
121
Special2:FC:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
122
Special2:FC:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
339
5. System Maintenance
123
Special2:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
124
Special2:BW:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
125 Plain1:Glossy:Center
*ENG
126 Plain1:Glossy:Press
*ENG
127 Plain2:Glossy:Center
*ENG
128 Plain2:Glossy:Press
*ENG
129 M-thick:Glossy:Center
*ENG
130 M-thick:Glossy:Press
*ENG
131 OHP:Center
*ENG
132 OHP:Press
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
139 Thick4:FC:Center
*ENG
140 Thick4:FC:Press
*ENG
141 Thick4:BW:Center
*ENG
142 Thick4:BW:Press
*ENG
001 Center
002 End
1106
340
Main SP Tables-1
003 Pressure
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 15 / 1 sec/step]
1107
001 Specifies the time that the fusing heater turns off after the fusing unit temperature has reached
its target temperature.
002
004
006
007
008
1108
001
002
1111
Stanby/Preheat1: Press
*ENG
[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the ready or energy save 1 mode.
Preheat2:Press
*ENG
[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the energy save 2 mode.
Low Power:Press
*ENG
[0 to 125 / 60 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the low power mode.
Print Ready:Center
*ENG
Specifies the temperature of the heating roller for the print ready condition.
Print Ready:Press
*ENG
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the print ready condition.
[After Reload/Job Target Temp.]
Center
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 17 / 1 deg/step]
001 Specifies the threshold temperature for low temperature. If the fusing temperature is 17C
or less, the machine executes the fusing mode for low temperature.
341
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 deg/step]
002 Sepcifies the threshold temperature for high temperature. If the fusing temperature is 30C
or more, the machine executes the fusing mode for high temperature.
Low Temp. Correction
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
003 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in low temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.
High Temp. Correction
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
004 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in high temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.
*ENG
*ENG
1113
001
*ENG
[Curl Correction]
Execute Pattern
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On (No Decurl), 2: On
003
Humidity:Threshold:M-humid
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 1 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:H005 humid
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in high humidity.
342
Main SP Tables-1
006
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:H007 humid:No Decurl
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 40 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in high humidity.
CPM:M-humid
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]
008 Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
009
CPM:H-humid
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in high humidity.
CPM:M-humid:No Decurl
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]
010 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
CPM:H-humid:No Decurl
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
011 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in high
humidity.
1115
001
1124
*ENG
Specifies the different temperature between end and center of the heating roller.
[CPM Down Setting]
Specifies the settings for the CPM down mode.
*ENG
Specifies the CPM down threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature decreases -20C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM down mode.
002 Low:Up Temp.
*ENG
343
5. System Maintenance
Specifies the CPM up threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature increases -15C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM up mode.
003 Low :1st CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
004 Low :2nd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 2nd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
005 Low :3rd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
*ENG
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
007 High:2nd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
008 High:3rd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
009
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A3 paper size.
010
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A3 paper size.
011
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A3 paper size.
012
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A4 paper size.
344
Main SP Tables-1
013
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A4 paper size.
014
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A4 paper size.
015
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of B5 paper size.
016
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of B5 paper size.
017
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of B5 paper size.
018
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A5 paper size.
019
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A5 paper size.
020
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A5 paper size.
021
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A6 paper size.
022
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A6 paper size.
345
5. System Maintenance
023
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A6 paper size.
024 Judging Interval
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 5 / 1 sec/step]
001 SC Number
*ENG
002 SC Cause
*ENG
[0 to 9 / - / 1/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the center of
the heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the end of the
heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
346
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Main SP Tables-1
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1142
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
001 Enables or disables the fusing consecutive jam (three times) SC detection.
0: No detection, 1: Detection
1151
[Pressure Setting]
Pressure Change ON/OFF
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
001 Enables or disables the pressure switching control for the fusing unit.
0: OFF , 1: ON
002
003
004
Pressure Position1
*ENG
Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 1.
Pressure Position2
*ENG
Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 2.
Pressure Position3
*ENG
Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 3.
Depressure Position
*ENG
005 Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the depression position (no
pressure).
347
5. System Maintenance
Shift Time
*ENG
[0 to 3600 / 5 / 1 sec/step]
010 Specifies the timing for depressing the fusing unit. If the machine does not get any jobs for
specified time by this SP after copying or printing, the machine depresses the fusing unit.
101 Pressure:Plain1/2
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in normal speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)
102 Pressure:Thin
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
103 Pressure:M-thick
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
104 Pressure:Thick1
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
105 Pressure:Thick2
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
106 Pressure:Thick3
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
107 Pressure:Special1
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
108 Pressure:Special2
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
109 Pressure:Special3
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
110 Pressure:Envelope
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in low speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)
348
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
Main SP Tables-1
156 Pressure:Plain1/2:Glossy
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
157 Pressure:M-thick:Glossy
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
158 Pressure:OHP
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
Pressure:Thick4
Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for thick 4 paper.
161
1152
ENG
[0 to 9,000,000 / - / 1 /step]
Displays the detection time for the edge of the pressure roller actuator.
[Fusing Nip Band Check]
001 Execute
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
Executes the nip band measurement between heating roller and pressure roller.
If the nip band width is not 8 mm, and fusing is not good, replace the pressure roller or install
a new fusing unit.
002
003
004
1153
Pre-Idling Time
*ENG
* ENG
[5 to 30 / 20 / 1 sec/step]
* ENG
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1 ]
349
5. System Maintenance
Operation interval
*ENG
[1 to 300 / 0 / 1 K/step]
002 Adjusts the execution interval for the fusing cleaning mode.
1K= 100 sheets
003
004
1801
350
Control Temp.
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for the fusing cleaning mode.
Page Count
*ENG
[1 to 300000 / - / 1 page/step]
001 Registration:Plain:Low
*ENG
002 Registration:Plain:High
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
007 Registration:Thick1:Mid
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-1
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
034 Feed:Plain:Low
*ENG
035 Feed:Plain:High
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
5
[4 to 4 / 0.0 / 0.1 %/step]
[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
351
5. System Maintenance
352
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
060 KOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
061 KOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
062 KOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
063 MOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]
064 MOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]
065 MOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
066 COpcDevMot:High
*ENG
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]
067 COpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]
068 COpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
069 YOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]
070 YOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]
071 YOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
075 TransferMot:High
*ENG
076 TransferMot:Mid
*ENG
077 TransferMot:Low
*ENG
078 TonerMot
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
[30 to 30 / 10 / 5 %/step]
Main SP Tables-1
100
Drum Adjust
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
102 COpcDevMot:High
*ENG
103 YOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
104 MOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
105 COpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
106 YOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
107 MOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
108 COpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
109 YOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
110 MOpcDevMot:1200
*ENG
111 COpcDevMot:1200
*ENG
[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]
[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]
5
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
[ 7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]
112 YOpcDevMot:1200
*ENG
120 Long:Registration:Plain:High
*ENG
121 Long:Registration:Plain:Low
*ENG
*ENG
123
Long:Registration:Middle
Thick:Middle
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[2 to 2 / -1 / 0.1 %/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
353
5. System Maintenance
129 Long:Fusing:Plain:High
*ENG
130 Long:Fusing:Plain:Low
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1902
[Amplitude Control]
001 Execute
002 Result
*ENG
0: Successfully done
2: Sampling failure
3: Insufficient detection number
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
*ENG
1950
354
Main SP Tables-1
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1951
*ENG
[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1952
[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
001 -
1953
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 min./step]
355
5. System Maintenance
001
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On
002
003
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 min./step]
*ENG
*ENG
005
1954
356
*ENG
002
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
009
*ENG
010
*ENG
011
*ENG
012
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
Main SP Tables-2
SP2-XXX (Drum)
[Charge DC Voltage] Charge Roller DC Voltage Adjustment
2005
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
014 PCU:Thick 1
*ENG
357
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
016 HVP:Plain
*ENG
017 HVP:Thick 1
*ENG
*ENG
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&FINE: Low speed
Adjusts the AC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2012
358
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
0: Process control
1: Manual control (AC voltages are decided
with SP2006.)
2013
Current Environmental:
001
Display
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
359
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
008
*ENG
009
*ENG
010
Previous Environmental:
Display
*ENG
*ENG
012
*ENG
013
*ENG
2015
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Success
1: Out of tolerance range
2: Out of adjustable range
3: Adjustment incompleted
360
These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser
optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2103
*ENG
*ENG
003 Left
*ENG
004 Right
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2105
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2109
[Test Pattern]
Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD.
362
*ENG
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]
Main SP Tables-2
0 None
3: Horizontal (1dot)
4: Horizontal (2dot)
[1 to 4 / 1 / 1/step]
007 Density: Ma
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
008 Density: Cy
0: Lightest density
009 Density: Ye
2111
001 Mode a
002 Mode b
003 Mode c
363
5. System Maintenance
2112
001 Execute
[Skew Adjustment]
2117
These SPs must be used when a new laser optics housing unit is installed or when SC2.585
occurs. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and Adjustment"
section.
001 Pulse: M
*ENG
002 Pulse: C
*ENG
003 Pulse: Y
*ENG
2118
[50 to 50 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
[Skew Adjustment]
001 Execute: M
*ENG
002 Execute: C
*ENG
003 Execute: Y
*ENG
2119
364
001 M
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 Y
*ENG
[50 to 50 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
Main SP Tables-2
2150
Adjusts the magnification for each area. The main scan (297 mm) is divided into 8 areas.
Area 1 is at the front side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 8 is at the rear
side of the machine (right side of the image).
Decreasing a value makes the image shift to the left side on the print.
Increasing a value makes the image shift to the right side on the print.
1 pulse = 1/16 dot
027 Area 0: Bk
*ENG
028 Area 1: Bk
*ENG
029 Area 2: Bk
*ENG
030 Area 3: Bk
*ENG
031 Area 4: Bk
*ENG
032 Area 5: Bk
*ENG
033 Area 6: Bk
*ENG
034 Area 7: Bk
*ENG
035 Area 8: Bk
*ENG
036 Area 9: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
079 Area 0: Ma
*ENG
Not used
080 Area 1: Ma
*ENG
Not used
365
5. System Maintenance
366
081 Area 2: Ma
*ENG
082 Area 3: Ma
*ENG
083 Area 4: Ma
*ENG
084 Area 5: Ma
*ENG
085 Area 6: Ma
*ENG
086 Area 7: Ma
*ENG
087 Area 8: Ma
*ENG
088 Area 9: Ma
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
131 Area 0: Cy
*ENG
132 Area 1: Cy
*ENG
133 Area 2: Cy
*ENG
134 Area 3: Cy
*ENG
135 Area 4: Cy
*ENG
136 Area 5: Cy
*ENG
137 Area 6: Cy
*ENG
138 Area 7: Cy
*ENG
139 Area 8: Cy
*ENG
140 Area 9: Cy
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
183 Area 0: Ye
*ENG
Not used
Not used
Not used
Not used
Main SP Tables-2
184 Area 1: Ye
*ENG
185 Area 2: Ye
*ENG
186 Area 3: Ye
*ENG
187 Area 4: Ye
*ENG
188 Area 5: Ye
*ENG
189 Area 6: Ye
*ENG
190 Area 7: Ye
*ENG
191 Area 8: Ye
*ENG
192 Area 9: Ye
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
The main scan is divided into 16 areas. However, the image areas are limited from area 1
to area 14.
For BK and Magenta, area 1 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image) and
area 14 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image).
For Cyan and Yellow, area 1 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image) and
area 14 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image).
367
5. System Maintenance
368
001 Area 0: Bk
*ENG
002 Area 1: Bk
*ENG
003 Area 2: Bk
*ENG
004 Area 3: Bk
*ENG
005 Area 4: Bk
*ENG
006 Area 5: Bk
*ENG
007 Area 6: Bk
*ENG
008 Area 7: Bk
*ENG
009 Area 8: Bk
*ENG
010 Area 9: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
033 Area 0: M
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
034 Area 1: M
*ENG
035 Area 2: M
*ENG
036 Area 3: M
*ENG
037 Area 4: M
*ENG
038 Area 5: M
*ENG
039 Area 6: M
*ENG
040 Area 7: M
*ENG
041 Area 8: M
*ENG
042 Area 9: M
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
065 Area 0: C
*ENG
369
5. System Maintenance
370
066 Area 1: C
*ENG
067 Area 2: C
*ENG
068 Area 3: C
*ENG
069 Area 4: C
*ENG
070 Area 5: C
*ENG
071 Area 6: C
*ENG
072 Area 7: C
*ENG
073 Area 8: C
*ENG
074 Area 9: C
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
097 Area 0: Y
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
098 Area 1: Y
*ENG
099 Area 2: Y
*ENG
100 Area 3: Y
*ENG
101 Area 4: Y
*ENG
102 Area 5: Y
*ENG
103 Area 6: Y
*ENG
104 Area 7: Y
*ENG
105 Area 8: Y
*ENG
106 Area 9: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2160
001 600dpi:Bk
*ENG
002 600dpi:Ma
*ENG
003 600dpi:Cy
*ENG
004 600dpi:Ye
*ENG
005 1200dpi:Bk
*ENG
006 1200dpi:Ma
*ENG
007 1200dpi:Cy
*ENG
008 1200dpi:Ye
*ENG
[10 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
371
5. System Maintenance
2181
372
*ENG
*ENG
003 Skew: M
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
021 Skew: C
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
039 Skew: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
2182
[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
001 M Magnification
*ENG
002 C Magnification
*ENG
003 Y Magnification
*ENG
When line shifts are not corrected by the automatic line position adjustment, do this SP.
Increasing a value reduces the image in the main scan direction.
Decreasing a value enlarges the image in the main scan direction.
374
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
375
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
Not used
2185
Displays/adjusts the target value for the main scan magnification correction of the line
position adjustment.
After replacing the laser optics housing unit, input the standard value for Bk provided with
the new unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement Adjustment"
section. It is not necessary to input the values for the other colors; these are automatically
adjusted after doing the line position adjustment.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
2193
001
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
002 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode after job
end.
003
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode after job end.
Page: Interrupt: BW+FC
*ENG
004 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode during
job.
005
376
Page: Interrupt: FC
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode during jobs.
Main SP Tables-2
Page: Stand-By: BW
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
006 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW printing mode reaches
the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is
satisfied.
Page: Stand-By: FC
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for FC printing mode in stand-by mode.
007 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in color printing mode
reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009
is satisfied.
Temp.
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1deg/step]
008 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment
once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions.
Time
*ENG
009 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Magnification
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 0.1 / 0.01%/step]
010 Adjusts the magnification threshold for line position adjustment. If the length of the main scan
is changed by this amount since the previous MUSIC, then MSUIC is done again.
Temp. 2
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1deg/step]
011 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment
twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions.
Time 2
*ENG
012 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Page: Power ON:BW+FC
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and FC printing mode at power013 on. The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW and color printing
mode reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or
SP2-193-009 is satisfied.
377
5. System Maintenance
2194
001
002
003
004
005
006
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 year/step]
*ENG
[1 to 12 / 1 / 1 month/step]
*ENG
[1 to 31 / 1 / 1 day/step]
*ENG
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1 hour/step]
*ENG
[0 to 59 / 0 / 1 minute/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]
*ENG
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
*ENG
0: Not done
1: Completed successfully
2: Cannot detect patterns
3: Fewer lines on the pattern than the target
*ENG
4: Not used
5: Out of the adjustment range
6 to 9: Not used
2198
378
Main SP Tables-2
2220
*ENG
Adjusts the fixed LD power for each line speed and color.
These SPs are activated only when SP3-041-002 is set to "0".
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
379
5. System Maintenance
Development bias is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, adjusting these
settings has no effect while Process Control (SP3-041-001 Default: ON) is activated.
After deactivating Process Control with SP3-041-001, the values in these SP modes are used
for printing.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2241
[Temperature/Humidity: Display]
Displays the environment temperature and humidity.
001 Temperature
2302
380
Main SP Tables-2
001
Current Environmental
Display
*ENG
003
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 1
*ENG
004
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 2
*ENG
005
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 3
*ENG
006
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 4
*ENG
2308
*ENG
001 Threshold 1
*ENG
Threshold 1 paper:
Paper is detected as "S1" size.
[0 to 350 / 257 / 1 mm/step]
002 Threshold 2
*ENG
381
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
004 Threshold 4
*ENG
2311
*ENG
*ENG
2326
001
002
*ENG
Adjusts the positive voltage of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Negative
*ENG
Adjusts the negative current of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Positive
*ENG
003 Adjusts the negative current limit of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer
roller.
004 Negative
2351
382
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
001
002
003
2357
001
002
003
004
005
006
007
008
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 2 paper or FINE mode.
[Common: FC: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: Full Color: Bias Adjustment
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
ITB unit: Plain: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: M
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: C
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: Y
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: M
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: C
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Y
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
383
5. System Maintenance
009
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: M
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
010 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
011
*ENG
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: Y
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]
012 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
2360
384
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 31 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 13/ 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 31 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]
Main SP Tables-2
[Plain: Bias]
2401
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]
004
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 27 / 1 A /step]
002
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
003
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]
004
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
385
5. System Maintenance
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
386
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
004
*ENG
005
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
009
*ENG
010
*ENG
011
*ENG
012
*ENG
013
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
014
*ENG
015
*ENG
016
*ENG
017
*ENG
018
*ENG
019
*ENG
020
*ENG
2421
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
387
5. System Maintenance
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2401 is multiplied by these SPs values.
2421
005-008
*ENG
006
*ENG
*ENG
008
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
*ENG
003
*ENG
004
*ENG
388
*ENG
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Main SP Tables-2
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2424.
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
004
*ENG
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
389
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[Thin: Bias]
2451
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 2000 / 10 V/
step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
390
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Main SP Tables-2
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2471
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.
*ENG
*ENG
2471
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2451 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.
391
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed,
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
2473
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2474.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
392
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
2480
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
2481
001
2482
001
2483
001
2484
[Glossy: Bias]
Separation DC: 1st Side
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in black-and-white mode.
[Glossy: Bias: FC]
Paper Transfer: 1st Side
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in full color mode.
[Glossy: Paper Size Correction]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
393
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2485
2486
*ENG
*ENG
2487
*ENG
*ENG
2488
*ENG
*ENG
2489
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[Thick 1: Bias]
2501
394
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 24 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
395
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
396
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
2521
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2522.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
397
5. System Maintenance
2523
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2524.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2530
398
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
2551
[Thick 2: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick 2 paper.
*ENG
*ENG
2553
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
2558
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 16 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
399
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.
400
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
2571
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2551 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
5
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2mm/step]
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2574.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
401
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2580
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 53 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
2601
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
2608
[0 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[OHP: Bias]
001 Separation DC
2603
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
402
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.
2621
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2601 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.
002 Separation DC
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
002 Separation DC
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
403
5. System Maintenance
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2624.
*ENG
002 Separation DC
*ENG
*ENG
[100 to 0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
002 Separation DC
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
001 Separation DC
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
2630
2650
[Thick3: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 3.
*ENG
*ENG
2651
404
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Main SP Tables-2
2652
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
405
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.
*ENG
*ENG
2654
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.
*ENG
*ENG
406
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Main SP Tables-2
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2657.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]
407
5. System Maintenance
2670
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[Thick4: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 4.
*ENG
*ENG
2671
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
2672
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1
*ENG
*ENG
408
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2675.
*ENG
*ENG
2674
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.
409
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2677.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
410
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Main SP Tables-2
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[Special1: Bias]
2751
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode.
P Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
411
5. System Maintenance
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
412
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
2771
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2771
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2751 is multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
413
5. System Maintenance
2773
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2774.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2780
414
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[Special2: Bias]
2801
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
415
5. System Maintenance
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
416
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
2821
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2821
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2801 is multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
417
5. System Maintenance
2823
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2824.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2830
418
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[Special 3: Bias]
2851
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
419
5. System Maintenance
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
420
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-2
2871
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2871
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2851 is multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
421
5. System Maintenance
2873
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2874.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2880
422
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
Main SP Tables-2
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
Specified the time of the development roller reverse rotation after the development unit has
stopped. The reverse rotation of the development roller is used for removing dust from the
development roller.
001 K
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 80 / 10 msec/step]
All
*ENG
Specified the threshold distance for the development roller reverse mode. This sp refers to
the counters for SP2905-006 to -009.
[Dev Rvs Counter]
006 K
*ENG
007 M
*ENG
008 C
*ENG
009 Y
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step]
423
5. System Maintenance
2907
Adjusts the threshold for moving away the image transfer belt from the color PCDUs. This SP
moves the image transfer belt away from the color PCDUs when the number of B/W image
printouts reaches the number of sheets specified with this SP after consecutive full color image
printouts in the full color mode.
If this SP is set to "0", the image transfer belt does not move away.
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]
002 Displays the number of the ITB encodre error. SC443 is displayed if this counter counts to
"3".
[SecondaryFB: Threshold] Paper Transfer Roller Feed-back: Threshold Adjustment
2930
Adjusts the threshold between high resistance (division 1) and low resistance (division 2) at
the paper transfer roller. This SP affects SP2931 to SP2939.
001 Voltage
2960
001
2970
[Process Interval]
Additional Time
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
001
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 50 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning
Specifies the threshold sheets for the cleaning of the paper transfer roller without the refresh
mode.
424
Main SP Tables-2
002 Refresh
2971
001
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning, 1: Cleaning
*ENG
Adjusts the timing for the non-image area bias of the image transfer roller.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5000 / 0 / 10 page/step]
*ENG
[0 to 940 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 940 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 940 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]
2972
2973
001 2974
2980
2990
425
5. System Maintenance
426
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 195 / 30 / 10 min./step]
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
0: No limit, 1: Limit
004
*ENG
[0 to 5000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
005
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
[0 to 5000 / 1 / 1 page/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
Main SP Tables-3
SP3-XXX (Process)
3011
001 Normal
003 Pre-ACC
All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order Y C M K
e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were
successful.
See the "Error Condition Tables" in the "Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" section
for details.
427
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3013
003 Execution: Bk
004 Execution: M
005 Execution: C
006 Execution: Y
3014
*ENG
Displays the developer initialization result. See section "Developer Initialization Result" in the
001 "Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" section for details on the meaning of each
code.
All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y C M Bk.
e.g., 1 (Y) 2 (C) 1 (M) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.
428
Main SP Tables-3
3015
003 Execution: Bk
004 Execution: M
005 Execution: C
006 Execution: Y
3016
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3041
[0 to 30 / 4 / 1 sec/step]
001
Voltage Control
*ENG
LD Power Control
*ENG
429
5. System Maintenance
AutoControl Prohibition
003 Set
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Permit, 1: Forbid
Pre-ACC
*ENG
1: Process Control
2: TC Control (TD Adjustment)
3: Not used
Pattern Calculation
005 Method
*ENG
0: FIXED
1: INITIALIZED
2: CALCULATED
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at power on.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
001 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: Initialization
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at the developer
initialization.
002
430
Main SP Tables-3
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment in stand by mode.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
003 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: ACC
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at ACC.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
004 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
005
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]
Not used
Repeat Number: Job End
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at job end.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
006 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat: Interrupt
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
007 Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment during printing.
DFU
008
*ENG
Adjusts the time for the toner supply mode when a toner density is detected to be low.
431
5. System Maintenance
Consumption pattern: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
009 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the black toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: M
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
010 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the magenta toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: C
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
011 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the cyan toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: Y
*ENG
012 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the yellow toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
013
014
015
016
017
T1 Bias: Bk
*ENG
018
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
432
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-001) exceed the target values (SP3611-005) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Main SP Tables-3
*ENG
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-002) exceed the target values (SP3611-006) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: C
020
*ENG
3044
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-003) exceed the target values (SP3611-007) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-004) exceed the target values (SP3611-008) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
[Toner Supply Type] Toner Supply Type ([Color])
Selects the toner supply method type.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3045
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
0: FIXED (with the supply rates stored with SP 3401)
1: PID (Vtref_Fixed)
2: PID (Vtref_Control)
3: Not used
001 ON/OFF
*ENG
Adjusts the number of times toner supply is attempted for each color when the TD sensor
continues to detect toner end during toner recovery.
433
5. System Maintenance
001 Repeat: Bk
*ENG
002 Repeat: M
*ENG
003 Repeat: C
*ENG
004 Repeat: Y
*ENG
3131
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3201
[1 to 20 / 5 / 1 time/step]
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: M
*ENG
003 Current: C
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
434
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
3221
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: M
*ENG
003 Current: C
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
005-008 Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization. DFU
3222
005 Initial: Bk
*ENG
006 Initial: M
*ENG
007 Initial: C
*ENG
008 Initial: Y
*ENG
[Vtref: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color.
435
5. System Maintenance
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: M
*ENG
003 Current: C
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
005-008 Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization. DFU
005 Initial: Bk
*ENG
006 Initial: M
*ENG
007 Initial: C
*ENG
008 Initial: Y
*ENG
009-012 Displays and adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color. DFU
3239
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
002 (+)Consumption: M
*ENG
003 (+)Consumption: C
*ENG
004 (+)Consumption: Y
*ENG
005 (-)Consumption: Bk
*ENG
006 (-)Consumption: M
*ENG
007 (-)Consumption: C
*ENG
008 (-)Consumption: Y
*ENG
436
Main SP Tables-3
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
013-014 Threshold for image density rank on the image transfer belt.
3241
*ENG
*ENG
001 Coefficient: Bk
*ENG
002 Coefficient: M
*ENG
003 Coefficient: C
*ENG
004 Coefficient: Y
*ENG
005 Offset: Bk
*ENG
006 Offset: M
*ENG
007 Offset: C
*ENG
008 Offset: Y
*ENG
3242
001 StdSpd:Coefficient: Bk
*ENG
002 StdSpd:Coefficient: M
*ENG
003 StdSpd:Coefficient: C
*ENG
004 StdSpd:Coefficient: Y
*ENG
005 StdSpd:Offset: Bk
*ENG
006 StdSpd:Offset: M
*ENG
437
5. System Maintenance
007 StdSpd:Offset: C
*ENG
008 StdSpd:Offset: Y
*ENG
009 MidSpd:coef:Bk
*ENG
010 MidSpd:coef:M
*ENG
011 MidSpd:coef:C
*ENG
012 MidSpd:coef:Y
*ENG
013 MidSpd:offset:Bk
*ENG
014 MidSpd:offset:M
*ENG
015 MidSpd:offset:C
*ENG
016 MidSpd:offset:Y
*ENG
017 LowSpd:Coef:Bk
*ENG
018 LowSpd:Coef:M
*ENG
019 LowSpd:Coef:C
*ENG
020 LowSpd:Coef:Y
*ENG
021 LowSpd:offset:Bk
*ENG
022 LowSpd:offset:M
*ENG
023 LowSpd:offset:C
*ENG
024 LowSpd:offset:Y
*ENG
3251
438
[Coverage]
These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012.
001 Latest Pixel: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-017.
005 Average S: Bk
*ENG
006 Average S: M
*ENG
007 Average S: C
*ENG
008 Average S: Y
*ENG
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-018.
009 Average M: Bk
*ENG
010 Average M: M
*ENG
011 Average M: C
*ENG
012 Average M: Y
*ENG
5
[0 to 100 / 5 / 0.01 %/step]
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3-251-019.
013 Average L: Bk
*ENG
014 Average L: M
*ENG
015 Average L: C
*ENG
016 Average L: Y
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 100 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 100 / 40 / 1 sheet/step]
439
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
028
5
3311
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
005 Voffset dif: M
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3321
440
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
3322
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
441
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3401
9: Unexpected error
3: Offset voltage error
2: Vsg adjustment value error
1: O.K
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
*ENG
3411
001 Latest: Bk
*ENG
002 Latest: M
*ENG
003 Latest: C
*ENG
004 Latest: Y
*ENG
3421
442
[0 to 100 / - / 1 %/step]
Main SP Tables-3
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
*ENG
3501
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3510
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
005 MUSIC: BW
*ENG
006 MUSIC: FC
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
443
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
3511
444
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF), 1: Correct (ON)
026
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01/step]
027
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
Main SP Tables-3
028
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.01/step]
029
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 5 / 1/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
3512
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 page/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 minute/step]
001 Year
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1/step]
002 Month
*ENG
[1 to 12 / 1 / 1/step]
003 Date
*ENG
[1 to 31 / 1 / 1/step]
004 Hour
*ENG
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]
005 Minute
*ENG
[0 to 59 / 0 / 1/step]
001 Temperature
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1%RH/step]
*ENG
445
5. System Maintenance
001
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt
cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this value, toner is applied
to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over.
3519
[0 to 50 / 40 / 1C/step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
002 MUSIC
*ENG
003 TC Adj.
*ENG
3520
446
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
001 Temperature: H
*ENG
002 Temperature: M
*ENG
003 Temperature: L
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 3 / 0 / 1 revolution/step]
[Temperature Threshold]
3521
Specifies the threshold temperature for each condition. These settings affect the conditions
of SP3-520.
t1: Threshold between L (low temp.) and M (medium temp.)
t2: Threshold between M (medium temp.) and H (high temps)
001 Threshold: t2
*ENG
[20 or 30 / 25 / 1 deg/step]
002 Threshold: t1
*ENG
[0 or 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
[Rapi_timer]
100 Time Setting
447
5. System Maintenance
When the current condition has changed by more than the values of these SPs when
compared with the conditions at the previous operation, the process control at stand-by is
executed.
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 time/step]
3611
448
001 Bk (Current)
*ENG
002 M (Current)
*ENG
003 C (Current)
*ENG
004 Y (Current)
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 99 / 20 / 1 g/m3/step]
3612
[Vk Display]
Displays Vk for each color.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
449
5. System Maintenance
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the charge DC voltage adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.
450
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the LD power adjusted for each environment.
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
451
5. System Maintenance
3711
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3712
452
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
Main SP Tables-3
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3713
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
453
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3714
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3800
454
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
001 Condition
*CTL
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
*CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
*CTL
[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
Main SP Tables-3
*CTL
008 Coefficient
*ENG
Notice Setting
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Enable @Remote calling
1: Disable @Remote calling
011
NOTE:
If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near
full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full.
In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1".
Day Threshold: Toner
Collection bottle:NF
*ENG
[1 to 30 / 5 / 1 day/step]
012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is
displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection
bottle.
013 Total:Toner Collection Bottle
014
3900
*ENG
3901
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
455
5. System Maintenance
Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off.
The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section
3 (Replacement and Adjustment).
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
005 Developer: Bk
*ENG
006 Developer: Y
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
007 Developer: C
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
008 Developer: M
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
456
*ENG
Main SP Tables-4
Main SP Tables-4
SP4-XXX (Scanner)
4008
001
*ENG
Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the scanning start timing in the sub-scan
direction.
001 -
*ENG
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the scanning start timing in the main scan
direction.
001 -
*ENG
Sets the blank margin at each side for erasing the original shadow caused by the gap
between the original and the scale.
*ENG
*ENG
457
5. System Maintenance
Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.
Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT
4014
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
[Scan]
Execute the scanner free fun with each mode.
4020
[Dust Check]
Turns the ADF scan glass dust check on/ off.
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Selects the detect level.
*ENG
[0 to 8 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: lowest detection level
8: highest detection level
Selects the level of the sub scan line correction
when using the ARDF.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
*ENG
0: Off
1: Weakest
2: Weak
3: Strong
4: Strongest
458
*ENG
Not used
*ENG
Not used
Main SP Tables-4
Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. (See "Input
Check Table" in this section.)
4303
001
*ENG
0: No Original
1: A5-Lengthwise (16K SEF if 4305 is set to 3)
2: A5-Sideways (16K LEF if 4305 is set to 3)
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]
4305
[8K/16K Detection]
*ENG
001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.
4308
*ENG
0: OFF
1: ON
001
Turns on or off the CCD original size detection. This detection is used only when an original
is scanned in book scanning mode.
4309
459
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 32 / 1 digit/step]
001 Specifies the threshold between an original area and non-original area for the scan original
size detection in book scanning mode.
002 Detection Time
*ENG
Specifies the detection time for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
003 Lamp ON:Delay Time
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec/step]
Specifies the lamp on timing for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
[Scan Size Detect Value]
4310
Displays the detected value by CCD. Each detection point for paper size and color is
displayed on the LCD.
001 S1:R
*ENG
002 S1:G
*ENG
003 S1:B
*ENG
004 S2:R
*ENG
005 S2:G
*ENG
006 S2:B
*ENG
007 S3:R
*ENG
008 S3:G
*ENG
009 S3:B
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
460
Main SP Tables-4
4417
[0 to 24 / 0 / 1/step ]
0: Scanned image
6: Grid pattern
8: Gradation RGBCMYK
9: UCR pattern
001 Copy
002 Scanner
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
003 Fax
461
5. System Maintenance
4450
002
4501
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
4505
462
[ACC Cor:Bright]
Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.
001 Text:K
*ENG
002 Text:C
*ENG
003 Text:M
*ENG
004 Text:Y
*ENG
005 Photo:K
*ENG
006 Photo:C
*ENG
007 Photo:M
*ENG
008 Photo:Y
*ENG
Main SP Tables-4
4506
[ACC Cor:Dark]
Adjusts the offset correction for dark areas of the ACC pattern.
001 Text:K
*ENG
002 Text:C
*ENG
003 Text:M
*ENG
004 Text:Y
*ENG
005 Photo:K
*ENG
006 Photo:C
*ENG
007 Photo:M
*ENG
008 Photo:Y
*ENG
This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 Colors [R, G, B,
Option]) for a total of 48 parameters.
*ENG
463
5. System Maintenance
4600
001 SBU_ID
002 GASBU-N_ID
003 VSP5100_ID
4602
4603
[AGC Execution]
DFU
4609
002 DF Read
4610
002 DF Read
4623
464
Not used
Main SP Tables-4
4624
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4625
4628
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
465
5. System Maintenance
4629
4630
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Red.
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Digital Adjustment]
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
4645
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4633
466
4632
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4631
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Main SP Tables-4
4647
001 Power-ON
4654
001
*ENG
*ENG
4655
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
4656
467
5. System Maintenance
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
4658
4659
Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Displays the previous gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
4662
468
*ENG
4661
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4660
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Main SP Tables-4
4663
*ENG
*ENG
4673
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 16383 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4674
*ENG
4675
*ENG
469
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
4677
4678
Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Green.
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
4682
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Displays the factory setting values of the gain adjustment for Blue.
4681
470
*ENG
4680
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4679
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Main SP Tables-4
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF or 1-pass DF.
Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.
001 ARDF
*ENG
002 1-pass DF
*ENG
4690
001 RE
002 RO
4691
002 GO
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 BE
002 BO
4693
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 GE
4692
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 RE
002 RO
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
471
5. System Maintenance
4694
001 GE
002 GO
4695
001 BE
002 BO
4802
002 Lamp ON
[Home Position]
001 4806
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4804
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[Carriage Save]
Moves the carriage from the scanner home
position.
001 -
4807
472
Main SP Tables-4
[0 to 250 / 0 / 1 /step]
1: Grid pattern
001 -
4808
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution.
A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 R DATA1
*ENG
002 G DATA1
*ENG
003 B DATA1
*ENG
004 R DATA2
*ENG
005 G DATA2
*ENG
006 B DATA2
*ENG
Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for yellow in Photo mode.
See Printer Gamma Correction" in the Replacement and Adjustment for how to use.
009 -
4954
[Read/Restore Std]
473
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
[0 to 11 / 2 / 1 /step ]
001
4993
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest sensitivity
9: strongest sensitivity
Selects the range level of Highlight correction.
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest skew correction,
9: strongest skew correction
4994
001
*ENG
0: Text priority
1: Normal
2: Photo priority
474
Main SP Tables-5
Main SP Tables-5
SP5-XXX (Mode)
5024
*CTL
0: mm (Europe/Asia)
1: inch (USA)
[Accounting Counter]
5045
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 Counter Method
*CTL
0: Developments
1: Prints
5047
[Paper Display]
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
001 -
5051
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
[TonerRefillDetectionDisplay]
Enables or disables the toner refill detection display.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ] Alphanumeric
*CTL
0: ON
1: OFF
5055
[Display IP Address]
Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.
475
5. System Maintenance
001 -
5056
476
0: OFF 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display
001 -
5062
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 -
5061
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
*CTL
*CTL
009 Developer: Bk
*CTL
010 Developer: M
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
011 Developer: C
*CTL
012 Developer: Y
*CTL
Main SP Tables-5
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5066
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display
001 -
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
477
5. System Maintenance
009 Developer:Bk
*CTL
010 Developer:M
*CTL
011 Developer:C
*CTL
012 Developer:Y
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5104*
5071
001
5113
478
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On
Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up prevents
mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation panel and an actual paper
size on the by-pass tray.
[Optional Counter Type]
Main SP Tables-5
*CTL
0: None
*CTL
1: Expansion Device 1
2: Expansion Device 2
3: Expansion Device 3
5114
5118
[Disable Copying]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5120
001
5121
001
This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove
an optional counter, check the settings.
[Counter Up Timing]
*CTL
This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to "paper feed" and
"paper exit" respectively.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
5126
*ENG
479
5. System Maintenance
[APS Mode]
*CTL
5148
*ENG
The program selects a paper size system from the following alternatives: the AB system (0),
the LT system (1), and the AF system (2).
Size Detection Off
*CTL
0: Detecte
1: Not Detecte
5150
*CTL
Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not.
001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600
mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
5162
*CTL
001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.
[Fax Printing Mode at Optional]
5167
Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. This SP is used
when the receiving fax is accounted by an external accounting device.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing
[CE Login]
5169
480
If you will change the printer bit switches, you must log in to service mode with this SP before
you go into the printer SP mode.
Main SP Tables-5
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 CE Login
*CTL
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
5181
[Size Adjust]
Adjusts the paper size for each tray.
*ENG
002 TRAY 2: 1
*ENG
003 TRAY 2: 2
*ENG
004 TRAY 2: 3
*ENG
005 TRAY 2: 4
*ENG
*ENG
007 TRAY 3: 2
*ENG
008 TRAY 3: 3
*ENG
009 TRAY 3: 4
*ENG
010 TRAY 4: 1
*ENG
011 TRAY 4: 2
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT
481
5. System Maintenance
012 TRAY 4: 3
*ENG
013 TRAY 4: 4
*ENG
018 LCT
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF, 2: B5LEF
[RK 4]
5186
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001 -
*ENG
0: Disable
1: Enable
5188
[Copy NvVersion]
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.
001 5193
Sets the external controller type. This setting is appropriately adjusted if an external controller
is installed in the machine.
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1/step]
001 0: No external controller installed
1: EFI controller
2: Ratio controller
3: Egret controller
4 to 10: Reserved
5199
482
Main SP Tables-5
001 -
[ 0 or 1 / 0 / -]
*CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
Enables or disables the paper feeding out from the finisher without stapling.
If this setting is "1: ON", paper is fed out without stapling at the maximum number of
the finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum
number).
If this setting is "0: OFF", paper is fed out with stapling at the maximum number of the
finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum number).
5212
[Page Numbering]
*CTL
This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers.
A " value" moves the page number positions to the left edge. A "+ value" moves the page
number positions to the right edge.
003
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
004
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[Set Time]
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
DOM: +540 (Tokyo)
5302
5307
*CTL
#
[Summer Time]
483
5. System Maintenance
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
NA and EUR: 1, ASIA: 0
484
Main SP Tables-5
5404
5411
[LDAP Certification]
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Password NULL not permitted.
1: Password NULL permitted.
*CTL
5413
[Lockout Setting]
485
5. System Maintenance
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off (no wait time, lockout not cancelled)
*CTL
*CTL
Not Used
[Access Mitigation]
*CTL
*CTL
5415
486
[Password Attack]
Main SP Tables-5
*CTL
*CTL
5416
[Access Information]
*CTL
*CTL
5417
[Access Attack]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
487
5. System Maintenance
*CTL
[User Authentication]
5420
001 Copy
*CTL
*CTL
Enables or disables the color copy limitation for each copy mode when the user
authentication is "ON".
0: Enable (default), 1: Disable
002
011 DocumentServer
*CTL
021 Fax
*CTL
488
Main SP Tables-5
031 Scanner
*CTL
041 Printer
*CTL
051 SDK1
061 SDK2
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
*CTL
071 SDK3
5481
*CTL
*CTL
5490
*CTL
*CTL
489
5. System Maintenance
5501
[PM Alarm]
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 PM Alarm Level
0: Alarm off
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value (1 to 9999) x 1000
> PM counter
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
5504
[Jam Alarm]
0: No alarm sounds
1: Alarm sounds after the number of originals passing
through the ARDF > 10,000
*CTL
Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
001
0: Zero (Off)
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
3: High (6K jams)
[Error Alarm]
Sets the error alarm level.
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm
counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a set number of copied sheets
(for example, default 1500 sheets).
5505
The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5".
001 -
5508*
001*
490
*CTL
[CC Call]
*CTL -
Jam Remains
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Main SP Tables-5
002*
003*
Continuous Jams
0: Disable, 1: Enable
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute /step]
011* Sets the time a jam must remain before it becomes an "unattended paper jam". This setting
is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Jam Detection: Continuous Count
[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]
012* Sets the number of consecutive paper jams required to initiate a call. This setting is enabled
only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Door Open: Time Length
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 /step]
013* Sets the length of time the door remains open before the machine initiates a call.
This setting is enabled only when SP5-508-004 is set to "1".
[SC/Alarm Setting]
*CTL
5515
With NRS (New Remote Service) in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when
an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error
occurs.
001
SC Call
002
003
004
User Call
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Off
1: On
491
5. System Maintenance
006
007
008
Alarm Notice
009
010
011
012
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
5516
0: Off
1: On
*CTL
With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call when one of SP
parts reaches its yield.
001
005
006
001
5611
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
Factory Setting
*ENG
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
492
Main SP Tables-5
B-M
002
*ENG
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
G-C
003
*ENG
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
G-Y
004
*ENG
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-M
005
*ENG
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-Y
006
*ENG
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
5618
*CTL
[Memory Clear]
493
5. System Maintenance
002 Engine
003 SCS
005 Mcs
Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX settings,
local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer.
The following service settings:
Bit switches
Gamma settings (User & Service)
Toner Limit
Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the
scanner SP modes.
011 NCS
012 R-Fax
014 Clear DCS Setting
494
Main SP Tables-5
017 CCS
019 LCS
021 ECS
[FreeRun]
Performs a free run on the copier engine.
5802
The machine starts free run in the same condition as the sequence of A4/LT, A3 or
A4 SEF printing from the 1st or 2nd tray. Therefore, the correct paper should be
loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is not fed.
The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode for a test.
001 B/W A4 LEF
002 FC A4 LEF
003 FC A3 LEF
5803
[Input Check]
5804
[Output Check]
5805
[Anti-Condensation Heater]
002 0:OFF / 1:ON
*ENG
495
5. System Maintenance
[SC Reset]
5810
5811
5812
004 BICU
Inputs
*CTL
001 Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List, which can be printed with the users "Counter" menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Facsimile
*CTL
002 Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Supply
*CTL
003 Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number
and press #.
Operation
*CTL
004 Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press
#.
5816
496
[Remote Service]
*CTL
Main SP Tables-5
I/F Setting
Selects the remote service setting.
001
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]
0: Remote service off
1: CSS remote service on
2: NRS remote service on
CE Call
Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service.
002
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to "2".
Function Flag
Enables or disables the remote service function.
003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
SSL Disable
007
008 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the time-out when the RCG (Remote Communication
Gate) connects during a call via the @Remote network.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step]
497
5. System Maintenance
011
Controls if permission is given to get access to the SOAP method over Port 80 on the
@Remote network.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: No. Access denied
1: Yes. Access granted.
RFU Timing
498
Main SP Tables-5
Proxy Host
This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between the RCG
device and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server address.
063
The address display is limited to 128 characters. Characters beyond the 128
character are ignored.
This address is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy PortNumber
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between the
embedded RCG-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up the embedded
064
RCG-N.
This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy User Name
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name.
065
The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
499
5. System Maintenance
Proxy Password
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password.
066
The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
067
500
CERT:Up State
Displays the status of the certification update.
0
The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW
URL and certification is presently being updated.
The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
successful update.
The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update.
The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being
sent to the GW URL.
11
A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting
is in progress for the rescue GW connection.
12
The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
certification update request.
13
The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully,
and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW
URL.
14
The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW
controller, and the certification is being stored.
15
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful
completion of this event.
16
The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
failure of this event.
Main SP Tables-5
17
The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, the GW URL
was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but an certification
error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.
18
The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being
notified of the failure of the certification update.
CERT:Error
Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the
certification.
068
Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired.
An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired.
069 CERT:Up ID
501
5. System Maintenance
Displays the start time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.
Displays the end time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.
Selection Country
Select the country where embedded RCG-M is installed in the machine. After selecting the
country, you must also set the following SP codes for embedded RCG-M:
150
SP5816-153
SP5816-154
SP5816-161
0: Japan, 1: USA, 2: Canada, 3: UK, 4: Germany, 5: France, 6: Italy,
7: Netherlands, 8: Belgium, 9: Luxembourg, 10: Spain
Line Type AutomaticJudgment
Press [Execute].
Setting this SP classifies the telephone line where embedded RCG-M is connected as either
dial-up (pulse dial) or push (DTMF tone) type, so embedded RCG-M can automatically
151 distinguish the number that connects to the outside line.
The current progress, success, or failure of this execution can be displayed with
SP5816-152.
If the execution succeeded, SP5816-153 will display the result for confirmation and
SP5816-154 will display the telephone number for the connection to the outside line.
502
Main SP Tables-5
Selection Dial/Push
This SP displays the classification (tone or pulse) of the telephone line to the access point
for embedded RCG-M. The number displayed (0 or 1) is the result of the execution of
SP5816-151. However, this setting can also be changed manually.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
153 0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone
Inside Japan "2" may also be displayed:
0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone 10PPS
2: Pulse Dialing Phone 20PPS
503
5. System Maintenance
156
Use this SP to set a user name for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Dial Up Password
157
Use this SP to set a password for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Local Phone Number
161 Use this SP to set the telephone number of the line where embedded RCG-M is connected.
This number is transmitted to and used by the Call Center to return calls.
Limit: 24 numbers (numbers only)
Connection Timing Adjustment: Incoming
When the Call Center calls out to an embedded RCG-M modem, it sends a repeating ID
tone (*#1#). This SP sets the time the line remains open to send these ID tones after the
162 number of the embedded RCG-M modem is dialed up and connected.
[0 to 24 / 1 / 1 /step]
The actual amount of time is this setting x 2 sec. For example, if you set "2" the line will
remain open for 4 sec.
504
Main SP Tables-5
Access Point
This is the number of the dial-up access point for RCG-M. If no setting is done for this SP
163 code, then a preset value (determined by the country selected) is used.
Default: 0
Allowed: Up to 16 alphanumeric characters
164 Line Connecting
This SP sets the connection conditions for the customer. This setting dedicates the line to
RCG-M only, or sets the line for sharing between RCG-M and a fax unit.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Sharing Fax
1: No Sharing Fax
If this setting is changed, the copier must be cycled off and on.
SP5816 187 determines whether the off-hook button can be used to interrupt a RCGM transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction.
173 Modem Serial Number
Retransmission Limit
Normally, it is best to allow unlimited time for certification and ID2 update requests, and
for the notification that the certification has been completed. However, RCG-M generates
174 charges based on transmission time for the customer, so a limit is placed upon the time
allowed for these transactions.
If these transactions cannot be completed within the allowed time, do this SP to cancel the
time restriction.
FAX TX Priority
This SP determines whether pushing the off-hook button will interrupt a RCG-M transmission
in progress to open the line for fax transaction. This SP can be used only if SP5816 164 is
187
set to "0".
[0 or 1/ 0 / - ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
200 Manual Polling
505
5. System Maintenance
Regist: Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the registered device by the external nor embedded RCG device is set.
1: The embedded RCG device is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this status,
this
unit cannot answer a polling request from the external RCG.
201
2. The embedded RCG device is set. In this status, the external RCG unit cannot answer a
polling request.
3. The registered device by the external RCG is being set. In this status the embedded RCG
device cannot be set.
4 The registered module by the external RCG has not started.
Allows entry of the number of the request needed for the RCGN device.
506
Main SP Tables-5
Register Result
Displays a number that indicates the registration result.
0: Succeeded
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
5: Proxy error (Illegal user name or password)
6: Communication error
7: Certification update error
8: Other error
9: Registration executing
Code
Meaning
-11001
-11003
Unexpected error
-12002
-12003
-12005
507
5. System Maintenance
-12006
-12007
-12009
-12010
-2385
-2387
-2389
-2390
-2391
5821
Parameter error
Basil not managed
-2394
-2395
-2396
-2397
-2398
508
*CTL
Main SP Tables-5
Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the
NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in this
section.
001 NV-RAM Data Upload
Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the
"NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in this section.
001 NV-RAM Download
5828
[Network Setting]
1284 Compatibility
050
(Centro)
*CTL
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
This SP is activated only when SP5-828-50 is set to "1".
Enables/disables Job Spooling.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
509
5. System Maintenance
bit1: FTP
bit2: IPP
bit3: SMB
bit4: BMLinkS
bit5: DIPRINT
bit6: sftp
bit7: (Reserved)
[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Enables or disables the Web operation.
[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
145
510
Main SP Tables-5
147
149
151
Displays or does not display the link to Net RICOH on the top
page and link page of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display
511
5. System Maintenance
Displays or does not display the link to URL1 on the top page
of the web system.
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1]
0: Not display, 1:Display
5832
512
Same as "-239"
Same as "-240"
Same as "-241"
*CTL
Main SP Tables-5
[Capture Settings]
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)
*CTL
0: Disable, 1: Enable
001 With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot be initialized,
displayed, or selected.
002
Panel Setting
5. System Maintenance
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]
091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via
the MLB with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.
514
Main SP Tables-5
113 Secondary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
114 Secondary srv URL path
[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]
121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Copy (Mono)
[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]
122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
Reso: Print (Color)
123
Selects the resolution for color print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Print (Mono)
124
Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
515
5. System Maintenance
Selects the resolution for color fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Color)
127 Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Mono)
128 Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
5840
[IEEE 802.11]
[1 to 11 or 13 / 11 or 13 / 1 /step]
Channel Max
*CTL
Europe/Asia: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
006 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.
516
Main SP Tables-5
[1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]
Channel Min
*CTL
Europe: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
007 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.
0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]
0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 - 55M Fix
0 x 10 - 48M Fix
0 x 0F - 36M Fix
0 x 0E - 18M Fix
0 x 0D - 12M Fix
008 Transmission Speed
*CTL
0 x 0B - 9M Fix
0 x 0A - 6M Fix
0 x 07 - 11M Fix
0 x 05 - 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 - 1M Fix
0 x 13 - 0 x FE (reserved)
0 x 12 - 72M (reserved)
0 x 09 - 22M (reserved)
Selects the WEP key.
[00 to 11 / 00 / 1 binary]
*CTL
00: Key #1
01: Key #2 (Reserved)
10: Key #3 (Reserved)
11: Key #4 (Reserved)
517
5. System Maintenance
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.
*CTL
*CTL
5841
518
Main SP Tables-5
001
002
003
004
007
OrgStamp
011
Staple Std1
012
Staple Std2
013
Staple Std3
014
Staple Std4
021
Staple Bind 1
022
Staple Blind2
023
Staple Blind 3
5844
[USB]
001
Transfer Rate
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
003 Product ID
*CTL
*CTL
5845
*CTL
Sets the FTP port number used when image files to the Scan Router Server.
519
5. System Maintenance
IP Address (Primary)
002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab
can be referenced by the initial system setting.
Delivery Error Display Time
006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a
test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external
device.
IP Address (Secondary)
008 Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary
delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without
reference to the DNS setting.
Delivery Server Model
[0 to 4/ 0 / 1 /step]
Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device.
0: Unknown
009 1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
010 Delivery Svr. Capability
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
520
Main SP Tables-5
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
011
Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user)
Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link
Bit5 to 0: Not used
013
014
015
016
017
018
022
Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error.
[0 to 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
5846
[UCS Settings]
*CTL
Displays ID
001 Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only
displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394 EUI.
The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.
521
5. System Maintenance
Clears ID
002 Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute
this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the ID,
the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on.
Maximum Entries
003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the
data (excluding user code information) is displayed.
Delivery Server Retry Timer
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
006 Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server
address book.
Delivery Server Retry Times
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server
address book.
Delivery Server Maximum Entries
008 Sets the maximum number account entries of the delivery server user information managed
by UCS.
010
020
040
522
[1 to 255 / 60 / 1 /step]
Sets the length of the timeout for the search of the LDAP server.
WSD Maximum Entries
Sets the maximum entries for the address book of the WSD (WS-scanner).
Addr Book Migration (USB => HDD)
Not used in this machine.
Main SP Tables-5
Procedure
1. Turn the machine off.
2. Install the new HDD.
3. Turn the machine on.
4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically.
5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system administrator
or key operator.
6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846-041. After this SP executes successfully, any user can
access the address book.
Displays the slot number where an address book data is in.
[0 to 30 / - /1]
0: Unconfirmed
043 Addr Book Media
1: SD Slot 1
2: SD Slot 2
4: USB Flash ROM
20: HDD
30: Nothing
047
048
Initialize Delivery Addr Clears the distribution address book information, except the user
Book
code.
049
Clears the LDAP address book information, except the user code.
523
5. System Maintenance
Bit: Meaning
060
062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP does not normally require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password
policy to control access to the address book.
063 Complexity Option 2 DFU
064 Complexity Option 3 DFU
065 Complexity Option 4 DFU
524
Main SP Tables-5
5847
*CTL
SP5847-1 through SP5847-8 changes the default settings of image data transferred
externally by the Net File page reference function. [ 0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
SP5847-21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile.
"Net files" are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the
DeskTopBinder software.
001 Rate for Copy Color
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
006 Rate for Printer Color 1200dpi
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
525
5. System Maintenance
[Web Service]
*CTL
5848 2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. Setting of 0001 has
no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.
5848
5848 100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The default is equal
to 1 gigabyte.
Access Ctrl: Repository (only
002
Lower 4 bits)
003
004
007
526
DFU
Specifies the max size of the image data that the
machine can download.
[1 to 1024 / 1024 / 1 MB /step]
Main SP Tables-5
NIA
[Installation Date]
5849 1 Display
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)
*CTL
Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0:Public] [1: Private]
527
5. System Maintenance
5853
Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware using a local port (IEEE1284) when
updating the remote ROM.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
*CTL
0: Disable
1: Enable
5857
*CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
001 Switches the debug log feature on and off. The debug log cannot be captured until this
feature is switched on.
Target (2: HDD 3: SD)
2: HDD, 3: SD Card
002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with
SP5-858 are satisfied.
[ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step]
Save to HDD
005
006
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD.
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card.
Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to
each SD Card.
Save to SD Card
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card.
Main SP Tables-5
001
002
*CTL
These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination
selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes.
Engine SC Error
(0: OFF, 1: ON)
Controller SC Error
(0: OFF, 1: ON)
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
5859
*CTL
529
5. System Maintenance
001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4
These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
functions that use common memory on the controller
board.
005 Key 5
006 Key 6
[9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / ]
007 Key 7
008 Key 8
009 Key 9
010 Key 10
5860
[SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]
*CTL
[1 to 168 / 72 / 1 hour/step]
Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The
received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
021 MDN Response RFC2.5298 Compliance
[0 to 1 / 1 / ]
[0 to 1 / 0 / ]
Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account
after the SMTP server is validated.
0: No. "From" item not switched.
1: Yes. "From item switched.
025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting
530
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
Main SP Tables-5
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard
001 Writing
*CTL
003 Initialize
*CTL
5873
5875
531
5. System Maintenance
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
[Option Setup]
5881
001 -
5883
5885
532
*ENG
Main SP Tables-5
0: OFF, 1: ON
Bit Meaning
0: Forbid all document server access (1)
1: Forbid user mode access (1)
020 Document Server ACC Ctrl
*CTL
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Thumbnail, 1: Icon, 2: Details
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Setting for each e-mail
1: Signature for all
2: No signature
*CTL
*CTL
Not Used
*CTL
Not Used
533
5. System Maintenance
5887
001 -
*CTL
5
5888
001 -
*CTL
5893
002 SDK-2
003 SDK-3
004 SDK-4
005 SDK-5
006 SDK-5
534
001 SDK-1
5894
*CTL
[Test Name1]
Test Name1_1
Main SP Tables-5
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
[Application Invalidation]
5895
001
Printer
*CTL
002
Scanner
*CTL
5907
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Enable
1: Disable
Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information
is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these names should be registered again.
After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting
is completed, the beeper sounds five times.
5913
*CTL
[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second /step]
002 Sets the amount of time to elapse while the machine is in standby mode (and the operation
panel keys have not been used) before another application can gain control of the display.
5967
*CTL
0: ON, 1: OFF
Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that prevents image
data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must
switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.
5974
[Cherry Server]
Specifies which version of ScanRouter, "Lite" or "Full", is installed.
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / ] 0: Lite, 1: Full
535
5. System Maintenance
[Device Setting]
5985
The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable
and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller
board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only
for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC
Other network applications than NRS or LDAP/NT
authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even
though you can change the initial settings of those network
applications, the settings do not work.
5
002 On Board USB
5987
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[Mech. Counter]
001 0: OFF / 1: ON
5990
536
Main SP Tables-5
006 Non-Default
022 Scanner SP
5998
5
-
001 fast/silent
*ENG
537
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-6
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
6006
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides.
005 Buckle: Duplex Front
006 Buckle: Duplex Rear
*ENG
*ENG
Displays the signals received from the sensors and switches of the ARDF. Only Bit 0 is used
for ADF input check ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[ADF OUTPUT Check]
6008
6009
538
p.627 "Main
Main SP Tables-6
6010
*ENG
Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors
cannot recognize all sizes.
*ENG
001
NA
EU/
ASIA
6017
0: Setting 1, 1: Setting 2
Setting 1
Setting 2
DLT SEF
LG SEF
Foolscap SEF
LT SEF
LT LEF
US EXE LEF
DLT SEF
8K 267 x 390 mm
LT SEF
LT LEF
6020
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
*CTL
001 -
*ENG
539
5. System Maintenance
6128
001
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
6129
001
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
6130
540
Main SP Tables-6
001 A3T
*ENG
002 B4T
*ENG
003 A4T
*ENG
004 A4Y
*ENG
005 B5T
*ENG
006 B5Y
*ENG
007 DLT-T
*ENG
008 LG-T
*ENG
009 LT-T
*ENG
010 LT-Y
*ENG
*ENG
012 Other
*ENG
Selects the skew correction control for each paper size. These are only activated for B804/
B805.
541
5. System Maintenance
001 A3T
*ENG
002 B4T
*ENG
003 A4T
*ENG
004 A4Y
*ENG
005 B5T
*ENG
006 B5Y
*ENG
007 DLT-T
*ENG
008 LG-T
*ENG
009 LT-T
*ENG
010 LT-Y
*ENG
*ENG
012 Other
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: No (No skew correction)
1: Roller Stop Skew Correction
542
This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the stack on the
finisher stapling tray in the (Booklet) Finisher B804/B805. The adjustment is done
perpendicular to the direction of paper feed.
Main SP Tables-6
001 A3T
*ENG
002 B4T
*ENG
003 A4T
*ENG
004 A4Y
*ENG
005 B5T
*ENG
006 B5Y
*ENG
007 DLT-T
*ENG
008 LG-T
*ENG
009 LT-T
*ENG
010 LT-Y
*ENG
*ENG
012 Other
*ENG
001
6134
Finisher (B408/B804/
B805)
*EN
G
543
5. System Maintenance
001 A3T
002 B4T
003 A4T
004 B5T
005 DLT-T
006 LG-T
007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"
009 Other
6135
005 DLT-T
006 LG-T
007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"
009 Other
6136
[Folding Number]
Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher B804.
001 -
544
[2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step]
Main SP Tables-6
6138
6139
6143
p.627
6145
p.627
6144
p.627
p.627
6146
6149
*ENG
001 -
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheet/step]
545
5. System Maintenance
[INPUT Check]
6150
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[OUTPUT Check]
6151
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[INPUT Check]
6152
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[OUTPUT Check]
6153
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[INPUT Check]
6154
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D536) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section).
[OUTPUT Check]
6155
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D536) (
p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this section)
546
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this
section)
Main SP Tables-6
[OUTPUT Check]
6161
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.627 "Main SP Tables-9" in this
section)
547
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-7
SP7-XXX (Data Log)
7401
[Total SC Counter]
Displays the number of SC codes detected.
001 SC Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step ]
[SC History]
7403
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
006 Latest 5
*CTL
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
7502
548
* CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
Main SP Tables-7
7503
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 original/step ]
*CTL
003 Tray 1: ON
*CTL
004 Tray 2: ON
*CTL
005 Tray 3: ON
*CTL
006 Tray 4: ON
*CTL
007 LCT : ON
*CTL
008 Bypass: ON
*CTL
009 Duplex: ON
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5
For details, (
Detection")
p.786 "Jam
549
5. System Maintenance
*CTL
*CTL
017 Registration: ON
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
550
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
For details, (
Detection")
p.786 "Jam
For details, (
Detection")
p.786 "Jam
Main SP Tables-7
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
For details, (
Detection")
p.786 "Jam
For details, (
Detection")
p.786 "Jam
551
5. System Maintenance
7505
001 At Power On
003 Skew Correction: On
004 Registration Sensor: On
005 Original Exit Sensor: On
*CTL
7506
552
*CTL
006 A5 LEF
*CTL
014 B5 LEF
*CTL
038 LT LEF
*CTL
*CTL
132 A3 SEF
*CTL
133 A4 SEF
*CTL
134 A5 SEF
*CTL
141 B4 SEF
*CTL
142 B5 SEF
*CTL
*CTL
164 LG SEF
*CTL
166 LT SEF
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
Main SP Tables-7
255 Others
7507
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
*CTL
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
7508
*CTL
007 Latest-6
008 Latest-7
009 Latest-8
010 Latest-9
553
5. System Maintenance
7624
0: Not PM maintenance
1: PM maintenance
[0 or 1 / 1 -]
0: Not PM maintenance
1: PM maintenance
554
*CTL
Main SP Tables-7
7803
*CTL
*ENG
555
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
556
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
557
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
558
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
7804
559
5. System Maintenance
7807
012 Developer: Bk
013 Developer: M
014 Developer: C
015 Developer: Y
100 All
560
Main SP Tables-7
7832
*CTL -
[ACC Counter]
*CTL
*CTL
7836
7852
Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning
glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1
(ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]
7853
[Replacement Counter]
Displays the PM parts replacement number.
561
5. System Maintenance
562
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
009 K Developer
*CTL
010 M Developer
*CTL
011 C Developer
*CTL
012 Y Developer
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]
[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]
Main SP Tables-7
[Coverage Range]
Sets the color coverage threshold.
Coverage rate = Coverage per page / A4 full coverage (dots) x 100
There are three coverage counters: Color 1, Color 2, and Color 3
[A] 5% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-001.
[B] 20% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-002.
7855
*CTL
[1 to 200 / 5 /1]
*CTL
[1 to 200 / 20 /1]
563
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 page/step ]
564
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
565
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]
078
566
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 %/step ]
7931
567
5. System Maintenance
010 Date
011 Serial No.
*ENG
7932
568
[Toner Bottle M]
Displays the toner bottle information for M.
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
007 Maintenance ID
008 New Product Information
009 Recycle Counter
010 Date
011 Serial No.
012 Toner Remaining
013 EDP Code
014 End History
015 Refill Information
016 Attachment: Total Counter
017 Attachment: Color Counter
*ENG
7933
[Toner Bottle C]
Displays the toner bottle information for C.
569
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
007 Maintenance ID
008 New Product Information
009 Recycle Counter
010 Date
011 Serial No.
012 Toner Remaining
013 EDP Code
014 End History
015 Refill Information
016 Attachment: Total Counter
017 Attachment: Color Counter
018 End: Total Counter
019 End: Color Counter
020 Attachment Date
021 End Date
7934
570
[Toner Bottle Y]
Displays the toner bottle information for Y.
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
007 Maintenance ID
008 New Product Information
009 Recycle Counter
010 Date
011 Serial No.
012 Toner Remaining
013 EDP Code
014 End History
015 Refill Information
016 Attachment: Total Counter
017 Attachment: Color Counter
*ENG
571
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
572
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
573
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
574
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
*ENG
7950
*ENG
7951
575
5. System Maintenance
*ENG
*ENG
576
Main SP Tables-7
*ENG
*ENG
7952
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
577
5. System Maintenance
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.
*CTL
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.
*CTL
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
Main SP Tables-7
*CTL
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*CTL
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*CTL
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*CTL
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*CTL
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
579
5. System Maintenance
001 T<=0
002 0<T<=5:0<=H<30
003 0<T<=5: 30<=H<70
004 0<T<=5: 70<=H<=100
005 5<T<15: 0<=H<30
006 5<T<15: 30<=H<55
*CTL
[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]
*CTL
[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]
7954
7955
580
Fusing Stop
Main SP Tables-7
001
002
003
004
Displays the threshold sheet for the heating roller near end.
End: Page
Displays the threshold distance for the heating roller near end.
End: Rotation
581
5. System Maintenance
Main SP Tables-8
SP8-xxx: Data Log2
Many of these counters are provided for features that are currently not available, such as sending color
faxes, and so on. However, here are some Group 8 codes that when used in combination with others, can
provide useful information.
SP Numbers
What They Do
SP8211 to SP8216
SP8401 to SP8406
SP8691 to SP8696
582
What it means
T:
C:
Copy application.
F:
Fax application.
P:
Print application.
S:
Scan application.
Main SP Tables-8
L:
O:
Other applications
(external network
applications, for
example)
The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on the small
LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations below and refer to it
again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand.
What it means
>
AddBook
Address Book
Apl
Application
B/W
Bk
Black
Cyan
ColCr
Color Create
ColMode
Color Mode
Comb
Combine
Comp
Compression
Deliv
Delivery
583
5. System Maintenance
Abbreviation
584
What it means
DesApl
Dev Counter
Dup, Duplex
Emul
Emulation
FC
Full Color
FIN
Full Bleed
No Margins
GenCopy
GPC
Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does not count
up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number
that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page job, the counter counts up
11-10 =1)
IFax
Internet Fax
ImgEdt
Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border
removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.
Black (YMCK)
LS
LSize
Mag
Magnification
MC
NRS
Org
OrgJam
Original Jam
Palm 2
Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows print jobs
to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files
to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats.
Main SP Tables-8
Abbreviation
What it means
PC
Personal Computer
PGS
Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original. Duplex pages
count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT
counter SP is switched ON.
PJob
Print Jobs
Ppr
Paper
PrtJam
PrtPGS
Print Pages
Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2 only. This
machine is under development and currently not available.
Rez
Resolution
SC
Scn
Scan
Sim, Simplex
S-to-Email
Scan-to-E-mail
SMC
SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8 counters are recorded
in the SMC report.
Svr
Server
TonEnd
Toner End
TonSave
Toner Save
TXJob
Send, Transmission
YMC
YMCK
All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.
585
5. System Maintenance
T:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 002
C:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 003
F:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 004
P:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 005
S:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 006
L:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 001
These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed.
When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.
Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the
SP modes are not counted.
When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at
the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.
A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.
When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the
document server is not used).
A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are not
counted separately).
A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one
transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been
completed.
A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.
The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.
When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job
stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.
When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both
increment.
When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.
When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.
586
Main SP Tables-8
When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However,
for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments.
8 011
T:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 012
C:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 013
F:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 014
P:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 015
S:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 016
L:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 017
O:Jobs/LS
*CTL
When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document
server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
8 021
T:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 022
C:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 023
F:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 024
P:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 025
S:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 026
L:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 027
O:Pjob/LS
*CTL
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter
increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document server
with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter
increments.
587
5. System Maintenance
When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter
increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter
increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed
with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image
Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.
8 031
T:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 032
C:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 033
F:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 034
P:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 035
S:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 036
L:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 037
O:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application
that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.)
the L: counter increments.
8 041
T:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 042
C:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 043
F:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 044
P:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 045
S:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 046
L:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 047
O:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an email, the O: counter increments.
588
Main SP Tables-8
8 051
T:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 052
C:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 053
F:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 054
P:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 055
S:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 056
L:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 057
O:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter
increments.
8 061
T:FIN Jobs
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
F:FIN Jobs
8 063
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by the application.
C:FIN Jobs
8 062
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
P:FIN Jobs
8 064
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
S:FIN Jobs
8 065
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.
589
5. System Maintenance
L:FIN Jobs
8 066
*CTL
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode
screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window
within document server mode.
O:FIN Jobs
8 067
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the
network. The finishing method is specified by the application.
8 06x 1 Sort
Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored copy job is set for Sort
and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments. (See SP8
066 1)
8 06x 2 Stack
8 06x 3 Staple
8 06x 4 Booklet
8 06x 5 Z-Fold
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Z-fold).
8 06x 6 Punch
Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job,
the P: counter increments. (See SP8 064 6.)
8 06x 7 Other
T:Jobs/PGS
8 071
8 072
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
F:Jobs/PGS
8 073
*CTL
These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job,
regardless of which application was used.
C:Jobs/PGS
590
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of
pages in the job.
Main SP Tables-8
P:Jobs/PGS
8 074
*CTL
These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
S:Jobs/PGS
8 075
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job.
O:Jobs/PGS
8 077
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
L:Jobs/PGS
8 076
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs (Web Image
Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job.
8 07x 1 1 Page
8 07x 8
21 to 50 Pages
8 07x 2 2 Pages
8 07x 9
51 to 100 Pages
8 07x 3 3 Pages
8 07x 10
8 07x 4 4 Pages
8 07x 11
8 07x 5 5 Pages
8 07x 12
8 07x 6 6 to 10 Pages
8 07x 13
8 07x 7 11 to 20 Pages
8 07x 14
1001 to Pages
For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode,
the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
If a job is paused and re-started, it counts as one job.
If the finisher runs out of staples during a print and staple job, then the job is counted at the time the
error occurs.
For copy jobs (SP 8072) and scan jobs (SP 8075), the total is calculated by multiplying the number
of sets of copies by the number of pages scanned. (One duplex page counts as 2.)
The first test print and subsequent test prints to adjust settings are added to the number of pages of the
copy job (SP 8072).
591
5. System Maintenance
When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted.
T:FAX TX Jobs
8 111
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax, either
directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
F: FAX TX Jobs
8 113
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax directly
on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 11x 1 B/W
8 11x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.
This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored
on the document server.
If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started.
If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are
available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (8 12x) also increments.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:IFAX TX Jobs
8 121
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, either directly
or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
F: IFAX TX Jobs
8 123
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not stored on the
document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 12x 1 B/W
8 12x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.
592
Main SP Tables-8
The counters for color are provided for future use; the color fax feature is not available at this time.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:S-to-Email Jobs
8 131
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and
attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not.
S: S-to-Email Jobs
8 135
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached
to e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.
8 13x 1 B/W
8 13x 2 Color
8 13x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or blackand-white then counted.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one
job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same
document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-toEmail and once for Scan-to-PC).
T:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8 141
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a Scan Router server.
S: Deliv Jobs/Svr
8 145
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned in scanner mode
and sent to a Scan Router server.
8 14x 1 B/W
8 14x 2 Color
593
5. System Maintenance
8 14x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server
cannot be confirmed.
If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a "Color"
job.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
delivered, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.
T:Deliv Jobs/PC
8 151
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts.
S:Deliv Jobs/PC
8 155
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
with Scan-to-PC.
8 15x 1 B/W
8 15x 2 Color
8 15x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, it is not counted.
If the job is cancelled while it is waiting to be sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.
594
Main SP Tables-8
8 161
T:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
8 163
F:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.
This counts fax jobs started from a PC using a PC fax application, and sending the data out to the
destination from the PC through the copier.
8 171
T:Deliv Jobs/WSD
*CTL
8 175
S:Deliv Jobs/WSD
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
-001 B/W
-002 Color
-003 ACS
8 181
*CTL
8 185
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
-001 B/W
-002 Color
-003 ACS
8 191
*CTL
8 192
*CTL
8 193
*CTL
8 195
*CTL
8 196
*CTL
SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.
595
5. System Maintenance
A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S: count
is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button
in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
T:LSize Scan PGS
8 201
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan and copy
jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
F: LSize Scan PGS
8 203
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for fax transmission.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
S:LSize Scan PGS
8 205
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan jobs only.
Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
8 211
T:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 212
C:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 213
F:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 215
S:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 216
L:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
596
Main SP Tables-8
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the
L: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
8 221
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side scanning.
Number of front sides fed for scanning:
8 221 1
Front
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is
the same as the number of pages fed for either simplex or duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count
is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The
front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.)
Number of rear sides fed for scanning:
8 221 2
Back
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the
same as the number of pages fed for duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is
the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning.
When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the
pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.
Scan PGS/Mode
8 231
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the
work load on the ADF.
8 231 2 SADF
8 231 5 Platen
597
5. System Maintenance
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original's
page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the
Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
T:Scan PGS/Org
8 241
8 242
8 243
8 245
*CTL
These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all jobs,
regardless of which application was used.
C:Scan PGS/Org
*CTL
598
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs.
F:Scan PGS/Org
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs.
S:Scan PGS/Org
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs.
L:Scan PGS/Org
8 246
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within
the Copy mode screen
8 241
8 242
8 243
8 245
8 246
8 24x 1: Text
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 24x 2: Text/Photo
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 24x 3: Photo
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
8 24x 5: Map
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
8 24x 6: Normal/Detail
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
8 24x 8: Binary
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Main SP Tables-8
8 24x 9: Grayscale
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
8 251
T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 252
C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 254
P:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 255
S : Scan PGS/ImgEdr
*CTL
8 256
L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
Image Repeat
Centering
Positive/Negative
8 257
O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: The count totals the number of times the edit
features have been used. A detailed breakdown of
exactly which features have been used is not given.
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
8 261
T:Scan PGS/ColCr
*CTL
8 262
*CTL
8 265
S:Scn PGS/Color
*CTL
8 266
L:Scn PGS/ColCr
*CTL
8 26x 4 Other
599
5. System Maintenance
8 281
T:Scan PGS/TWAIN
*CTL
8 285
S:Scan PGS/TWAIN
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.
8 291
T:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
8 293
F:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
8 295
S:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
5
T:Scan PGS/Size
8 301
600
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP
8-445].
L:Scan PGS/Size
8 306
*CTL
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443].
S:Scan PGS/Size
8 305
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page
size [SP 8-442].
F:Scan PGS/Size
8 303
*CTL
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size
[SP 8-441].
C:Scan PGS/Size
8 302
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size
(scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446].
Main SP Tables-8
8 30x 1 A3
8 30x 2 A4
8 30x 3 A5
8 30x 4 B4
8 30x 5 B5
8 30x 6 DLT
8 30x 7 LG
8 30x 8 LT
8 30x 9 HLT
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
S: Scan PGS/Rez
8 315
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.
8 31x 1
1200dpi <
8 31x 2
600dpi to 1199dpi
8 31x 3
400dpi to 599dpi
8 31x 4
200dpi to 399dpi
8 31x 5
< 199dpi
5. System Maintenance
8 381
T:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 382
C:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 383
F:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 384
P:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 385
S:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 386
L:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 387
O:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as
2.
When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages
are not counted as printed pages:
- Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
- Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
- Reports printed to confirm counts.
- All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
- Test prints for machine image adjustment.
- Error notification reports.
- Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
LSize PrtPGS
8 391
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also
displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
602
Main SP Tables-8
8 401
T:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 402
C:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 403
F:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 404
P:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 405
S:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 406
L:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.
Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.
8 411
Prints/Duplex
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 421
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the printer application.
S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 425
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 424
*CTL
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the copier application.
F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 423
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 422
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the scanner application.
603
5. System Maintenance
L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation
panel.
8 426
O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 427
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by Other applications
8 42x 7 4>
8 42x 8 6>
8 42x 9 8>
8 42x 10 9>
8 42x 11 16>
8 42x 12 Booklet
8 42x 13 Magazine
These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their
compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
Booklet
604
Magazine
Original Pages
Count
Original Pages
Count
Main SP Tables-8
T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 431
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode
window at the operation panel with the three features below.
O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 437
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
print application.
L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 436
*CTL
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
copy application.
P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 434
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below,
regardless of which application was used.
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 432
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with
Other applications.
8 43x 2 Series/Book
605
5. System Maintenance
8 441
T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 443
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 447
606
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer
application.
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 446
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax application.
S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 445
*CTL
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy
application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 444
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 442
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other applications.
Main SP Tables-8
8 44x 1 A3
8 44x 2 A4
8 44x 3 A5
8 44x 4 B4
8 44x 5 B5
8 44x 6 DLT
8 44x 7 LG
8 44x 8 LT
8 44x 9 HLT
PrtPGS/Ppr Tray
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.
Bypass Tray
8 451 2 Tray 1
Copier
8 451 3 Tray 2
Copier
8 451 4 Tray 3
8 451 5 Tray 4
8 451 6 Tray 5
LCT (Option)
8 451 7 Tray 6
8 451 8 Tray 7
8 451 9 Tray 8
8 451 10 Tray 9
607
5. System Maintenance
T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications.
8 461
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is based on
feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However,
these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed
on one side counts as 1.
8 462
8 463
8 464
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
8 466
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel.
8 46x 1 Normal
8 46x 2 Recycled
8 46x 3 Special
8 46x 4 Thick
8 46x 5 Normal (Back)
8 46x 6 Thick (Back)
8 46x 7 OHP
8 46x 8 Other
8 471
608
PrtPGS/Mag
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Main SP Tables-8
T:PrtPGS/TonSave
*CTL
8 484
P:PrtPGS/TonSave
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 491
T:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 492
C:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 493
F:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 496
L:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 497
O:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 49x 1 B/W
8 49x 2 Single Color
609
5. System Maintenance
T:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 504
P:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 507
O:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 50x 1 B/W
8 50x 2 Mono Color
8 50x 3 Full Color
8 511
8 514
610
T:PrtPGS/Emul
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.
P:PrtPGS/Emul
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.
Main SP Tables-8
8 514 1
RPCS
8 514 2
RPDL
8 514 3
PS3
8 514 4
R98
8 514 5
R16
8 514 6
GL/GL2
8 514 7
R55
8 514 8
RTIFF
8 514 9
8 514 10
PCL5e/5c
8 514 11
PCL XL
8 514 12
IPDL-C
8 514 13
BM-Links
8 514 14
Other
Japan Only
SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.
8 521
T:PrtPGS/FIN
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy
application.
F:PrtPGS/FIN
8 523
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/FIN
8 522
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax
application.
NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.
611
5. System Maintenance
P:PrtPGS/FIN
8 524
*CTL
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print
application.
S:PrtPGS/FIN
8 525
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/FIN
8 526
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
8 52x 1 Sort
8 52x 2 Stack
8 52x 3 Staple
8 52x 4 Booklet
8 52x 5 Z-Fold
8 52x 6 Punch
8 52x 7 Other
If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still
counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted.
8 531
Staples
T:Counter
8 581
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the
application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
8 581 1 Total
8 581 2 Total: Full Color
612
*CTL
Main SP Tables-8
C:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the copy application broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
8 582 2 Single Color
8 582 3 Two Color
613
5. System Maintenance
F:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the fax application broken down by color output.
8 583 1 B/W
8 583 2 Single Color
8 584
P:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the print application broken down by color output.
8 584 1 B/W
8 584 2 Mono Color
8 584 3 Full Color
8 584 4 Single Color
8 584 5 Two Color
8 586
L:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the local storage broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
8 582 2 Single Color
8 582 3 Two Color
8 582 4 Full Color
O:Counter
8 591
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages printed, and
the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only.
8 591 1 A3/DLT
8 591 2 Duplex
614
*CTL
Main SP Tables-8
Coverage Counter
8 601
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total coverage for each color and the total printout pages for each
printing mode.
8 601 1 B/W
8 601 2 Color
8 601 11 B/W Printing Pages
8 601 12 Color Printing Pages
8 617
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion.
8 617 1 SDK-1
8 617 2 SDK-2
8 617 3 SDK-3
8 617 4 SDK-4
8 617 5 SDK-5
8 617 6 SDK-6
8 631
8 633
T:FAX TX PGS
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
F:FAX TX PGS
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
8 63x 1 B/W
8 63x 2 Color
615
5. System Maintenance
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:IFAX TX PGS
8 641
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using
I-Fax.
F:IFAX TX PGS
8 643
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using
I-Fax.
8 64x 1 B/W
8 64x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:S-to-Email PGS
8 651
616
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both
the Scan and document server applications.
Main SP Tables-8
S:S-to-Email PGS
8 655
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for the
Scan application only.
8 65x 1 B/W
8 65x 2 Color
The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is
cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are
sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent
to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).
Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large
number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page
document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also
10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20.).
T:Deliv PGS/Svr
8 661
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by both Scan and LS applications.
S:Deliv PGS/Svr
8 665
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by the Scan application.
8 66x 1 B/W
8 66x 2 Color
The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router
server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server.
617
5. System Maintenance
T:Deliv PGS/PC
8 671
*CTL
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scanto-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
S: Deliv PGS/PC
8 675
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the
Scan application.
8 67x 1 B/W
8 67x 2 Color
8 681
T:PCFAX TXPGS
*CTL
8 683
F:PCFAX TXPGS
*CTL
This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the
destination.
When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only
counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes
up by 10, not 20.)
8 691
T:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 692
C:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 693
F:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 694
P:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 695
S:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 696
L:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages
sent to each destination.
618
Main SP Tables-8
TX PGS/Port
8 701
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For
example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN
(G3, G4) is 12.
8 701 1 PSTN-1
8 701 2 PSTN-2
8 701 3 PSTN-3
8 701 4 ISDN (G3,G4)
8 701 5 Network
8 711
8 715
T:Scan PGS/Comp
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
S:Scan PGS/Comp
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages sent by each compression mode.
8 715 1 JPEG/JPEG2000
8 715 2 TIFF(Multi/Single)
8 715 3 PDF
8 715 4 Other
8 715 5 PDF/Comp
8 721
8 725
T:Deliv PGS/WSD
*CTL
S: Dvliv PGS/WSD
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode.
x 1 B/W
x 2 Color
619
5. System Maintenance
8 731
8 735
8 741
T:Scan PGS/Media
*CTL
S:Scan PGS/Media
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by each scanner
mode.
x 1 B/W
x 2 Color
RX PGS/Port
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them.
8 741 1 PSTN-1
8 741 2 PSTN-2
8 741 3 PSTN-3
8 741 5 Network
Dev Counter
8 771
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the development rollers) for
black and other color toners.
8 771 1 Total
8 771 2 K
8 771 3 Y
8 771 4 M
8 771 5 C
Toner_Bottle_Info.
8 781
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
620
Main SP Tables-8
8 781 1 Toner: BK
8 781 2 Toner: Y
8 781 3 Toner: M
8 781 4 Toner: C
8 791
LS Memory Remain
*CTL
Toner Remain
8 801
*CTL
[0 to 100/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP allows the user
to check the toner supply at any time.
Note: This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than
other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps).
8 801 1 K
8 801 2 Y
8 801 3 M
8 801 4 C
CVr Cnt: 0-10%
8 851
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 0% to 10%.
8 851 11 0 to 2%: BK
8 851 31 5 to 7%: BK
8 851 12 0 to 2%: Y
8 851 32 5 to 7%: Y
8 851 13 0 to 2%: M
8 851 33 5 to 7%: M
8 851 14 0 to 2%: C
8 851 34 5 to 7%: C
8 851 21 3 to 4%: BK
8 851 41 8 to 10%: BK
8 851 22 3 to 4%: Y
8 851 42 8 to 10%: Y
8 851 23 3 to 4%: M
8 851 43 8 to 10%: M
621
5. System Maintenance
8 851 24 3 to 4%: C
CVr Cnt: 11-20%
8 861
8 851 44 8 to 10%: C
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 11% to 20%.
8 861 1 BK
8 861 2 Y
8 861 3 M
8 861 4 C
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 21% to 30%.
8 871 1 BK
8 871 2 Y
8 871 3 M
8 871 4 C
CVr Cnt: 31%8 881
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is 31% or higher.
8 881 1 BK
8 881 2 Y
8 881 3 M
8 881 4 C
8 891
Page/Toner Bottle
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner for each color.
8 891 1 BK
622
*ENG
Main SP Tables-8
8 891 2 Y
8 891 3 M
8 891 4 C
8 901
Page/Toner_prev1
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner for each color.
8 901 1 BK
8 901 2 Y
8 901 3 M
8 901 4 C
8 911
Page/Toner_prev2
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner for each color.
8 911 1 BK
8 911 2 Y
8 911 3 M
8 911 4 C
8 921
Cvr Cnt/Total
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
623
5. System Maintenance
624
Machine Status
8 941
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation mode. These
SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for
improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards.
8 941 6 SC
8 941 7 PrtJam
8 941 8 OrgJam
Main SP Tables-8
8 951
AddBook Register
These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration.
8 951 4 Group
8 951 6 F-Code
8 999
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
625
5. System Maintenance
8 999 1 Total
8 999 2 Copy: Full Color
8 999 3 Copy: BW
8 999 4 Copy: Single Color
8 999 5 Copy: Two Color
8 999 6 Printer Full Color
8 999 7 Printer BW
8 999 8 Printer Single Color
626
Main SP Tables-9
Main SP Tables-9
Input Check Table
When entering the Input Check mode, 8 digits display the result for a section. Each digit corresponds to a
different device as shown in the table.
Bit No.
Result
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
Copier
5803
Description
Reading
0
Not set
No paper
Paper remaining
No paper
Paper remaining
Upper limit
Upper limit
Paper remaining
Paper detected
Paper detected
5. System Maintenance
Paper detected
Paper full
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Set
Not set
Toner end
Toner remaining
Toner end
Toner remaining
Toner end
Toner remaining
Toner end
Toner remaining
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Closed
Open
Closed
Open
628
Main SP Tables-9
Set
Not set
Not full
Full
Not new
New
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Not contact
Contact
Not contact
Contact
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
SC detected
No SC
SC detected
No SC
SC detected
No SC
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
New
Not new
629
5. System Maintenance
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Not contact
Contact
Closed
Open
(LD5V ON)
(LD5V OFF)
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
Not HP
HP
Open
Closed
Full
Nearly full
Near end
Almost empty
Switch Location
Europe/Asia
4 (bit0)
3 (bit1)
2 (bit2)
Main SP Tables-9
A3 SEF*1
(A3 SEF)
B4 SEF*2
(B4 SEF)
A4 SEF
A4 SEF
B5 SEF
B5 SEF
A4 LEF*3
(A4 LEF)
B5 LEF*4
(B5 LEF)
A5 LEF
A5 LEF
*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003.
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004.
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002.
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-005.
Length Sensor
NA
EU/ASIA
HLT SEF
A6 SEF
HLT SEF
A6 SEF
HLT SEF
A5 SEF
HLT SEF
A5 SEF
LT/LG SEF*1
A4 SEF
LT/LG SEF*1
A5 LEF
bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
631
5. System Maintenance
Length Sensor
NA
EU/ASIA
LT/LG SEF*1
A4 SEF
LT/LG SEF*1
A5 LEF
DLT SEF
A3 SEF
LT LEF
A4 LEF
DLT SEF
A3 SEF
LT LEF
A4 LEF
bit3
Bit2
Bit1
Bit0
*1: The paper size (LT or LG) can be selected with SP1-007-001.
ARDF (D540)
6007
632
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Main SP Tables-9
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Not HP
HP
Original detected
6140
Bit
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Not Full
Full
Paper detected*1
Paper detected
Not HP
HP
Paper detected
Not HP
HP
Paper detected
Paper detected
Not Full
Full
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
633
5. System Maintenance
HP
Not HP
Paper detected
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
6140 18 Limit SW
Not Limit
Limit
6140 19 DOOR SW
Closed
Open
Not HP
HP
Staple detected
Staple detected
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
Paper detected
Not Full
Full
6140 27 Punch HP
Not HP
HP
See *1
See *1
6140 30
Not HP
HP
Paper detected
Not HP
HP
Paper detected
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
Paper detected
Paper detected*2
634
Main SP Tables-9
Paper detected*2
Not HP
HP
Staple detected
Staple detected
Not HP
HP
Staple detected
Staple detected
Not Full
Full
DIP SW 2
Punch Type
Japan
Europe
North America
North Europe
*2: Please refer to "Lower Tray (B804 Only)" in the Service Manual for the "2000/3000 (Booklet)
Finisher".
6139
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
635
5. System Maintenance
6139 3
6139 4
6139 5
6139 14
6139 15
Paper Sensor
(Stack Height Sensor)
Tray Lower Sensor
(Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor)
Proof Full Sensor
(Paper Limit Sensor)
Paper detected
Home position
Home position
Home position
Paper detected
Home position
Staple detected
Staple detected
Home position
Home position
Output tray
detected
Lower limit
Not full
Full
6150
636
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Main SP Tables-9
Set
Not set
Closed
Open
Closed
Open
6152
Description
Reading
0
6154
Description
Reading
0
Set
Not set
Paper detected
6160
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Closed
Open
637
5. System Maintenance
Closed
Open
Closed
Open
638
Display
Description
Main SP Tables-9
639
5. System Maintenance
640
Middle Speed
Polygon Motor: LL
Polygon Motor: L
Polygon Motor: HH
Main SP Tables-9
IH Coil Fan
IH Inverter Fan
Development Clutch-K
Development Clutch-M
Development Clutch-C
Development Clutch-Y
641
5. System Maintenance
642
TD Sensor:Bk
TD Sensor: M
TD Sensor: C
TD Sensor: Y
ID Sensor: Front
ID Sensor: Center
ID Sensor: Rear
ID Sensor: M
ID Sensor: C
ID Sensor: Y
Main SP Tables-9
643
5. System Maintenance
ARDF (D540)
6008
Display
Description
644
6008 12 Stamp
Stamp Solenoid
Main SP Tables-9
Display
Description
Stapler Motor
Stapler Hammer
Display
Description
645
5. System Maintenance
6145 7 Exit Guide Plate Open/Close Motor Exit Guide Plate Motor
6145 20
646
Main SP Tables-9
Display
Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Current
Selection
Description
Bridge: Feed Motor: Current switching signal
6151 7
Display
Description
-
Display
Description
-
Display
Description
Feed Motor:High Speed
(D537/D538/D387)
Feed Motor: Increase Speed
(D537/D538/D387)
647
5. System Maintenance
(D537/D538/D387)
Feed Motor: Low Speed
(D537/D538/D387)
648
Bit Switch
Main SP Tables-9
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
DFU
bit 3
No I/O Timeout
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur.
bit 4
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot (* Card Save
Function in "System Maintenance Reference" section of the Field Service Manual).
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the
printable area.
1001
Bit Switch
649
5. System Maintenance
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
Shift Collate
Normal Collate
A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a
Collate Type configured.
If #5-0 is enabled, this Bit Switch has no effect.
bit 3
0: Enable
1: Disable
Some host systems submit jobs that contain both PS and PCL5e/c. If Auto PDL switching
is disabled, these jobs will not be printed properly.
1001
650
bit 4
DFU
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
DFU
Bit Switch
Main SP Tables-9
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A") will be changed
to "<ESC>*r1A"
1001
bit 3
DFU
bit 4
DFU
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
DFU
Bit Switch
Bit Switch
651
5. System Maintenance
Disable
Enable
If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type
from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured
options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
"User Tools > Printer Features > System"
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
DFU
bit 3
[PS] PS Criteria
Pattern3
Pattern1
Disable
(100)
Enable (1000)
Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job
Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
bit 5
Face-up output
Disable
Enable
Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.
1001
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
DFU
Bit Switch
Bit Switch
652
Main SP Tables-9
1001
Bit Switch
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
DFU
bit 3
Disable
Enable
Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode
authentication is enabled.
DFU
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
[Clear Setting]
Initialize Printer System
Initializes settings in the System menu of the user mode.
[Print Summary]
Print Summary
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).
653
5. System Maintenance
1005
1005 1
1006
[Display Version]
Disp. Version
Displays the version of the controller firmware.
[Sample/Locked Print]
*CTL
0: Linked, 1: On
Enables and disables the document server. When you select 0, the document server is
1006 1 enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select
1, the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.
[Data Recall]
1101
Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous
setting, or c) the current setting.
1101 1 Factory
1101 2 Previous
1101 3 Current
*CTL
1101 4 ACC
1102
1102 1
1103
[Resolution Setting]
Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.
2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text,
600x600 Text
[Test Page]
Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.
1104
654
[Gamma Adjustment]
Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the Mode Selection menu.
Main SP Tables-9
*CTL
[0 to 30 / 15 / 1/step ]
Stores the print gamma adjusted with the Gamma Adj. menu item as the current setting.
Before the machine stores the new current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the
current setting to the previous setting memory storage location.
1106
[Toner Limit]
Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.
*CTL
655
5. System Maintenance
Scanner SP Mode
SP1-xxx (System and Others)
1004
[Compression Type]
Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.
*CTL
[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ]
1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR
[Erase margin]
1005
1009
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: enable, 1: disable
1010
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Display, 1: No display
656
Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that
can be selected at the operation panel.
Main SP Tables-9
[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step ]
*CTL
[5 to 95 / 30 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 60 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at
the operation panel.
*CTL
[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
657
5. System Maintenance
Firmware Update
To update the firmware for this machine, you must have the new version of the firmware downloaded onto
an SD (Secure Digital) Card. The SD Card is inserted into SD Card Slot 2 on the left rear side of the controller
box.
Type of Firmware
There are several types of firmware as shown below.
658
Type of firmware
Function
Location of firmware
Message shown
Engine
Engine
System/Copy
Application
Operating system
System/Copy
Lcdc
Panel control
LCDC
Lcdc
ADF
ADF control
ADF
NetworkSupport
Controller Board
NetworkSupport
Language 1
LCDC
Language1
Language 2
LCDC
Language2
RPCS
Controller Board
RPCS
MediaPrint:JPEG/TIFF
Controller Board
MediaPrint:JPEG/
TIFF
FONT
Controller Board
FONT
FONT1
Controller Board
FONT1
NetworkDocBox
Controller Board
NetworkDocBox
Printer
Controller Board
Printer
Scanner
Controller Board
Scanner
Websupport
Controller Board
Websupport
WebUapl
Controller Board
WebUapl
Firmware Update
"Upload" means to send data from the machine to the SD card. "Download" means to send data from
the SD card to the machine.
To select an item on the LCD, touch the appropriate button on the soft touch-screen of the LCD, or,
press the appropriate number key on the 10-key pad of the operation panel. For example, when "Exit
(0)" shows on the screen you can touch the Exit button on the screen, or, press the "0" button on the
operation panel of the copier.
Make sure that the machine is disconnected from the network to prevent a print job for arriving while
the firmware update is in progress before you start the firmware update procedure.
Updating Firmware
Preparation
If the SD card is blank, copy the entire "romdata" folder onto the SD card.
If the card already contains the "romdata" folder, copy the "D086" folder onto the card.
If the card already contains folders up to "D086", copy the necessary firmware files (e.g. D086xxxx.fwu)
into this folder.
Do not put multiple machine firmware programs on the same SD card. Copy the only model firmware
you want.
659
5. System Maintenance
Updating Procedure
1. Turn the main power switch off.
2. Remove the slot cover (
x 1).
3. Insert the SD card into SD Card Slot 2. Make sure the label on the SD card faces the front side of the
machine.
4. Slowly push the SD card into the slot so it locks in place. You will hear it click. Make sure the SD card
locks in place.
To remove the SD, push it in to unlock the spring lock. Then release it so it pops out of the slot.
5. Disconnect the network cable from the copier if the machine is connected to a network.
6. Switch the main power switch on. After about 45 seconds, the initial version update screen appears
on the LCD in English.
7. On the screen, touch the button or press the corresponding number key on the operation panel to
select the item in the menu that you want to update.
ROM/NEW
What it means
ROM:
Tells you the number of the module and name of the version currently installed.
The first line is the module number, the second line the version name.
NEW:
Tells you the number of the module and name version on the SD card. The first
line is the module number, the second line the version name.
Controller, engine and operation panel firmware cannot be updated at the same time. It is
recommended to update firmware modules one by one.
8. Touch "UpDate (#)" (or
The progress bar does not show for the operation panel firmware after you touch "OpPanel".
The power on key flashes on and off at 0.5 s intervals when the LCDC firmware is updating. The
power key flashes on and off at 3 s intervals when the update is finished.
9. The "Update is Done" message appears on the operation panel after completing the updating. The
message differs depending on the firmware that has been updated.
10. Switch the copier main power switch off when you see the "Update is Done" message or follow the
procedure that is displayed on the operation panel.
11. Press in the SD card to release it. Then remove it from the slot.
12. Switch the copier on for normal operation.
660
Firmware Update
Error Messages
An error message shows in the first line if an error occurs during the download.
The error code consists of the letter "E" and a number. The example above shows error "E24" displayed.
For details, refer to the Error Message Table. ( "Handling Firmware Update Error")
x 1).
661
5. System Maintenance
662
Firmware Update
8. Prepare the newer App2Me Provider zip file from the Firmware Download Center, and then unzip
the zip file. (The folder name is "337051920".)
9. Copy the App2Me Provider folder into the specified path for the VM card. The path is:
"SD_Card Drive\ sdk\dsdk\dist\337051920"
10. Turn the SD card label face to the front of the machine, and then push it slowly into Slot 2 (lower slot)
until you hear a click.
11. Turn the main power switch on.
12. Press [User Tools] on the operation panel.
13. Touch the "Extended Feature Settings" button twice.
14. Touch the "Extended Feature Info" tab on the LCD.
15. Touch the "App2Me" line.
16. Set the setting of the "Auto Start" to "On".
17. Touch the "Exit" button.
18. Exit the [User Tools/Counter] settings.
App2Me and all other running applications on the VM card must be shut down before removing the
VM card in order to update the firmware, back up NVRAM, install the browser unit, or execute
application move or undo with SP5873.
After the VM card is re-inserted, App2Me (and any other VM card applications used by the customer)
must be switched on after the machine is switched on.
663
5. System Maintenance
x 1).
664
Firmware Update
14. You will see "Uninstalling the extended feature... Please wait.", and then "Completed".
15. Touch "Exit" to go back to the setting screen.
16. Exit "User/Tools" setting, and then turn off the main power switch.
17. Remove the SD card of the browser unit from SD card slot 2.
18. Overwrite the updated program in the "sdk" folder of the browser unit application with PC.
19. Do the "Installation Procedure" to install the browser unit.
Meaning
Solution
20
21
22
23
Error occurred when ROM update Controller program abnormal. If the second attempt fails,
program started
replace controller board.
24
30
31
32
33
34
665
5. System Maintenance
666
35
36
40
42
43
44
50
x 1).
3. Insert the SD card with the language data into SD Card Slot 2.
4. Switch the copier main power switch on. The initial screen opens after about 45 seconds.
5. Touch "Language Data (2)" on the screen (or press the "2" key).
What it does
LANG. 1(1)
Touch this button on the screen (or press the "1" key on the 10-key pad) to
open the next screen so you can select the 1st language.
LANG. 1(2)
Touch this button on the screen (or press the "2" key on the 10-key pad) to
open the next screen so you can select the 2nd language.
Exit (0)
Touch this key on the screen (or press the "0" key on the 10-key pad) to
quit the update procedure and return to normal screen.
7. Touch "LANG 1(1)" to select the 1st Language. Touch "LANG (2)" to select the 2nd Language.
667
5. System Maintenance
8. Touch the appropriate button on the screen (or press the number on the 10-keypad) to select a
language as the 1st (or 2nd) language.
If a language is already selected, it will show in reverse.
Touching "Exit (0)" returns you to the previous screen.
9. If you do not see the language that you want to select, touch " (7)" or " (9)" on the screen (or press
the "7" or "9" key) to show more choices.
The Download Screen opens after you select a language.
The 1st or 2nd language selected for updating shows.
The following show to right of the selection:
1. The first column shows the language currently selected.
2. The 2nd column shows the language selected to replace that language.
The example below shows that the download will replace "Japanese" with "Italian" as the 1st
language.
668
Another screen with a progress bar does not show when the language is downloading.
669
5. System Maintenance
first.
3. Press yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the system settings.
4. Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.
670
first.
5
3. Press Yes when the message prompts you to confirm that you want to reset the Copier Document
Server settings.
4. Press exit when the message tells you that the settings have been reset.
671
5. System Maintenance
3. Press the "Exit" button. Then turn the copier off and on again.
672
x 1).
4. Insert the SD card into SD card slot 2. Then switch the copier on.
5. Execute SP5824-001 (NVRAM Data Upload) and then press the Execute key.
6. The following files are coped to an NVRAM folder on the SD card when the upload procedure is
finished. The file is saved to the path and the following filename:
NVRAM\<serial number>.NV
Here is an example with Serial Number K5000017114:
NVRAM\K5000017114.NV
7. In order to prevent an error during the download, be sure to mark the SD card that holds the uploaded
data with the number of the machine from which the data was uploaded.
You can upload NVRAM data from more than one machine to the same SD card.
673
5. System Maintenance
x 1).
3. Insert the SD card with the NVRAM data into SD Card Slot 2.
4. Switch the copier main power switch on.
5. Do SP5825-001 (NVRAM Data Download) and press the Execute key.
The serial number of the file on the SD card must match the serial number of the machine for the
NVRAM data to download successfully. The download fails if the serial numbers do not match.
This procedure does not download the following data to the NVRAM:
Total Count
C/O, P/O Count
674
Select Title
Folder
Local Authentication
Folder Authentication
Account ACL
New Document Initial ACL
LDAP Authentication
Download
1. Prepare a formatted SD card.
2. Make sure that the write-protection on the SD card is off.
3. Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.
4. Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine (
x 1).
5. Install the SD card into the SD card slot 2 (for service use).
6. Turn on the main power switch.
7. Enter the SP mode.
8. Do SP5-846-051 (Backup All Addr Book).
9. Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.
10. Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2.
11. Install the SD slot cover.
If the capacity of SD card is not enough to store the local user information, an error message is
displayed.
Carefully handle the SD card, which contains user information. Do not take it back to your
location.
675
5. System Maintenance
Upload
1. Turn off the main power switch of the main machine.
2. Remove the SD slot cover at the left rear side of the machine (
x 1).
3. Install the SD card, which has already been uploaded, into the SD card slot 2.
4. Turn on the main power switch.
5. Enter the SP mode.
6. Do SP5-846-052 (Restore All Addr Book).
7. Exit the SP mode, and then turn off the main power switch.
8. Remove the SD card form the SD card slot 2.
9. Install the SD slot cover.
676
677
5. System Maintenance
The default setting is 0 (OFF). This feature must be switched on in order for the debug
information to be saved.
4. Select the target destination where the debug information will be saved. Under 5857 Save Debug
Log, touch 2 Target, enter 2 with the operation panel key to select the hard disk as the target
destination. Then press .
Select 3 SD Card to save the debug information directly to the SD card if it is inserted in the
service slot.
5. Now touch 5858 and specify the events that you want to record in the debug log. SP5858 (Debug
Save When) provides the following items for selection.
1
Engine SC Error
Controller SC Error
Any SC Error
Jam
678
For details about SC code numbers, please refer to the SC tables in Section 4. Troubleshooting.
6. Select one or more memory modules for reading and recording debug information. Touch 5859.
Under 5859 press the necessary key item for the module that you want to record.
Enter the appropriate 4-digit number. Then press
Refer to the two tables below for the 4-digit numbers to enter for each key.
The example below shows Key 1 with 2222 entered.
679
5. System Maintenance
The following keys can be set with the corresponding numbers. (The initials in parentheses indicate
the names of the modules.)
4-Digit Entries for Keys 1 to 10
Key No.
Copy
Printer
Scanner
2222 (SCS)
14000 (SRM)
256 (IMH)
1000 (ECS)
1025 (MCS)
Web
4848 (COPY)
4400 (GPS)
5375 (Scan)
5682 (NFA)
2224 (BICU)
4500 (PDL)
5682 (NFA)
6600 (WebDB)
4600 (GPS-PM)
3000 (UCS)
3300 (PTS)
2000 (NCS)
2000 (NCS)
6666 (WebSys)
10
2224 (BICU)
4126 (DCS)
2000 (NCS)
680
Acronym
Meaning
Acronym
Meaning
ECS
NFA
GPS
GW Print Service
PDL
GSP-PM
Print Server
IMH
SCS
MCS
SRM
System Resource
Management
NCS
WebDB
7. The machine is now set to record the debugging information automatically on the HDD (the target
selected with SP5857-002) for the events that you selected with SP5858 and the memory modules
selected with SP5859.
Please keep the following important points in mind when you do this setting:
Note that the number entries for Keys 1 to 5 are the same for the Copy, Printer, Scanner, and Web
memory modules.
The initial settings are all zero.
These settings remain in effect until you change them. Be sure to check all the settings, especially the
settings for Keys 6 to 10. To switch off a key setting, enter a zero for that key.
You can select any number of keys from 1 to 10 (or all) by entering the corresponding 4-digit numbers
from the table.
You cannot mix settings for the groups (COPY, PRINTER, etc.) for 006 to 010. For example, if you
want to create a PRINTER debug log you must select the settings from the 9 available selections for
the PRINTER column only.
One area of the disk is reserved to store the debug log. The size of this area is limited to 4 MB.
2. On the control panel, enter 01. Then hold down for at least 3 seconds until the machine beeps
and then release it. This saves the debug log to the hard disk for later retrieval with an SD card by the
service representatives.
681
5. System Maintenance
This SP copies the log on an SD card (the file that contains the information written directly from shared
memory) to a log specified by key number. The copy operation is executed in the log directory of the SD
card inserted in the same slot. (This function does not copy from one slot to another.) Each SD card can
hold up to 4 MB of file data. Unique file names are created for the data during the copy operation to
prevent overwriting files of the same name. This means that log data from more than one machine can be
copied onto the same SD card. This command does not execute if there is no log on the HDD for the name
of the specified key.
682
Card Save (Add): Appends files to the SD Card. Does not overwrite existing files. If the card
becomes full or if all file names are used, an error will be displayed on the operation panel.
Subsequent jobs will not be stored.
Card Save (New): Overwrites files in the card's /prt/cardsave directory.
Limitation:
Card Save cannot be used with PJL Status Readback commands. PJL Status Readbacks will not work.
In addition they will cause the Card Save to fail.
Procedure
1. Turn the main power switch OFF.
2. Insert the SD card into slot 2. Then turn the power ON.
3. Enter SP mode.
4. Select the Printer Sp.
5. Select SP-1001 "Bit Switch.
683
5. System Maintenance
6. Select Bit Switch 1 Settings and use the numeric keypad to turn bit 4 ON and then press the #
button to register the change. The result should look like: 00010000. By doing this, Card Save option
will appear in the List/Test Print menu.
684
10. Card Save (Add) and Card Save (New) should be displayed on the screen. Select Card Save (Add)
or Card Save (New).
685
5. System Maintenance
13. Card Save should be displayed in the top left of the display panel.
14. Send a job to the printer. The Communicating light should start blinking as shown below.
15. As soon as the printer receives the data, it will be stored on the SD card automatically with no print
output. Nothing is displayed on the screen, indicating that a Card Save operation was successful.
16. Press Offline and then the Clear/Stop button to exit Card Save mode.
686
17. Change the Bit Switch Settings back to the default 00000000. Press the # button in the numeric
keypad to register the changes.
18. Remove the SD card after the main power switch is turned off.
Error Messages
Card Save error messages:
Init error: A card save process (e.g. card detection, change to kernel mode) failed to initialize.
Card not found: Card cannot be detected in the slot.
No memory: Insufficient working memory to process the job.
Write error: Failed to write to the card.
Other error: An unknown error occurred.
If an error occurs, pressing OK will cause the device to discard the job and return to the ready state.
687
5. System Maintenance
688
6. Troubleshooting
SC Tables
Service Call Conditions
Summary
The SC Table section shows the SC codes for controller errors and other errors. The latter (not controller
errors) are put into four types. The type is determined by their reset procedures. The table shows the
classification of the SC codes.
Key
Controller
errors
Other errors
CTL
Definition
The error has occurred in the
controller.
Reset Procedure
See "Troubleshooting Procedure" in the
table.
The error involves the fusing unit. The Turn the main switch off and on. Reset
machine operation is disabled. The the SC (set SP5-810-1). Turn the main
user cannot reset the error.
switch off and on.
After you turn the main power switch off, wait for one second or more before you turn the main power
switch on ( SC 672). All SCs are logged. The print log data (SP5-990-004) in SP mode can check the
latest 10 SC codes detected and total counters when the SC code is detected.
If the problem concerns electrical circuit boards, first disconnect then reconnect the connectors before
you replace the PCBs.
689
6. Troubleshooting
If the problem concerns a motor lock, first check the mechanical load before you replace motors or
sensors.
SC Code Classification
The table shows the classification of the SC codes:
Class 1
1XX
2XX
Section
Scanning
Laser exposure
3XX
4XX
690
Image development 1
Image development 2
SC Code
Detailed section
100 -
Scanner
190 -
200 -
Polygon motor
220 -
Synchronization control
230 -
240 -
LD control
280 -
290 -
Shutter
300 -
Charge
330 -
Drum potential
350 -
Development
380 -
400 -
Image transfer
420 -
Paper separation
430 -
Cleaning
440 -
Around drum
460 -
Unit
480 -
Others
SC Tables
Class 1
5XX
5XX
6XX
7XX
8XX
9XX
Section
Communication
Peripherals
Controller
Others
SC Code
Detailed section
500 -
Paper feed
515 -
Duplex
520 -
Paper transport
530 -
Fan motor
540 -
Fusing
560 -
Others
570 -
600 -
Electrical counters
620 -
Mechanical counters
630 -
Account control
640 -
CSS
650 -
Network
670 -
680 -
700 -
Original handling
720 -
Two-tray finisher
740 -
Booklet finisher
800 -
820 -
Diagnostics error
860 -
Hard disk
880 -
900 -
Counter
920 -
Memory
990 -
Others
691
6. Troubleshooting
SC1xx: Scanning
No.
Type
101
Type
120
692
SC Tables
No.
Type
121
No.
Type
141
Harness disconnected
Defective SBU
1. Check the cable connection
2. Replace the SBU.
693
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
142
Type
144
Defective harness
Defective detection port on the BICU
1. Replace the harness.
2. Replace the SBU.
3. Replace the BICU.
No.
161
694
Type
D
SC Tables
No.
Type
001
No.
Type
165
A device check error occurs when the copy data security function is set "ON"
with the initial setting.
Incorrect installation of the copy data security board
Defective copy data security board
1. Reinstall the copy data security board.
2. Replace the copy data security board.
No.
Type
195
NVRAM defective
BICU replaced without original NVRAM
1. Check the serial number with SP5-811-002.
2. If the stored serial number is incorrect, contact your supervisor.
695
6. Troubleshooting
SC 2xx: Exposure
No.
Type
202
6
No.
Type
203
696
SC Tables
No.
Type
204
No.
Type
210
211
212
213
The laser synchronizing detection signal for the end position of LDB [K], [Y], [M],
[C] is not detected for one second after the LDB unit turned on when detecting the
main scan magnification.
Disconnected or defective harness to synchronizing detector for end position
Defective synchronizing detector board
-
No.
Type
220
222
226
697
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
Defective LDB
Defective BICU
1. Check the connectors.
2. Replace the laser-synchronizing detector.
3. Replace the LDB.
4. Replace the BICU.
No.
Type
230
No.
Type
231
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [K].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
698
SC Tables
No.
Type
232
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [Y].
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
233
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [Y].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
FGATE ON error: M
234
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [M].
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
235
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [M].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
699
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
236
The PFGATE ON signal does not assert within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for start position [C].
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
237
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts within 5 seconds after processing the image
in normal job or MUSIC for end position [C].
The PFGATE ON signal still asserts when the next job starts.
See SC 230 for troubleshooting details.
No.
Type
240
LD error: K
241
LD error: Y
242
LD error: M
243
LD error: C
The BICU detects LDB error a few times consecutively when LDB unit turns on after
LDB initialization.
Worn-out LD
700
SC Tables
No.
Type
285
Type
312
313
314
315
Defective PCDU
Defective HVPS
1. Check or replace the harnesses of the HVPS.
2. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
3. Replace the HVPS.
701
6. Troubleshooting
Type
360
361
362
363
Defective TD sensor.
1. Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector and harness
between the TD sensor and PCDU for damage.
2. Check the drawer connector.
3. Replace the defective PCDU.
No.
702
Type
364
365
366
367
SC Tables
No.
Type
TD sensor defective
1. Check the black, magenta, cyan, or yellow TD sensor connector and harness
between the TD sensor and PCDU for damage.
2. Check the drawer connector.
3. Replace the defective PCDU.
No.
Type
372
373
374
375
During TD sensor initialization, the output value of the black, magenta, cyan, or
yellow TD sensor is not within the range of the specified value with SP3238-001 to
-004 (default: 2.5V) 0.2V
Heat seal not removed from a new developer pack
-
TD sensor defective
Harness between TD sensor and drawer disconnected, defective
1. Remove the heat seal from each PCDU.
2. Replace the defective PCDU.
No.
Type
380
381
382
703
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
383
No.
Type
396
397
398
399
Defective harness
Shorted 24 V fuse on the PSU
Defective interlock system
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the drum/development motor.
3. Replace the 24V fuse on the PSU.
704
SC Tables
Type
400
Type
441
Motor overload
Defective image transfer unit motor
1. Replace the image transfer belt unit.
2. Replace the IOB.
705
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
442
No.
Type
443
706
SC Tables
No.
Type
452
No.
Type
460
707
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
490
No.
Type
491
708
SC Tables
No.
Type
492
Broken harness
Defective image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit
Defective high voltage supply unit
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the image transfer belt unit or paper transfer unit.
3. Replace the high voltage supply unit.
No.
Type
The thermistor output of the temperature sensor was not within the prescribed
range (0.2V to 3.5V).
498
The thermistor output of the humidity sensor was not within the prescribed range
(0.01V to 2.4V).
Temperature and humidity sensor harness disconnected, loose, defective
Temperature and humidity sensor defective
1. Check the connector and harness.
2. Replace the temperature/humidity sensor.
Type
501
502
709
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
710
SC Tables
No.
Type
503-0
1
711
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
503-0
2
If the upper limit does not go off for 1.5 seconds even the tray lift motor turns
on to lower the tray after the upper limit has been detected at power on.
B
712
SC Tables
No.
Type
504-0
1
If the upper or lower limit is not detected within 8 seconds when the tray lift motor is
turned on to lift up or lower the tray
Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection
Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection
1. Check the cable connections.
2. Check and/or replace the defective component.
No.
Type
If the upper limit does not go off for 1.5 seconds even the tray lift motor turns
on to lower the tray after the upper limit has been detected at power on.
Defective tray lift motor or connector disconnection
Defective lift sensor or connector disconnection
1. Check the cable connections.
2. Check and/or replace the defective component.
No.
505
Type
713
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
-01
When the tray lift sensor of the LCT 1200-sheet does not go on after the pickup roller solenoid has turned on at power on.
Tray lift motor defective or disconnected
Tray lift sensor defective or disconnected
1. Check the harness connections.
2. Replace the tray lift motor.
3. Replace the tray lift sensor.
Both tray lift sensor and lower limit sensor are turned on at the same time when the
main power is turned on or the right door is closed.
Tray lift motor defective or disconnected
Tray lift sensor defective or disconnected
-02
No.
Type
530
714
SC Tables
No.
Type
531
No.
Type
532
715
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
533
No.
Type
534
716
SC Tables
No.
Type
535
No.
Type
The motor lock signal error is detected for 10 seconds after the motor lock signal
was first detected.
Defective third duct fan motor
536
717
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
540
Motor overload
Defective fusing/paper exit motor
1. Check or replace the harness.
2. Replace the fusing/paper exit motor.
No.
Type
6
541
No.
Type
542
718
SC Tables
No.
Type
543
Defective IOB
Defective BICU
Related SC code: SC 553
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.
No.
Type
During stand-by mode or a print job, the temperature detected by the heating roller
thermopile reaches 250 C.
Defective PSU
Defective IOB
544
Defective BICU
Defective fusing control system
Related SC code: SC 543
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.
719
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
545
No.
Type
The zero cross signal is not detected for 2 seconds even though the heater relay
is on after turning on the main power or closing the front door.
547
The detection error occurs twice or more in the 11 zero cross signal detections.
This error is defined when the detected zero cross signal is less than 45.
Defective fusing lamp relay
Defective fusing lamp relay circuit
Unstable power supply
1. Check the power supply source.
2. Replace the PSU
720
SC Tables
No.
Type
551
No.
Type
The temperature at the end of the heating roller does not reach the ready
temperature for 89 seconds after the IH inverter turned on.
552
721
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
553
Defective IOB
Defective BICU
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.
No.
Type
554
Defective BICU
Defective fusing control system
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.
No.
Type
555
722
SC Tables
No.
Type
557
No.
Type
559
Type
561
Defective thermopile
Defective pressure roller thermistor
1. Check if the pressure roller thermistor is firmly connected.
2. Replace the thermopile.
3. Replace the pressure roller thermistor.
723
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
563
Defective IOB
Defective BICU
1. Replace the PSU.
2. Replace the IOB.
3. Replace the BICU.
No.
Type
564
Defective BICU
Defective fusing control system
1. Replace the thermistor.
2. Replace the PSU.
3. Replace the IOB.
4. Replace the BICU.
724
SC Tables
No.
Type
565
No.
Type
No.
Type
571
725
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
581
Defective IH inverter
1. Check if the power supply voltage of the customer site is within the proper
power voltage range.
2. Check CN981 on the IH inverter.
3. Replace the IH inverter.
No.
Type
582
726
SC Tables
No.
Type
585
Type
610
611
727
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
620
No.
Type
621
622
IOB problems
BICU problems
PSU problems in the machine
Main board problems in the peripherals
1. Check if the cables of peripherals are correctly connected.
2. Replace the PSU if no power is supplied to peripherals.
3. Replace the IOB or main board of peripherals.
4. Replace the BICU.
728
SC Tables
No.
Type
623
When a communication error signal between the 1st paper bank and 2nd paper
bank is received.
Loose or disconnected connector
Check the connection between the main machine and paper feed unit.
No.
Type
632
CTL
B
After 3 attempts to send a data frame to the optional counter device via the serial
communication line, no ACK signal was received within 100 ms.
Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board and copier
control board is disconnected or damaged
Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter device.
Check the connection between the main machine and optional counter device.
No.
Type
633
CTL
B
Serial line between the optional counter device, the relay board and copier
control board is disconnected or damaged
Make sure that SP5113 is set to enable the optional counter device.
1. Check if the setting of the SP5113 is correctly set.
2. Check the connection between the main machine and optional counter device.
729
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
634
CTL
B
No.
Type
635
CTL
B
No.
636
Type
CTL
-01
730
SC Tables
No.
Type
-02
No.
Type
CTL
641
Type
CTL
650
-001
Incorrect SP settings
Disconnected telephone line
Disconnected modem board
Check and set the correct user name (SP5816-156) and password (SP5816-157).
Incorrect modem setting
-004
731
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
-005
The supplied voltage is not sufficient due to the defective communication line or
defective connection.
Same as -001
Consult with the user's local telephone company.
No.
Type
651
CTL
C
No.
Type
669
Retry of EEPROM communication fails three times after the machine has detected
the EEPROM error.
Caused by noise
Turn the main power switch off and on.
No.
Type
670
CTL
D
732
SC Tables
CTL
D
No.
Type
672
CTL
D
Controller stall
733
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
681
No.
Type
682
No.
Type
683
The machine gets RFID communication error even the toner cartridges have not been
installed in the machine.
Caused by noise
Turn the main power switch off and on.
734
SC Tables
No.
Type
687
Defective controller
Defective BICU
1. Check if the controller is firmly connected to the BICU.
2. Replace the controller.
3. Replace the BICU.
No.
Type
Loose connection
Defective BICU
Defective LD controller board
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Check the cable connection.
3. Replace the laser optics-housing unit.
4. Replace the BICU board.
735
6. Troubleshooting
SC7xx: Peripherals
No.
Type
721
The 1st failure issues an original jam message, and the 2nd failure issues this SC
code.
Type
723
The 1st detection failure causes a jam error, and the 2nd failure causes this SC
code.
Defective stack feed-out HP sensor
Overload on the stack feed-out motor
Defective stack feed-out motor
Defective main board
Disconnected or defective harness
736
SC Tables
No.
Type
No.
Type
725
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
2. Check for blockages in the guide plate motor mechanism.
3. Replace the guide plate position sensor and/or guide plate motor
4. Replace the finisher main board.
No.
Type
730
737
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
740
The HP sensor of the staple unit detects the home position after the staple unit
moves from its home position.
Staple jam
Motor overload
Defective stapler motor
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
Type
742
738
SC Tables
No.
Type
746
No.
Type
739
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
760
No.
Type
761
740
SC Tables
No.
Type
763
No.
Type
764
No.
Type
765
741
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
766
No.
Type
The shift motor HP sensor does not detect any change for 1.86 seconds after the
shift motor has turned on at power on or during its operation.
770
No.
Type
791
Defective connector
Broken harness
1. Check the connections between the bridge unit and the machine.
2. Install a new bridge unit.
742
SC Tables
No.
Type
792
Defective harness
Incorrect installation
1. Check the connections between the finisher and the machine.
2. Install a new finisher.
No.
Type
798
-1
743
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
798
-02
Type
798
-03
744
SC Tables
No.
Type
798
-04
745
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
798
-05
Type
798
-06
The stapler HP sensor does not detect "ON" when a stapling job is commanded
or the stapler moves.
Staple jam
Motor overload
Defective stapler motor
1. Check the connections and cables for the components mentioned above.
2. Replace the HP sensor and/or stapler motor
3. Replace the finisher main board.
746
SC Tables
No.
Type
798
-07
Motor overload
B
Type
798
-08
747
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
798
-09
Type
816
CTL
D
No.
819
748
Type
CTL
C
[0x5032]
HAIC-P2 error
[0x5245]
vm_pageout: VM is full
[0x5355]
[554C]
USB error
SC Tables
No.
820
Type
CTL
[0612]
No.
833
[0F30]
[0F31]
[0F41]
Type
CTL
C
[50B1]
[50B2]
749
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
851
CTL
B
Defective IEEE1394
Defective controller.
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Replace the IEEE1394 interface board.
3. Replace the controller.
No.
Type
853
CTL
B
The wireless LAN card is not detected before communication is established, though
the wireless LAN board is detected.
Loose connection
Check the connection.
No.
Type
854
CTL
B
750
SC Tables
No.
Type
855
CTL
856
Loose connection
Defective wireless LAN/Bluetooth card
1. Check the connection.
2. Replace the wireless LAN/Bluetooth card.
No.
Type
857
CTL
B
858
Type
CTL
C
[1]
751
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
[30]
[31]
752
SC Tables
No.
Type
859
Unformatted HDD
The encryption key on the controller is different from the one on the
HDD
CTL
The data encryption (NVRAM and HDD) has not been completed.
[10]
No.
Type
860
CTL
B
753
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
861
CTL
D
Defective cables
Defective HDD
Defective controller
1. Check the connection between the HDD and controller.
2. Check and replace the cables.
3. Replace the HDD.
4. Replace the controller.
No.
Type
863
CTL
D
Defective HDD
Defective controller
1. Replace the HDD.
2. Replace the controller.
No.
Type
864
CTL
D
While reading data from the HDD or storing data in the HDD, data transmission
fails.
Defective HDD
Replace the HDD.
754
SC Tables
No.
Type
865
CTL
D
No.
Type
866
CTL
B
No.
Type
SD card error
867
CTL
D
No.
Type
868
CTL
D
755
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
870
CTL
B
Defective HDD
Incorrect path to the server
1. Initialize the address book data (SP5-846-050).
2. Initialize the user information (SP5-832-006).
3. Replace the HDD.
No.
Type
CTL
B
Defective HDD
Power failure during an access to the HDD
1. Turn the main switch off and on.
2. Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-007).
3. Replace the HDD.
No.
Type
873
CTL
B
Defective HDD
Power failure during an access to the HDD
1. Initialize the HDD partition (SP5-832-008).
2. Replace the HDD.
756
SC Tables
No.
Type
874
CTL
D
No.
Type
875
CTL
D
An error is detected while all of the HDD or NVRAM are formatted logically by the
Data Overwrite Security Unit (D377).
The logical format for the HDD fails.
Turn the main switch off/on and try the operation again
No.
876
Type
CTL
D
-001
-002
757
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
-003
-004
-005
No.
Type
877
CTL
D
758
SC Tables
No.
Type
878
CTL
D
No.
Type
880
CTL
D
SC9xx: Miscellaneous
No.
Type
900
CTL
D
Defective NVRAM
Defective controller
1. Check the connection between the NVRAM and controller.
2. Replace the NVRAM.
3. Replace the controller.
759
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
910
911
912
913
914
No.
6
919
CTL
D
While EAC (External Application Converter), the conversion module, was operating
normally, the receipt of a power line interrupt signal from the FLUTE serial driver was
detected, or BREAK signal from the other station was detected.
Power outage at the EFI controller
EFI controller was rebooted
Connection to EFI controller loose
No.
Type
920
CTL
D
Defective software
Unexpected hardware resource (e.g., memory shortage)
1. Software defective; switch off/on, or change the controller firmware if the
problem is not solved
2. Insufficient memory
760
SC Tables
No.
Type
921
CTL
D
No.
Type
990
CTL
D
Defective controller
Software error
Type
991
CTL
C
761
6. Troubleshooting
No.
Type
992
CTL
D
No.
Type
994
CTL
C
An error occurred because the number of records exceeded the limit for images
managed in the service layer of the firmware. This can occur if there if there are too
many application screens open on the operation panel.
No action required because this SC does not interfere with operation of the
machine.
No.
995
Type
D
-001
-002
-003
Defective controller
1. Replace the controller with the correct type.
-004
762
SC Tables
No.
Type
997
CTL
B
No.
Type
CTL
D
Software problem
1. Check the setting of SP5875-001. If the setting is set to "1 (OFF)", change it
to "0 (OFF)".
2. Check if the RAM-DIMM and ROM-DIMM are correctly connected.
3. Reinstall the controller system firmware.
4. Replace the controller.
Note 1
If a problem always occurs in a specific condition (for example. printer driver setting, image file), the
problem may be caused by a software error. In this case, the following data and information needs to be
sent back to your product specialist. Please understand that it may take some time to get a reply on how
to solve the problem, because in some cases the design staff in Japan must analyze the data.
Symptom / Possible Causes / Action taken
Summary sheet (SP mode "Printer SP", SP1-004 [Print Summary])
763
6. Troubleshooting
764
Result
Successfully
completed
Description
Developer initialization is
successfully completed.
Possible Causes/Action
A cover was opened or the main switch was
turned off during the initialization.
Forced
termination
Developer initialization
was forcibly terminated.
Vt error
Vcnt error 1
Vcnt error 2
Vcnt error 3
1. Defective TD sensor
2. Vt target settings are not correct.
3. Toner density error
765
6. Troubleshooting
The machine starts developer initialization after you set Enable in SP3-902-005, 006, 007, or
008. Developer initialization automatically resumes when you open and close the front door or turn
the main switch off and on if an error other than Error 8 occurs.
Successfully
completed
Description
Possible Causes/Action
Process control self-check Check the Vsg adjustment. See the "Vsg
successfully completed.
Adjustment Result" following this table.
Defective development unit
Vt error
Vt maximum or minimum
error is detected.
53
ID sensor
coefficient (K5)
detection error
766
No. Result
Description
Possible Causes/Action
54
ID sensor
coefficient (K5)
maximum/
minimum error
55
Gamma error:
Maximum
56
Gamma error:
Minimum
Hardware defective.
1. Same as 53
2. Replace the toner supply pump unit.
57
Vk error:
Maximum
Vk is out of range.
150 < Vk
Hardware defective.
Same as 53
ID sensor pattern density is too high.
58
Vk error:
Minimum
Vk is out of range.
Background dirty
Vk < 150
Hardware defective
Same as 53
59
99
Sampling data
error during
gamma
correction
Unexpected
error
767
6. Troubleshooting
Description
Possible Causes/Action
Vsg adjustment is
correctly done.
O.K
ID sensor
adjustment
error
Vsg cannot be
adjusted within 4.0
0.5V.
Defective IOB
1. Clean the ID sensor.
2. Check the belt cleaning. Clean or replace the transfer
belt.
3. Replace the image transfer belt.
4. Replace the ID sensor.
5. Check the connection.
6. Replace the IOB board.
Defective ID sensor
ID sensor
output error
ID sensor output is
more than "Voffset
Threshold" (SP3-32
4-004)
Poor connection
Defective IOB
1. Replace the ID sensor.
2. Check the connection.
3. Replace the IOB board.
Vsg
Adjustment
error
Other cases
Retry SP3-321-010.
No.
Result
Description
Note
Not done
Completed
successfully
Cannot detect
patterns
See Note
Out of the
adjustment range
See Note
Not used
6-9
For details, see the "Troubleshooting Guide - Line Position Adjustment" section.
769
6. Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting Guide
Image Quality
The following work-flow shows the basic troubleshooting steps for the image quality problems on this
product.
770
Troubleshooting Guide
771
6. Troubleshooting
Test
1. Do SP2-111-003 (Mode c: rough adjustment).
2. Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed
successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to Countermeasure list for color registration
errors.
3. Do SP2-111-001 (Mode a: fine adjustment twice).
4. Use SP2-194-007 to check if the result of the line position adjustment is correct (0: Completed
successfully, 1: Not completed). If the result is "1", refer to Countermeasure list for color registration
errors.
5. Put some A3/DLT paper on the by-pass tray.
When you print a test pattern, use the by-pass tray to feed the paper.
6. Print out test pattern "7" with SP2-109-003.
7. Check the printed output with a loupe.
8. If there are no color registration errors on the output, the line position adjustment is correctly done. If
not, refer to the countermeasure list for color registration errors.
772
Troubleshooting Guide
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective laser optics housing unit shutter
Defective image processing unit
Low density of test pattern
Defective BICU
1. Replace the shutter motor.
2. Replace the high voltage power supply unit.
3. Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply
some toner (SP3-015-xxx).
4. Replace the BICU.
Defective ID sensor shutter
Defective ID sensor
Defective BICU
1. Replace the ID sensor shutter solenoid.
2. Replace the ID sensor.
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective BICU
1. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
2. Replace the BICU.
Defective image transfer belt
Defective drive units
Defective BICU
1. Replace the image transfer belt.
2. Replace the drum motor.
3. Replace the BICU.
773
6. Troubleshooting
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective ID sensor at center
Deformed center area on the image transfer belt
Defective BICU
1. Replace the ID sensor.
2. Replace the image transfer belt.
3. Replace the BICU.
Defective PCDU
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective BICU
1. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.
Others
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Do SP2-111-001 or -002.
774
Troubleshooting Guide
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Low density
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Low pattern density
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some
toner (SP3-015-xxx).
No defective component
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective BICU
1. Do SP2-111-003 again.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.
775
6. Troubleshooting
Possible cause/Countermeasure
No defective component
Defective image transfer belt
Defective drive units
Defective BICU
1. Do SP2-111-003 again.
2. Replace the image transfer belt.
3. Replace the drum motor.
4. Replace the BICU.
Defective PCDU
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective BICU
1. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the BICU.
Others
776
Troubleshooting Guide
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Abnormal SP setting value of main scan: K
Adjust the value with SP2-101-001.
Abnormal SP setting value of main scan length detection:
K
Adjust the value with SP2-185-001.
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Low pattern density
Do the forced process control (SP3-011-001) or supply some
toner (SP3-015-xxx).
777
6. Troubleshooting
Possible cause/Countermeasure
Defective image transfer belt
Defective drive units
Defective ID sensor
Defective BICU
Incorrect SP value
1. Replace the image transfer belt.
2. Replace the ID sensor.
3. Replace the drum motor.
4. Replace the BICU.
5. Adjust the value with SP2-182-022 to -039.
Defective PCDU
Defective laser optics housing unit
Defective IOB
1. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
2. Replace the laser optics housing unit.
3. Replace the IOB.
The sub scan lines are shifted. Shifted
lines appear cyclically.
Defective PCDU
Defective drive unit
Drum phase adjustment error
1. Do SP1-902-001 (Drum phase adjustment); see
Replacement and Adjustment Drive Unit Gear Unit for
details.
2. Reinstall or replace the PCDU.
3. Check or replace the drive unit.
778
Troubleshooting Guide
2. Make a sample copy, and then check if a stain appears on the output.
779
6. Troubleshooting
780
Troubleshooting Guide
781
6. Troubleshooting
6
Countermeasure 1
1. Check if the toner supply tube is bent or disconnected.
1. Straighten the toner supply tube or connect it correctly.
Countermeasure 2
1. Remove the target color toner bottle.
1. Disconnect the toner supply tube from the toner pump unit.
2. Remove the blocked toner in the toner supply tube with a vacuum cleaner.
Countermeasure 3
Replace the toner pump unit (
Countermeasure 4
Replace the PCDU (
782
p.205).
p.214).
Troubleshooting Guide
The toner density of a solid image or halftone image may not be uniform ([A]: problem output, [B]: normal
output) if a large amount of sheets is printed at low coverage. If this occurs, follow the countermeasure
below.
Recovery Procedure
1. Enter the SP mode.
1. Set SP3-044-xxx (Toner Supply Type) to "1: PID (Vref Fixed)".
Chose a target color SP number from -001 (Bk), -002 (Magenta), -003 (Cyan), and -004
(Yellow).
2. Set SP3-222-xxx (Vtref: Display/Set) to "4V".
Chose a target color SP number from -001 (Bk), -002 (Magenta), -003 (Cyan), and -004
(Yellow).
3. Set SP2-109-003 (Test Pattern; Pattern Selection) to "23: Full Dot Pattern".
4. Set SP2-109-005 (Test Pattern; Color Selection) to "1: All Color (black)", "2: Magenta", "3: Cyan",
or "4: Yellow".
Chose a target color selection number.
5. Press "Copy Window" on the LCD.
6. Copy 20 sheets for A4 size or 30 sheets for A3 size, and then check the setting of SP3-222-xxx (Vtref:
Display/Set).
If the setting of this SP is more than 4V, go to next step. If not, copy again until the setting of this
SP is more than 4V.
7. Return the setting of SP3-044-xxx (Toner Supply Type) to "4: MBD (Vref_Control)".
Return the setting of the SP which you have changed in step 2 before.
783
6. Troubleshooting
Faulty Cleaning
Black or color lines (2-3mm)
Possible Cause:
Wear of the cleaning blade at a specific point by image creation in the same place many times.
Solution:
Replace the drum unit.
784
Troubleshooting Guide
6
Possible Cause:
Developer wear with time
Solution:
Replace the developer or the development unit.
785
6. Troubleshooting
Jam Detection
Paper Jam Display
SP7-507 shows the paper jam history.
786
LCD
Display
Description
7504 3
Tray 1: ON
7504 4
Tray 2: ON
7504 5
Tray 3: ON
7504 6
Tray 4: ON
7504 7
LCT: ON
7504 8
Bypass: ON
7504 9
Duplex: ON
7504 10
7504 11
Vertical Transport 1: ON
Jam Detection
LCD
Display
Description
7504 12
Vertical Transport 2: ON
7504 13
Bank Transport 1
7504 15
7504 16
7504 17
Registration: ON
7504 18
Fusing Entrance: ON
7504 19
Fusing Exit: ON
7504 20
Paper Exit: ON
7504 21
Relay Exit: ON
7504 22
Relay Transport: ON
7504 23
7504 24
7504 25
Duplex Exit: ON
7504 26
Duplex Entrance: ON (In) Duplex entrance sensor does not detect paper.
7504 27
Duplex Entrance: ON
(Out)
7504 28
7504 51
SEF Sensor 1
7504 52
SEF Sensor 2
7504 53
7504 54
787
6. Troubleshooting
Description
7504 55
7504 56
7504 57
Regist Sensor
7504 58
LCT Sensor
7504 59
LCD
Display
7504 60
Exit Sensor
7504 61
7504 62
Relay Sensor
7504 63
7504 64
7504 65
7504 66
Duplex Entrance: OFF (In) Duplex entrance sensor does not turn off.
7504 67
7504 68
7504 100
R1-R2
7504 101
R1-R2
7504 102
R3-R5
788
7504 103
7504 104
R3-R5
Jam Detection
7504 105
7504 106
7504 107
7504 108
Description
Stack height sensor does not detect paper after
the lower tray has lifted up.
Stack height sensor still detects paper after the
lower tray has lifted down.
Jogger fence HP sensor does not turn off after
the jogger fence has moved from its home
position.
Jogger fence HP sensor does not turn on after
the jogger fence has returned to its home
position.
Shift roller HP sensor does not turn off after the
shift roller has moved from its home position.
Shift roller HP sensor does not turn on after the
shift roller has returned to its home position.
Stapler HP sensor does not turn off after the
stapler has moved from its home position.
Stapler HP sensor does not turn on after the
stapler has returned to its home position.
Stack feed-out belt HP sensor does not turn off
after the stack feed-out belt has moved from its
home position.
LCD
Display
R1-R2
R3-R5
R1-R2
R3-R5
7504 109
7504 191
R1-R4
7504 192
R1-R4
7504 193
R1-R4
R3-R5
789
6. Troubleshooting
7504 194
Description
Stapling tray paper sensor does not turn on
after the finisher entrance sensor has turned on.
Stapling tray paper sensor does not turn off
after it has turned on.
LCD
Display
R5-R7
7504 195
R8-R12
7504 196
7504 197
6
7504 198
R8-R12
Fold unit exit sensor does not turn off after the
fold rollers have stopped.
7504 199
7504 200
R1-R4
R8-R12
790
R1-R4
Jam Detection
7504 202
7504 203
Description
Corner stapler HP sensor does not turn on/off
after the corner stapler movement motor has
turned on.
Stapler rotation HP sensor does not turn on/off
after the corner stapler rotation motor has
turned on.
Corner stapler does not finish stapling after a
specified time.
Booklet stapler does not finish stapling after a
specified time.
LCD
Display
R8-R12
R8-R12
7504 204
6
R8-R12
7504 206
R1-R4
791
6. Troubleshooting
792
Paper Size
Size Code
Paper Size
05
A4 LEF
141
B4 SEF
06
A5 LEF
142
B5 SEF
14
B5 LEF
160
DLT SEF
38
LT LEF
164
LG SEF
44
HLT LEF
166
LT SEF
132
A3 SEF
172
HLT SEF
133
A4 SEF
255
Others
134
A5 SEF
Jam Detection
Sensor Locations
793
6. Troubleshooting
The CN numbers in the following table are the connector numbers on the IOB.
No.
SW1
S9
Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name
Activ
e
794
CN204/1
Duplex Door
ID Sensor: M
ID Sensor: C
ID Sensor: Y
ID Sensor: Front
CN211/1
CN211/2
ID Sensor: Rear
CN211/3
Registration Sensor
CN224/A2
S1
S12
CN
CN232/B9
Condition
Symptom
Open
Shorted
Open
Shorted
CN211/
Open/
7, 11
Shorted
CN211/
Open/
8, 12
Shorted
CN211/
Open/
9, 13
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
SC400
SC258
SC400 / SC258
SC258
Open
Shorted
Jam A, B (Jam1)
No.
Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name
Activ
e
CN
S28
CN222/A2
S29
CN222/ A5
S30
CN222/ A8
S31
CN222/ A11
CN207/A1
S24
S25
S26
S27
CN207/B9
L
Condition
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open
Symptom
SC380/SC396
SC381/SC397
SC382/SC398
SC383/SC399
Toner end cannot be
detected.
CN207/
B12
CN207/
Shorted
B15
S32
S18
S21
Paper End
S24
Sensor 1, 2
S20
S23
S21
H/L
CN208/11
CN230/A7
Open/
Shorted
Open
Shorted
Jam A, B (Jam1)
Open
Shorted
CN230/
A10, B10
CN230/
Open/
A13, B13
Shorted
CN230/B7
SC443
SC501, SC502
Open
Shorted
Jam A, B (Jam1)
795
6. Troubleshooting
No.
S14
S15
S16
S17
SW4
S11
Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name
Activ
e
796
Condition
CN224/
Open/
B2, B5
Shorted
CN224/
Open/
B10, B13
Shorted
B16, B17,
B19, B20
Open/
Shorted
Shorted
Open
B12
Shorted
S8
CN232/B6
S6
CN232/A8
S7
S35
TD Sensor - K
Open
CN232/
Shorted
A15
CN232/
S10
Symptom
Open
CN224/A9
CN232/
6
SW2
CN
Open
Shorted
Jam C (Jam 1)
Open
Shorted
Jam Z (Jam 1)
CN232/
Open
A11
Shorted
Jam Z (Jam 1)
CN227/A7
Open/
Shorted
SC372
No.
Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name
Activ
e
S36
TD Sensor - M
S37
TD Sensor - C
S38
TD Sensor - Y
S4
S13
SW4
CN
CN227/
Open/
A15
Shorted
CN227/B7
Open/
Shorted
CN227/
Open/
B15
Shorted
CN204/12
SC373
SC374
SC375
Jam C (Jam 19)
Shorted
Jam C (Jam 1)
Open
Shorted
Open
Shorted
CN224/A7
A11, A12,
A13, A15
Symptom
Open
CN224/A5
CN224/
SW6
Condition
Open/
Shorted
SC498
S33
Temperature/
Humidity Sensor
CN231/
Open/
25, 27
Shorted
797
6. Troubleshooting
No.
S34
TH2
TH1
S3
Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name
Thermopile
Thermistor
- Heating Roller
Thermistor
- Pressure Roller
Paper Exit Sensor
Activ
e
CN
CN209/16
CN212/22
CN212/18
CN204/9
6
S5
S43
S39
Scanner HP Sensor
S41
S42
798
Condition
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Open/
Shorted
Symptom
SC541
SC551
SC561
Open
Shorted
Jam C (Jam 1)
Open
Shorted
CN204/15
CN313/14
Open/
SIO
Shorted
CN313/11
Open/
SIO
Shorted
CN313/8
Open/
SIO
Shorted
CN313/5
Open/
SIO
Shorted
CN313/2
Open/
SIO
Shorted
CN318/2
Open
SC120
SIO
Shorted
SC121
No.
Sensor Name/
Sensor Board Name
Activ
e
S40
S2
CN
Condition
CN318/5
Open/
SIO
Shorted
CN204/6
Open/
Shorted
Symptom
Platen cover open cannot
be detected.
Jam C (Jam 24/64)
Fuse
Rating
115V
220V - 240V
FU1
15A/125V
8A/250V
FU2
10A/125V
6.3A/250V
FU3
2A/250V
1A/250V
FU4
1A/250V
1A/250V
FU5
5A/250V
5A/250V
FU6
2A/250V
2A/125V
FU7
10A/125V
10A/125V
FU8
10A/125V
10A/125V
FU9
6.3A/125V
6.3A/125V
FU10
6.3A/125V
6.3A/125V
FU11
6.3A/125V
6.3A/125V
FU12
6.3A/125V
6.3A/125V
FU13
6.3A/125V
6.3A/125V
799
6. Troubleshooting
Fuse
FU14
Rating
115V
220V - 240V
5A/250V
5A/250V
IH Inverter
Fuse
FU1
Rating
115V
220V - 240V
15A/125V
8A/250V
FU2
115C
No response
FU3
115C
No response
FU4
1A/250V
For continued protection against risk of fire, replace only with same type and rating of fuse.
800
801
6. Troubleshooting
802
7. Energy Saving
Energy Save
Energy Saver Modes
Customers should use energy saver modes properly, to save energy and protect the environment.
7
The area shaded grey in this diagram represents the amount of energy that is saved when the timers are
at the default settings. If the timers are changed, then the energy saved will be different. For example, if
the timers are all set to 240 min., the grey area will disappear, and no energy is saved before 240 min.
expires.
Timer Settings
The user can set these timers with User Tools (System settings > Timer setting)
Panel off timer (10 sec 240 min): Panel Off Mode. Default setting: 60 sec.
Energy saver timer (1 240 min): Low Power Mode. Default setting: 15 min.
Auto off timer (1 240 min): Off/Sleep Mode. Default setting: 30 min.
Normally, Panel Off timer < Energy Saver timer < Auto Off timer. But, for example, if Auto Off timer < or
= Panel Off timer and Energy Saver timer, the machine goes immediately to Off mode when the Auto Off
timer expires. It skips the Panel Off and Energy Saver modes.
Example
Panel off: 1 min.
803
7. Energy Saving
Recommendation
We recommend that the default settings should be kept.
If the customer requests that these settings should be changed, please explain that their energy costs
could increase, and that they should consider the effects on the environment of extra energy use.
If it is necessary to change the settings, please try to make sure that the Auto Off timer is not too long.
Try with a shorter setting first, such as 30 min., then go to a longer one (such as 60 min.) if the customer
is not satisfied.
If the timers are all set to the maximum value, the machine will not begin saving energy until 240
minutes has expired after the last job. This means that after the customer has finished using the machine
for the day, energy will be consumed that could otherwise be saved.
If you change the settings, the energy consumed can be measured using SP8941, as explained below.
804
Energy Save
This should only be used as a reference value, because the power consumption specifications are measured
in a controlled environment with a constant power supply.
To get an exact measurement at the customers site, a watt meter must be used to measure the actual energy
consumed.
To use SP8941 to calculate the energy consumed:
At the start of the measurement period, read the values of SP8941 001 to 005.
At the end of the measurement period, read the values of SP8941 001 to 005 again.
Find the amount of time spent in each mode (subtract the earlier measurement from the later
measurement).
Multiply this by the power consumption spec for each mode.
Convert the result to kWh (kilowatt hours)
Here is an example calculation.
Machine
SP8941:
Condition
Machine
Status
Time at Start
(min.)
Time at End
(min.)
Running
time
(hour)
Power
consumption
Spec. (W)
( - )/
60 =
Operating
Power
consumption
(KWH)
(
)/1000
=
001:
Operatin
g Time
21089.0
21386.0
5.0
1081.8
5.35
002:
Standby
Time
306163.0
308046.0
31.4
214.0
6.72
003:
Energy save
Energy
(Panel off)
Save Time
71386.0
75111.0
62.1
214.0
13.29
Low power
004: Low
Power
Time
154084.0
156340.0
37.6
146.0
5.49
Off/Sleep
005: Off
Mode
Time
508776.0
520377.0
193.4
7.0
1.35
Stand by
(Ready)
Total
32.20
805
7. Energy Saving
Paper Save
Effectiveness of Duplex/Combine Function
Duplexing and the combine functions reduce the amount of paper used. This means that less energy overall
is used for paper production, which improves the environment.
1. Duplex:
Reduce paper volume in half!
7
2. Combine mode:
Reduce paper volume in half!
3. Duplex + Combine:
Using both features together can further reduce paper volume by 3/4!
806
Paper Save
To check the paper consumption, look at the total counter and the duplex counter.
The total counter counts all pages printed.
For one duplex page, the total counter goes up by 2.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the total counter goes up by 3.
The duplex counter counts pages that have images on both sides.
For one duplex page, the duplex counter goes up by 1.
For a duplex job of a three-page original, the duplex counter will only increase by 1, even though
two sheets are used.
How to calculate the paper reduction ratio, when compared with Single-sided copying, with no 2-in-1
combine mode
Paper reduction ratio (%) = Number of sheets reduced: A/Number of printed original images: B x 100
Number of sheets reduced: A
= Output pages in duplex mode/2 + Number of pages in Single-sided with combine mode + Number
of pages in Duplex with combine mode x 3/2
A = ((2) + (3) + (4))/2 + (5) + (6) x 3/2
Number of printed original images: B
= Total counter6 + Number of pages in Single-sided with combine mode + Number of pages in Duplex
with combine mode
B = (1) + (5) + (6)
(1) Total counter: SP 8581 001 (pages)
(2) Single-sided with duplex mode: SP 8421 001 (pages)
(3) Double-sided with duplex mode: SP 8421 002 (pages)
(4) Book with duplex mode: SP 8421 003 (pages)
(5) Single-sided with combine mode: SP 8421 004 (pages)
807
7. Energy Saving
808
Model AT-C2.5
Machine Code: D086/D087
Appendices
1 November, 2010
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1. Appendix: Specifications
General Specifications.......................................................................................................................................3
Main Frame....................................................................................................................................................3
Printer...............................................................................................................................................................7
Scanner...........................................................................................................................................................9
Supported Paper Sizes....................................................................................................................................10
Paper Feed...................................................................................................................................................10
Paper Exit......................................................................................................................................................13
Platen/ARDF Original Size Detection........................................................................................................18
Software Accessories.......................................................................................................................................20
Printer Drivers...............................................................................................................................................20
Scanner and LAN Fax drivers.....................................................................................................................20
Utility Software.............................................................................................................................................21
Optional Equipment.........................................................................................................................................22
ARDF (D541)...............................................................................................................................................22
Paper Feed Unit (D537)..............................................................................................................................22
LCT 2000-sheet (D538)..............................................................................................................................23
LCT 1200-sheet (D539)..............................................................................................................................23
1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher & Punch Unit (B793)..................................................................................24
1000-Sheet Finisher (B408).......................................................................................................................25
500-Sheet Finisher (D372).........................................................................................................................26
Bridge Unit (D386)......................................................................................................................................28
Shift Tray (D388).........................................................................................................................................29
1-bin Tray Unit (D536)...............................................................................................................................29
System SP3-xxx..............................................................................................................................................155
SP3-XXX (Process).....................................................................................................................................155
System SP4-xxx..............................................................................................................................................207
SP4-XXX (Scanner)....................................................................................................................................207
System SP5-xxx..............................................................................................................................................233
SP5-XXX (Mode).......................................................................................................................................233
System SP6-xxx..............................................................................................................................................301
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)...............................................................................................................................301
System SP7-xxx..............................................................................................................................................311
SP7-XXX (Data Log)..................................................................................................................................311
System SP8-xxx..............................................................................................................................................346
SP8-xxx: Data Log2..................................................................................................................................346
Input and Output Check................................................................................................................................392
Input Check Table.....................................................................................................................................392
Output Check Table..................................................................................................................................403
Printer Service Mode.....................................................................................................................................414
SP1-XXX (Service Mode)..........................................................................................................................414
Scanner SP Mode..........................................................................................................................................421
SP1-xxx (System and Others)...................................................................................................................421
SP2-XXX (Scanning-image quality)..........................................................................................................421
Test Pattern Printing........................................................................................................................................423
INDEX...........................................................................................................................................................425
1. Appendix: Specifications
General Specifications
Main Frame
Configuration:
Print Process:
Number of scans:
Resolution:
Gradation:
Desktop
Laser beam scanning & Dry electrostatic transfer system
4 drums tandem method
1
Scan: 600 dpi
Print: 600 dpi
Scan: 600dpi / 10bits/pixel
Print: 600dpi / 4 bits/pixel
Original type:
A3/11" x 17"
Original reference
position:
1. Appendix: Specifications
Warm-up time:
General Specifications
Minimum
Tray 1
Tray 2
Print Paper Size:
By-pass
Optional Tray
2000-sheet LCT
1200-sheet LCT
Maximum
A3/11" x 17"
305 x 600 mm
A3/11" x 17"
A4 (LEF)/
257 x 182mm
297 x 210mm
Continuous copy:
Up to 999 sheets
1. Appendix: Specifications
Zoom:
Memory:
Power Source:
North America
Europe
25%
25%
50%
50%
65%
61%
73%
71%
78%
82%
85%
87%
93%
93%
100%
100%
121%
115%
129%
122%
155%
141%
200%
200%
400%
400%
Standard: 1.5 GB
120 V, 60 Hz: More than 12A (for North America)
220 V 240 V, 50/60 Hz: More than 8A (for Europe/ASIA)
-
Power Consumption:
Maximum
Energy Saver
( Sleep Mode )
120V
220 - 240V
1584 W or less
1700 W or less
2.0 W or less
2.0 W or less
General Specifications
Model
State
Standby
Mainframe
Complete system
(*1)
40 dB(A)
44 dB(A)
or Less
or Less
C2.5a
or Less
Operating
Noise Emission:
(Sound Power Level)
Standby
40 dB(A)
46.9 dB(A)
or Less
or Less
C2.5b
or Less
Operating
Printer
PCL 6/5c
RPCS (Refined Printing Command Stream)
Adobe PostScript 3 (optional)
Printer Languages:
1. Appendix: Specifications
PCL 5c:
300 x 300 dpi : Available only in B/W mode
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bits)
PCL 6:
Resolution and
Gradation:
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bits) / 1200 x 1200
dpi
RPCS:
600 x 600 dpi, 1,800 x 600 dpi*, 9600 dpi x 600 dpi*
*1,800 x 600 dpi = 600 x 600 dpi (2 bits)
*9600 dpi x 600 dpi* = 600 x 600 dpi (4 bits)
PS3:
600 x 600 dpi : Fast (1 bit), Standard (2 bits), Fine (4 bits)
C2.5a:
30 ppm in Plain/Middle Thick mode
Printing speed:
Resident Fonts:
1 Bitmap font
Adobe PostScript 3 (Optional):
136 fonts (24 Type 2 fonts, 112 Type 14 fonts)
IPDS (Optional):
108 fonts
General Specifications
Scanner
Standard Scanner
Resolution:
Available scanning
Resolution Range:
Grayscales:
Scanning Throughput
(ARDF mode):
Interface:
Compression Method:
1. Appendix: Specifications
Paper Feed
North America
BT: By-pass Tray, T1: Tray 1, T2/3/4: Tray 2/3/4, LCT 2000: Large Capacity Tray: 2000-sheet, LCT
1200: Large Capacity Tray: 1200-sheet, DU: Duplex Unit
Paper
10
Size
(W x L)
BT
T1
T2/3/
4
LCT
LCT
2000
1200
DU
A3 W
12" x 18"
A3 SEF
297 x 420mm
A4 SEF
210 x 297mm
A4 LEF
297 x 210mm
A5 SEF
148 x 210mm
A5 LEF
210 x 148mm
A6 SEF
105 x 148mm
B4 SEF
257 x 364mm
B5 SEF
182 x 257mm
B5 LEF
257 x 182mm
B6 SEF
128 x 182mm
Ledger
11" x 17"
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
Government
Legal SEF
8.25" x 14"
5.5" x 8.5"
Paper
Size
(W x L)
BT
T1
T2/3/
4
LCT
LCT
2000
1200
DU
Executive SEF
7.25" x 10.5"
Executive LEF
10.5" x 7.25"
8" x 13"
8.5" x 13"
8.25" x 13"
11" x 15"
10" x 14"
8" x 10"
8K
267 x 390mm
16K SEF
195 x 267mm
16K LEF
267 x 195mm
F SEF
Foolscap SEF
Folio SEF
Custom
Com10 Env.
4.125" x 9.5"
Monarch Env.
3.875" x 7.5"
C6 Env.
114 x 162mm
C5 Env.
162 x 229mm
DL Env.
110 x 220mm
Remarks:
A
Not supported
11
1. Appendix: Specifications
Europe/ Asia
BT: By-pass Tray, T1: Tray 1, T2/3/4: Tray 2/3/4, LCT 2000: Large Capacity Tray: 2000-sheet, LCT
1200: Large Capacity Tray: 1200-sheet, DU: Duplex Unit
Paper
(W x L)
BT
T1
T2/3/
4
LCT
LCT
2000
1200
DU
A3 W
12" x 18"
A3 SEF
297 x 420mm
A4 SEF
210 x 297mm
A4 LEF
297 x 210mm
A5 SEF
148 x 210mm
A5 LEF
210 x 148mm
A6 SEF
105 x 148mm
B4 SEF
257 x 364mm
B5 SEF
182 x 257mm
B5 LEF
257 x 182mm
B6 SEF
128 x 182mm
Ledger
11" x 17"
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
Government
Legal SEF
8.25" x 14"
5.5" x 8.5"
Executive SEF
7.25" x 10.5"
Executive LEF
10.5" x 7.25"
8" x 13"
8.5" x 13"
F SEF
Foolscap SEF
12
Size
BT
T1
T2/3/
4
LCT
LCT
2000
1200
8.25" x 13"
11" x 15"
10" x 14"
8" x 10"
8K
267 x 390mm
16K SEF
195 x 267mm
16K LEF
267 x 195mm
Paper
Folio SEF
Size
(W x L)
Custom
DU
Com10 Env.
4.125" x 9.5"
Monarch Env.
3.875" x 7.5"
C6 Env.
114 x 162mm
C5 Env.
162 x 229mm
DL Env.
110 x 220mm
Remarks:
A
Not supported
Paper Exit
1000-Sheet Booklet Finisher
MF: Main Frame, Prf: Proof, Clr: Clear, Shf: Shift, Stp: Staple, SS: Saddle Stitch,
2/3 P: 2/3 Holes Punch, 4 P: 4 Holes Punch, N4P: North Europe 4 Holes Punch
13
1. Appendix: Specifications
Paper
MF
Clr
Shf
Stp
SS
2/3 P
4P
N4P
A3 W
12" x 18"
A3 SEF
297 x 420 mm
30
30
A4 SEF
210 x 297 mm
50
50
A4 LEF
297 x 210 mm
50
50
A5 SEF
148 x 210 mm
A5 LEF
210 x 148 mm
A6 SEF
105 x 148 mm
B4 SEF
257 x 364 mm
30
30
B5 SEF
182 x 257 mm
50
50
B5 LEF
257 x 182 mm
50
50
B6 SEF
128 x 182 mm
Ledger
11" x 17"
30
30
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
50
50
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
50
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
30
30
8.25" x 14"
30
30
5.5" x 8.5"
Executive SEF
7.25" x 10.5"
50
Executive LEF
10.5" x 7.25"
50
F SEF
8" x 13"
30
Foolscap SEF
8.5" x 13"
30
Government
Legal SEF
14
Size (W x L)
Paper
Size (W x L)
MF
Clr
Shf
Stp
SS
2/3 P
4P
N4P
8.25" x 13"
30
11" x 15"
30
10" x 14"
30
8" x 10"
30
8K
267 x 390 mm
30
16K SEF
195 x 267 mm
50
16K LEF
267 x 195 mm
50
Folio SEF
Custom
Com10 Env.
4.125" x 9.5"
Monarch Env.
3.875" x 7.5"
C6 Env.
114 x 162 mm
C5 Env.
162 x 229 mm
DL Env.
110 x 220 mm
Remarks:
Y
Supported
30
Output up to 30 sheets
50
Output up to 50 sheets
Not supported
15
1. Appendix: Specifications
Paper
(W x L)
MF
1000-sheet finisher
500-sheet finisher
Prf
Clr
Shf
Stp
Clr
Shf
Stp
1-Bin
Shift
A3 W
12" x 18"
A3 SEF
297 x
420 mm
30
30
A4 SEF
210 x
297 mm
50
50
A4 LEF
297 x
210 mm
50
50
A5 SEF
148 x
210 mm
A5 LEF
210 x
148 mm
A6 SEF
105 x
148 mm
B4 SEF
257 x
364 mm
30
30
B5 SEF
182 x
257 mm
50
50
B5 LEF
257 x
182 mm
50
50
B6 SEF
128 x
182 mm
Ledger
11" x 17"
30
30
Letter SEF
8.5" x 11"
50
50
Letter LEF
11" x 8.5"
50
50
Legal SEF
8.5" x 14"
30
30
8.25" x
14"
30
Government
Legal SEF
16
Size
Paper
Size
(W x L)
MF
1000-sheet finisher
500-sheet finisher
Prf
Clr
Shf
Stp
Clr
Shf
Stp
1-Bin
Shift
5.5" x
8.5"
Executive SEF
7.25" x
10.5"
50
50
Executive LEF
10.5" x
7.25"
50
50
F SEF
8" x 13"
30
30
8.5" x 13"
30
30
8.25" x
13"
30
30
11" x 15"
30
30
10" x 14"
30
30
8" x 10"
30
30
8K
267 x
390 mm
30
30
16K SEF
195 x
267 mm
50
50
16K LEF
267 x
195 mm
50
50
Foolscap SEF
Folio SEF
Custom
Com10 Env.
4.125" x
9.5"
Monarch Env.
3.875" x
7.5"
C6 Env.
114 x
162 mm
C5 Env.
162 x
229 mm
17
1. Appendix: Specifications
Size
Paper
(W x L)
110 x
220 mm
DL Env.
1000-sheet finisher
MF
500-sheet finisher
Prf
Clr
Shf
Stp
Clr
Shf
Stp
1-Bin
Shift
Remarks:
Y
Supported
30
Output up to 30 sheets
50
Output up to 50 sheets
Not supported
18
Size
Platen
ARDF
Platen
ARDF
Inches
Inches
Metric
Metric
A3 (297 x 420) L
Y*3
B4 (257 x 364) L
Y*3
A4 (210 x 297) L
Y*1
Y*3
A4 (297 x 210) S
Y*3
Y*3
B5 (182 x 257) L
Y*3
B5 (257 x 182) S
Y*3
A5 (148 x 210) L
-*1
A5 (210 x 148) S
-*1
B6 (128 x 182) L
B6 (182 x 128) S
Y*2
Y*2
11" x 15"
Y*2
10" x 14"
Y*2
Y*2
Y*4
Y*4
8.25" x 13"
Y*4
Y*4
8" x 13"(F)
Y*4
Y*4
Y*3
Y*2
Y*3
Y*2
Y*3
Y*2
Y*3
Y*2
Y*2
-*1
-*1
8K (267 x 390)
Y*3
Y*2
Y*3
Y*2
Y*3
Y*2
Y*2
8" x 10"
*1: Use SP4-303 to detect original sizes as A5 lengthwise/HLT when the message Can-t detect original
size shows.
*2: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP6-016-1.
*3: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP4-305-1.
*4: The machine can detect the paper size depending on the setting of SP5-126-1.
19
1. Appendix: Specifications
Software Accessories
1
The printer drivers and utility software are provided as following two CD-ROMs
1: Printer Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM
2: Scanner/PostScript Drivers and Utilities CD-ROM.
An auto-run installer lets you to select the components you want to install.
Printer Drivers
Printer Language
MacOS8.6 to 9.x,
MacOSX10.1
or later
PCL5c
/ PCL6
Yes
No
PS3
Yes
Yes
RPCS
No
No
The PCL5c/6 and PS3 drivers are provided on the printer drivers CD-ROM
The PS3 drivers are all genuine Adobe PS drivers, except for Windows 2000/XP/2003/Vista/7.
Windows 2000 uses Microsoft PS. A PPD file for each operating system is provided with the driver.
The PPD installer for Macintosh supports Mac OS X 10.1 or later versions.
The LAN Fax driver lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover
Sheet Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)
Network TWAIN
Yes
No
LAN-FAX
Yes
No
Printer Language
20
or later
Software Accessories
The Network TWAIN and LAN Fax drivers are provided on the scanner drivers CD-ROM.
This software lets you fax documents directly form your PC. Address Book Editor and Cover Sheet
Editor are to be installed as well. (These require the optional fax unit.)
Utility Software
Software
Description
Font Manager
(2000/XP/Server 2003/7)
DeskTopBinder SmartDeviceMonitor
for Client (2000/XP/Server 2003/
Vista/7)
DeskTopBinder Lite
(2000/XP/Server 2003/7)
21
1. Appendix: Specifications
Optional Equipment
1
ARDF (D541)
Simplex
Paper Size/Weight:
Duplex
Size
Weight
Size
Weight
Table Capacity:
Separation:
Original Transport:
Roller transport
Fax
32 to 200 %
Color
32.6 to 200 %
48.9 to 200 %
Power Source:
Power Consumption:
50 W or less
Dimensions (W D H) :
Weight:
10 kg (22 lb.)
22
FRR
Capacity:
Paper Weight:
Optional Equipment
Paper Size:
Power Source:
Power Consumption:
Dimensions (W x D x H):
Weight:
26 kg (57.3 lb.)
A4 LEF/LT LEF
Paper Weight:
Tray Capacity:
Power Source:
DC 24 V, 5 V (from copier/printer)
Power Consumption:
55 W (Max.)/30 W (Ave.)
Weight:
26 kg (57.3 lb.)
Size (W x D x H):
Paper Weight:
Tray Capacity:
Power Source:
Power Consumption:
55 W (Max)/ 25 W (Ave.)
Weight:
14 kg (30.8 lb.)
23
1. Appendix: Specifications
Size (W x D x H):
A3, B4, 11" x 17" (SEF) or A4, B5, 8.5" x 11" (LEF)
4 holes (Europe):
A3, B4, 11" x 17" (SEF) or A4, B5, 8.5" x 11" (LEF)
4 holes (North Europe):
A3/11" x 17" to B6/5.5" x 8.5" (SEF)
Staple mode:
A3/11" x 17" to B5/8.5" x 11"
No punch mode:
52 to 256 g/m2 (14 to 68 lb.) (Shift tray)
52 to 105 g/m2 (14 to 28 lb.) (Proof tray)
Paper Weight:
Punch mode:
52 to 163 g/m2 (14 to 43 lb.)
Staple mode:
64 to 90 g/m2 (17 to 24 lb.)
Label/Thick paper/OHP cannot be stapled
[Proof tray]
100 sheets: A4, 8.5" x 11" or less
Tray Capacity:
24
Optional Equipment
Single size:
Staple capacity:
Staple position:
Staple replenishment:
Power consumption:
60 W
Dimensions (W x D x H):
Weight
48 kg (105.8 lb.)
50 Kg (110.3 lb.)
A3 to A6
11" x 17" to 5.5" x 8.5"
Paper Weight:
Paper Capacity:
Lower Tray
No staple mode:
Paper Size:
25
1. Appendix: Specifications
Paper Weight:
Stapler Capacity:
Paper Capacity:
Staple positions:
Size
2 to 9
10 to 30
31 to 50
A4/LT LEF
B5 LEF
100
100 to 20
100 to 20
A4/LT SEF
100
50 to 10
50 to 10
50
50 to 10
Staple Replenishment:
Power Source:
Power Consumption:
50 W
Weight:
25 kg (55.2 lbs)
Dimensions (W x D x H):
A3 to B6 (SEF)
Paper Weight:
Tray Capacity:
26
10 to 50
Optional Equipment
Staple capacity:
Staple position:
500-Sheet Finisher
Target Line Speed
Target CPM
35 cpm
12"x18", A3 SEF to A6 SEF, DLT to HLT SEF
Paper Thickness
Stapling
Stack Height for Stapling
Front/Oblique: 1, Front/Parallel: 1
Rear/Oblique: 1, Rear/Parallel: 1, 2 locations
Stacks
Size
27
1. Appendix: Specifications
Stacking
2 to 9 Sheets
55 to 46
10 to 50 Sheets
45 to 10
2 to 9 Sheets
55 to 27
10 to 50 Sheets
25 to 8
2 to 9 Sheets
55 to 27
10 to 30 Sheets
25 to 8
Non-Stapling Mode
Vertical: 15 mm or less
Horizontal: 15 mm or less
Jogging Precision
2 to 30 Sheets 2 mm
31 to 50 Sheets 3 mm
Dimensions (W x D x H)
Weight
12 kg (26.4 lb)
Non-standard sizes
Width: 90 to 305 mm
Length: 148 to 600 mm
28
Paper Weight:
Paper Capacity:
Power Source:
Dimensions (W x D x H):
Weight
5 kg (11 lb.)
Optional Equipment
Standard sizes
A6 SEF to A3, HLT to DLT
Paper Size:
Non-standard sizes
Width: 90 to 305 mm
Length: 148 to 600 mm
Paper Weight:
Power Consumption:
Dimension (W x D x H):
Weight:
Standard Size:
A3 /DLT to A5/ HLT SEF
Paper Weight:
Tray Capacity:
Power Source:
Power Consumption:
Less than 1 W
Weight:
1.7 kg
Size (W x D x H):
29
1. Appendix: Specifications
30
Mainframe
Item
150K
200K
300K
450K
EM
Remarks
Scanner
Reflector
Optics cloth
1st/2nd/3rd mirrors
Optics cloth
Dry cloth
Exposure Glass
APS Sensor
Dry cloth
PCDU
Dev. UnitK
R: 600K
Dev. Unit C, M, Y
Drum Unit-K,
Drum Unit-C, M, Y
R
R
R
31
Item
150K
200K
Developer-K
300K
EM
Remarks
Developer-C, M, Y
450K
Transfer
Image Transfer Beltcleaning Unit
R: 600K
R
R:
150K
Fusing
Heating Roller
-Bearing
Pressure Roller
-Bearing
R
R/L
S552R
R
R/L
Thermopile
S552R
Paper Path
32
Registration Roller
Damp cloth
Registration Sensor
Dry cloth
Damp cloth
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Pick-up Belt
Dry cloth
Maintenance Tables
Item
150K
200K
300K
450K
EM
Remarks
Feed Roller
Dry cloth
Separation Roller
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Duplex Unit
Inverter Roller
Damp cloth
Transport Roller
Damp cloth
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Miscellaneous
Ozone Filter
Exhaust Filter
Dust Glass
ID Sensor
Blower Brush
ARDF (D541)
Item
120K
EM
Remarks
Sensors
Blower brush
White Plate
Drive Gear
Grease G501
Transport Roller
33
Item
120K
EM
Remarks
Exit Roller
Inverter Roller
Idle Rollers
EM
Remarks
Feed Roller
Dry cloth
Separation Roller
Dry cloth
Pick-up Belt
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Relay Sensor
Dry cloth
Relay Roller
Damp cloth
Damp cloth
34
EM
Remarks
Feed Roller
Dry cloth
Separation Roller
Dry cloth
Pick-up Roller
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Relay Sensor
Dry cloth
Relay Roller
Damp cloth
Damp cloth
Maintenance Tables
EM
Remarks
Feed Roller
Dry cloth
Separation Roller
Dry cloth
Pick-up Belt
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Relay Sensor
Dry cloth
Relay Roller
Damp cloth
Damp cloth
EM
Remarks
Rollers
Damp cloth
Discharge Brush
Dry cloth
Sensors
Blower brush
EM
C
Remarks
Discard chads.
EM
Remarks
Rollers
Damp cloth
Discharge Brush
Dry cloth
Sensors
Blower brush
35
EM
Remarks
Rollers
Damp cloth
Tray
Damp cloth
Sensor
Blower brush
Bearing
S552R
EM
C
Remarks
Damp cloth
EM
C
Remarks
Damp cloth
36
EM
Remarks
Feed Roller
Dry cloth
Separation Roller
Dry cloth
Pick-up Roller
Dry cloth
Dry cloth
Relay Sensor
Dry cloth
Relay Roller
Damp cloth
Damp cloth
Maintenance Tables
EM
Remarks
Rollers
Damp cloth
Sensors
Blower brush
Mainframe
Item
120K
240K
Dev. UnitC, M, Y
480K
600K
Remarks
Developer- C, M, Y
ITB Unit
ARDF
Item
80K
120K
240K
Remarks
Pick-up Roller
Number of originals
Feed Belt
Number of originals
Separation Roller
Number of originals
37
38
(Tray Location, Paper Type, Color Mode), Paper Type -> Plain, Thick 1or Thick 2
Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the registration motor operation timing
for each mode.
002 Tray: Plain
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
39
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
40
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the laser main scan start position for each
mode.
001 By-pass Table
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
006 Duplex
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP1-xxx
1007
*ENG
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -1 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / -2 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[9 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
41
LG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
001 Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection function of the by-pass tray.
This SP determines what paper size the machine detects if the detected size is less than 8.5".
0: OFF (Letter/SEF), 1: ON (Legal/SEF)
1101
001
002
003
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
004 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) when the fusing unit is
determined as cold state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:End
*ENG
005 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) when the fusing unit is
determined as cold state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
006 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller when the fusing unit is determined
as cold state.
Time:Cold
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
007 Specifies the threshold time for the fusiing reload when the fusing unit is determined as cold
state.
Temp.:Delta:Warm:Center
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
008 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) when the fusing unit is
determined as warm state.
42
System SP1-xxx
Temp.:Delta:Warm:End
*ENG
009 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) when the fusing unit is
determined as warm state.
Temp.:Delta:Warm:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
010 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller when the fusing unit is determined
as warm state.
Time:Warm
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
011 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload when the fusing unit is determined as warm
state.
Temp.:Delta:Hot:Center
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
012 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) when the fusing unit is
determined as hot state.
Temp.:Delta:Hot:End
*ENG
013 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) when the fusing unit is
determined as hot state.
Temp.:Delta:Hot:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 65 / 1 deg/step]
014 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller when the fusing unit is determined
as hot state.
Time:Hot
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
015 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload when the fusing unit is determined as hot
state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW:Center
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
016 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as cold state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW:End
*ENG
017 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as cold state.
Temp.Delta:Cold:BW:Press
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 70 / 1 deg/step]
018 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller in the black and white mode when
the fusing unit is determined as cold state.
43
Time:Cold:BW
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
019 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload in black and white mode when the fusing
unit is determined as cold state.
020
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:Cent
er
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (center) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
Temp.:Delta:Cold:BW2:End
*ENG
021 Specifies the temperature correction of the heating roller (end) in the black and white mode
when the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
Temp.Delta:Cold:BW2:Press
*ENG
022 Specifies the temperature correction of the pressure roller in the black and white mode when
the fusing unit is determined as warm state.
Time:Cold:BW2
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
023 Specifies the threshold time for the fusing reload in black and white mode when the fusing
unit is determined as warm state.
1102
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
001 Specifies the subtractive temperature of the heating roller (center) for the paper feed
permission.
002
Temp.:Lower Delta:End
*ENG
Specifies the subtractive temperature of the heating roller (end) for the paper feed permission.
Temp.:Upper Delta:Center
*ENG
003 Specifies the additional temperature of the heating roller (center) for the paper feed
permission.
004
44
Temp.:Upper Delta:End
*ENG
Specifies the additional temperature of the heating roller (end) for the paper feed permission.
System SP1-xxx
005
006
007
Temp.:Lower Delta:Press
*ENG
Specifies the subtractive temperature of the pressure roller for the paper feed permission.
Rotation Time
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the threshold time of the pre-rotation for the paper feed permission.
Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.1
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
013
Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.1
Temp.:Lower
Delta:Center:Sp.2
1105
Temp.:Upper
Delta:Center:Sp.2
001
Plain1:FC:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
45
002
003
004
3
005
006
007
008
46
Plain1:FC:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing..
Plain1:BW:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain1:BW:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:FC:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in full color printing.
Plain2:FC:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in full coloe printing.
Plain2:BW:Center
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
Plain2:BW:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller target temperature for the ready condition in BW printing.
009 Thin:FC:Center
*ENG
010 Thin:FC:Press
*ENG
011 Thin:BW:Center
*ENG
012 Thin:BW:Press
*ENG
013 M-thick:FC:Center
*ENG
014 M-thick:FC:Press
*ENG
015 M-thick:BW:Center
*ENG
016 M-thick:BW:Press
*ENG
017 Thick1:FC:Center
*ENG
018 Thick1:FC:Press
*ENG
019 Thick1:BW:Center
*ENG
020 Thick1:BW:Press
*ENG
System SP1-xxx
021 Thick2:FC:Center
*ENG
022 Thick2:FC:Press
*ENG
023 Thick2:BW:Center
*ENG
024 Thick2:BW:Press
*ENG
025 Thick3:FC:Center
*ENG
026 Thick3:FC:Press
*ENG
027 Thick3:BW:Center
*ENG
028 Thick3:BW:Press
*ENG
029 Special1:FC:Center
*ENG
030 Special1:FC:Press
*ENG
031 Special1:BW:Center
*ENG
032 Special1:BW:Press
*ENG
033 Special2:FC:Center
*ENG
034 Special2:FC:Press
*ENG
035 Special2:BW:Center
*ENG
036 Special2:BW:Press
*ENG
037 Special3:FC:Center
*ENG
038 Special3:FC:Press
*ENG
039 Special3:BW:Center
*ENG
040 Special3:BW:Press
*ENG
041 Envelop:Center
*ENG
042 Envelop:Press
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
103
Plain1:BW:Center:Low
Speed
47
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Plain2:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
*ENG
M-thick:FC:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Thick1:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
*ENG
107
109
111
115
48
M-thick:BW:Center:Low
Speed
117
Special1:FC:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
118
Special1:FC:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
119
Special1:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
120
Special1:BW:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
121
Special2:FC:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
122
Special2:FC:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
System SP1-xxx
123
Special2:BW:Center:Low
Speed
*ENG
124
Special2:BW:Press:Low
Speed
*ENG
125 Plain1:Glossy:Center
*ENG
126 Plain1:Glossy:Press
*ENG
127 Plain2:Glossy:Center
*ENG
128 Plain2:Glossy:Press
*ENG
129 M-thick:Glossy:Center
*ENG
130 M-thick:Glossy:Press
*ENG
131 OHP:Center
*ENG
132 OHP:Press
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
139 Thick4:FC:Center
*ENG
140 Thick4:FC:Press
*ENG
141 Thick4:BW:Center
*ENG
142 Thick4:BW:Press
*ENG
001 Center
002 End
1106
49
003 Pressure
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 15 / 1 sec/step]
1107
001 Specifies the time that the fusing heater turns off after the fusing unit temperature has reached
its target temperature.
002
004
006
007
008
1108
001
002
1111
Stanby/Preheat1: Press
*ENG
[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the ready or energy save 1 mode.
Preheat2:Press
*ENG
[0 to 125 / 90 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the energy save 2 mode.
Low Power:Press
*ENG
[0 to 125 / 60 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the low power mode.
Print Ready:Center
*ENG
Specifies the temperature of the heating roller for the print ready condition.
Print Ready:Press
*ENG
Specifies the temperature of the pressure roller for the print ready condition.
[After Reload/Job Target Temp.]
Center
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 17 / 1 deg/step]
001 Specifies the threshold temperature for low temperature. If the fusing temperature is 17C
or less, the machine executes the fusing mode for low temperature.
50
System SP1-xxx
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 deg/step]
002 Sepcifies the threshold temperature for high temperature. If the fusing temperature is 30C
or more, the machine executes the fusing mode for high temperature.
Low Temp. Correction
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
003 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in low temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.
High Temp. Correction
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
004 Specifies the additional temperature for the target temperature. If the fusing temperature is
in high temperature condition, this temperature is added to the taraget temperature.
005 Job Low Temp. Correction
*ENG
*ENG
1112
*ENG
*ENG
001 Specifies the threshold time for entering the repeat temperature correction mode after the first
sheet of paper has reached to the registration roller.
Control Time 2
*ENG
002 Specifies the threshold time for entering the repeat temperature correction mode after the
control time 1 (specified with SP1112-001) has elapsed.
Temp.:Plain:Center:1
*ENG
003 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:Plain:Press:1
*ENG
004 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.
51
Temp.:Plain:Center:2
*ENG
005 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is more than control time 2.
Temp.:Plain:Press:2
*ENG
006 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for plain paper when the operation
time of the machine is more than control time 2.
Temp.:M-thick:Center:1
*ENG
007 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:M-thick:Press:1
*ENG
008 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:M-thick:Center:2
*ENG
009 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is more than control time 2.
Temp.:M-thick:Press:2
*ENG
010 Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for middle thick paper when the
operation time of the machine is more than control time 2.
Temp.:Others:Center:1
*ENG
011 Specifies the correction temperature of the heating roller for paper type other than plain and
middle thick paper when the operation time of the machine is in the interval between control
time 1 and control time 2.
Temp.:Others:Press:1
*ENG
Specifies the correction temperature of the pressure roller for other than palin and middle
012 thick paper when the operation time of the machine is in the interval between control time 1
and control time 2.
[Image Processing Temp. Correct]
Temp.:Plain:Center: Level1
*ENG
013 Specifies the correction temperature for the level 1 of the job image control in black and
white printing mode.
52
System SP1-xxx
Temp.:Plain:Center: Level2
*ENG
014 Specifies the correction temperature for the level 2 of the job image control in black and
white printing mode.
1113
[Curl Correction]
Execute Pattern
001
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On (No Decurl), 2: On
002
003
Humidity:Threshold:M-humid
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 1 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:M*ENG
004 humid
[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in middle humidity.
Permit
005 humid
Temp.:Delta:Press:H-
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the curl control in high humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:M*ENG
006 humid:No Decurl
[0 to 200 / 50 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in middle humidity.
Permit Temp.:Delta:Press:H*ENG
007 humid:No Decurl
[0 to 200 / 40 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature for the no curl control in high humidity.
53
CPM:M-humid
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]
008 Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
009
CPM:H-humid
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
Specifies the CPM ratio of the decurl control against to the normal operation in high humidity.
CPM:M-humid:No Decurl
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 80 / 1 %/step]
010 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in middle
humidity.
CPM:H-humid:No Decurl
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 65 / 1 %/step]
011 Specifies the CPM ratio against of the no decurl control to the normal operation in high
humidity.
1114
001
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 80 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature of the pressure roller for the heat storage status.
Temp.:Threshold:Atmospher
002 e
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 60 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the threshold temperature inside the machine for the heat storage feedback control.
1115
001
1116
001
*ENG
Specifies the different temperature between end and center of the heating roller.
[Heat Storage FB Control]
Execution mode
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: OFF, 1: ON (BW), 2: ON (BW/FC)
54
Time Out
*ENG
[0 to 500 / 5 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the no-entry time for the heat strorage FB control after the LD units have fired.
System SP1-xxx
Delay:Standard Speed:BW:
*ENG
1
Delay:Standard Speed:BW:
*ENG
2
[0 to 200 / 80 / 1 deg/step]
022
032
041
042
043
*ENG
Specifies the standard temperature for the pressure roller during the heat storage FB control.
Temp. Correction Lower Limit *ENG
[-30 to 0 / -2 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the lower llimit temperature for the heat storage FB control.
Temp. Correction Upper Limit *ENG
[0 to 30 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
Specifies the upper llimit temperature for the heat storage FB control.
Paper Thickness
051 Coefficient:Plain1
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 /step]
Specifies the additional temperatreu to the heat strage FB control for plain paper 1.
Paper Thickness
052 Coefficient:Plain2
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 /step]
Specifies the additional temperatreu to the heat strage FB control for plain paper 2.
1121
[Switch:Rotation Start/Stop]
Time:After Reload
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 sec/step]
001 Specifies the ON time of the pressure roler lamp after the fusing temperature has reached
the reload temperature.
Time:After Recovery
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 15 / 1 sec/step]
002 Specifies the ON time of the pressure roler lamp after the fusing temperature has reached
the target temperature.
003
Time:After Job
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the ON time of the pressure roler lamp after the paper feeding has finished.
55
*ENG
004 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller center area after the fusing temperature
has reached the reload temperature.
End Uniform Start Temp.:B4
*ENG
005 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller end arear after the B4 paper feeding
has finished.
*ENG
006 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller end arear after the A4 paper feeding
has finished.
End Uniform Start Temp.:A5
*ENG
007 Specifies the target temperature of the pressure roller end arear after the A5 paper feeding
has finished.
008
009
1122
001
002
1124
*ENG
Specifies the temperature of the heating roller for the overshoot prevention.
Overshoot Prevent Time
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
Specifies the interval of the fusing unit rotation for the overshoot prevention.
[Standby Rotation Setting] DFU
Rotation Interval
*ENG
[0 to 240 / 60 / 1 min/step]
Specifies the rotation interval of the fusing unit in the stand-by mode.
Rotation Time
*ENG
Specifies the rotation time of the fusing unit in the stand-by mode.
[CPM Down Setting]
Specifies the settings for the CPM down mode.
Low:Down Temp.
*ENG
001 Specifies the CPM down threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature decreases -20C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM down mode.
56
System SP1-xxx
Low:Up Temp.
*ENG
002 Specifies the CPM up threshold temperature for the low temperature condition. If the fusing
temperature increases -15C (adjustable) below the target temperature, the machine enters
the CPM up mode.
003
004
005
006
007
008
*ENG
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
Low :2nd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 2nd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
Low :3rd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the low temperature condition.
High :1st CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
High:2nd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 3rd CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
High:3rd CPM
*ENG
Specifies the 1st CPM down ration against the normal CPM in the high temperature condition.
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A3 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
010 Temp.:A3
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A3 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
011 Temp.:A3
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A3 paper size.
High:1st CPM Down
012 Temp.:A4
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A4 paper size.
57
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A4 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
014 Temp.:A4
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A4 paper size.
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of B5 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
016 Temp.:B5:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of B5 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
017 Temp.:B5:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of B5 paper size.
High:1st CPM Down
018 Temp.:A5:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A5 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
019 Temp.:A5:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A5 paper size.
High:3rd CPM Down
020 Temp.:A5:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A5 paper size.
High:1st CPM Down
021 Temp.:A6:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 1st CPM down of A6 paper size.
High:2nd CPM Down
022 Temp.:A6:Press
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 2nd CPM down of A6 paper size.
58
System SP1-xxx
*ENG
Specifies the pressure roller temperature for 3rd CPM down of A6 paper size.
024
1131
Judging Interval
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 5 / 1 sec/step]
001
*ENG
0: Productivity priority
1: Fusing quality priority 1
2: Fusing quality priority 2
1141
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Fixed Duty, 1: Power Control
001 SC Number
*ENG
002 SC Cause
*ENG
[0 to 9 / - / 1/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the center of
the heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
Displays the temperature at the end of the
heating roller when an SC was issued.
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
59
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1142
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
[0 to 260 / - / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
001 Enables or disables the fusing consecutive jam (three times) SC detection.
0: No detection, 1: Detection
1151
[Pressure Setting]
Pressure Change ON/OFF
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
001 Enables or disables the pressure switching control for the fusing unit.
0: OFF , 1: ON
002
60
Pressure Position1
*ENG
Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 1.
System SP1-xxx
003
004
Pressure Position2
*ENG
Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 2.
Pressure Position3
*ENG
Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the pressure position 3.
Depressure Position
*ENG
005 Specifies the rotation time of the pressure roller contact motor for the depression position (no
pressure).
Shift Time
*ENG
[0 to 3600 / 5 / 1 sec/step]
010 Specifies the timing for depressing the fusing unit. If the machine does not get any jobs for
specified time by this SP after copying or printing, the machine depresses the fusing unit.
101 Pressure:Plain1/2
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in normal speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)
102 Pressure:Thin
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
103 Pressure:M-thick
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
104 Pressure:Thick1
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
105 Pressure:Thick2
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
106 Pressure:Thick3
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
107 Pressure:Special1
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
108 Pressure:Special2
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
109 Pressure:Special3
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
110 Pressure:Envelope
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
61
Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for each paper type in low speed.
0: Depression position (no pressure)
1: Position 1 (less pressure)
2: Position 2
3: Position 3 (strongest pressure)
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
156 Pressure:Plain1/2:Glossy
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
157 Pressure:M-thick:Glossy
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
158 Pressure:OHP
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
Pressure:Thick4
Sets the default pressure position of the fusing unit for thick 4 paper.
161
201
1152
ENG
[0 to 9,000,000 / - / 1 /step]
Displays the detection time for the edge of the pressure roller actuator.
[Fusing Nip Band Check]
001 Execute
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1]
Executes the nip band measurement between heating roller and pressure roller.
If the nip band width is not 8 mm, and fusing is not good, replace the pressure roller or install
a new fusing unit.
62
System SP1-xxx
002
003
004
1153
Pre-Idling Time
*ENG
* ENG
[5 to 30 / 20 / 1 sec/step]
* ENG
[1 to 3 / 3 / 1 ]
[Fuser Cleaning]
*ENG
002 Adjusts the execution interval for the fusing cleaning mode.
1K= 100 sheets
003
004
1801
Control Temp.
*ENG
Specifies the heating roller temperature for the fusing cleaning mode.
Page Count
*ENG
[1 to 300000 / - / 1 page/step]
001 Registration:Plain:Low
*ENG
002 Registration:Plain:High
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
007 Registration:Thick1:Mid
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
63
64
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0.5 / 0.1%/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
034 Feed:Plain:Low
*ENG
035 Feed:Plain:High
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
System SP1-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
060 KOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
061 KOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
062 KOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
063 MOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]
064 MOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]
065 MOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
066 COpcDevMot:High
*ENG
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]
067 COpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]
068 COpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
069 YOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 step/step]
070 YOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
[9 to 9 / 0 / 1 step/step]
071 YOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
075 TransferMot:High
*ENG
076 TransferMot:Mid
*ENG
077 TransferMot:Low
*ENG
078 TonerMot
*ENG
[4 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 %/step]
[30 to 30 / 10 / 5 %/step]
65
100
Drum Adjust
*ENG
*ENG
101 MOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
102 COpcDevMot:High
*ENG
103 YOpcDevMot:High
*ENG
104 MOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
105 COpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
106 YOpcDevMot:Mid
*ENG
107 MOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
108 COpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
109 YOpcDevMot:Low
*ENG
110 MOpcDevMot:1200
*ENG
111 COpcDevMot:1200
*ENG
[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]
[14 to 14 / 0 / 1 step/step]
[ 7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]
112 YOpcDevMot:1200
*ENG
120 Long:Registration:Plain:High
*ENG
121 Long:Registration:Plain:Low
*ENG
*ENG
123
66
[7 to 7 / 0 / 1 step/step]
Long:Registration:Middle
Thick:Middle
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[2 to 2 / -1 / 0.1 %/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP1-xxx
129 Long:Fusing:Plain:High
*ENG
130 Long:Fusing:Plain:Low
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1902
[Amplitude Control]
001 Execute
002 Result
*ENG
0: Successfully done
2: Sampling failure
3: Insufficient detection number
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
*ENG
1907
*ENG
[35 to 85 / 60 / 5 %/step]
67
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 40 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
*ENG
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1908
68
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1950
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
System SP1-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1951
*ENG
[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
1952
001 1953
001
[0 to 900 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 min./step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On
69
*ENG
Specifies the judgement time for entering the extra fan rotation mode.
003
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
Specifies the threshold rotation of the black development unit for entering the extra fan
rotation mode.
*ENG
*ENG
005
1954
70
002
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
009
*ENG
010
*ENG
011
*ENG
012
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
System SP2-xxx
SP2-XXX (Drum)
[Charge DC Voltage] Charge Roller DC Voltage Adjustment
2005
Adjusts the DC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.
Charge bias (DC component) is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore,
adjusting these settings does not effect while process control mode (SP3-041-1 Default: ON)
is activated. When deactivating process control mode with SP3-041-1, the values in these
SP modes are used for printing.
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
014 PCU:Thick 1
*ENG
71
*ENG
016 HVP:Plain
*ENG
017 HVP:Thick 1
*ENG
*ENG
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&FINE: Low speed
Adjusts the AC component of the charge roller bias in the various print modes.
Charge bias (AC component) is adjusted by environment correction (SP2-007-xxx to
SP2-011-xxx). These SPs are activated only when SP2-012-1 is set to "1: manual control".
72
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for LL environment (Low temperature
and Low humidity). DFU
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for ML environment (Meddle
temperature and Low humidity). DFU
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MM environment (Middle
temperature and Middle humidity). DFU
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
73
(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for MH environment (Middle
temperature and High humidity). DFU
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
(Color)
Displays/sets the AC current target of the charge roller for HH environment (High
temperature and High humidity). DFU
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2012
001 AC Voltage
*ENG
0: Process control
1: Manual control (AC voltages are decided
with SP2006.)
2013
74
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
003
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
008
*ENG
009
*ENG
75
010
Previous Environmental:
Display
*ENG
012
*ENG
013
*ENG
2014
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 500 / 10 / 5 page/step]
004 Temperature
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 99 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 12 / 1 g/m3/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 5 / 1 deg/step]
008 RH Threshold M
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 25 / 1 %RH/step]
009 AH Threshold M
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
*ENG
[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 deg/step]
011 RH Threshold S
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 5 / 1 %RH/step]
012 AH Threshold S
*ENG
[0 to 20 / 1 / 0.1 g/m3/step]
*ENG
2015
76
*ENG
[Charge AC Control:Result]
System SP2-xxx
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Success
1: Out of tolerance range
2: Out of adjustable range
3: Adjustment incompleted
These values are the parameters for the automatic line position adjustment and are adjusted
at the factory. However, you must input a value for SP2101-001 after replacing the laser
optics housing unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement and
Adjustment" section. The value should be provided with the new laser optics housing unit.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2102
77
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2103
78
*ENG
*ENG
003 Left
*ENG
004 Right
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4 / 0 / 0.1 mm/step]
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4 / 1 / 0.1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2105
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2106
79
001 Warming-Up
*ENG
*ENG
2107
[Image Parameter]
DFU
*ENG
*ENG
2109
[0 to 60 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
[Test Pattern]
Generates the test pattern using "COPY Window" tab in the LCD.
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]
0 None
3: Horizontal (1dot)
4: Horizontal (2dot)
[1 to 4 / 1 / 1/step]
1: All colors, 2: Magenta, 3: Yellow, 4: Cyan
80
006 Density: Bk
007 Density: Ma
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
008 Density: Cy
0: Lightest density
009 Density: Ye
System SP2-xxx
2111
001 Mode a
002 Mode b
003 Mode c
2112
001 Execute
[Skew Adjustment]
2117
001 Pulse: M
*ENG
002 Pulse: C
*ENG
003 Pulse: Y
*ENG
2118
[Skew Adjustment]
001 Execute: M
*ENG
002 Execute: C
*ENG
003 Execute: Y
*ENG
81
2119
001 M
*ENG
002 C
*ENG
003 Y
*ENG
2120
[50 to 50 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
001 On/Off
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Off, 1: On
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
005 Front
*ENG
006 Center
*ENG
007 Rear
*ENG
[0 to 1024 / 0 / 1/step]
82
System SP2-xxx
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
005 Front
*ENG
006 Center
*ENG
007 Rear
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
001 Maximum: Bk
*ENG
002 Maximum: M
*ENG
003 Maximum: C
*ENG
004 Maximum: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
83
001 Minimum: Bk
*ENG
002 Minimum: M
*ENG
003 Minimum: C
*ENG
004 Minimum: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
001 Maximum 2: Bk
*ENG
002 Maximum 2: M
*ENG
003 Maximum 2: C
*ENG
004 Maximum 2: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
84
System SP2-xxx
001 Minimum 2: Bk
*ENG
002 Minimum 2: M
*ENG
003 Minimum 2: C
*ENG
004 Minimum 2: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5.5 / 0 / 0.01V/step]
2150
Adjusts the magnification for each area. The main scan (297 mm) is divided into 8 areas.
Area 1 is at the front side of the machine (left side of the image) and area 8 is at the rear
side of the machine (right side of the image).
Decreasing a value makes the image shift to the left side on the print.
Increasing a value makes the image shift to the right side on the print.
1 pulse = 1/16 dot
027 Area 0: Bk
*ENG
028 Area 1: Bk
*ENG
029 Area 2: Bk
*ENG
030 Area 3: Bk
*ENG
031 Area 4: Bk
*ENG
032 Area 5: Bk
*ENG
033 Area 6: Bk
*ENG
034 Area 7: Bk
*ENG
035 Area 8: Bk
*ENG
036 Area 9: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
85
86
079 Area 0: Ma
*ENG
Not used
080 Area 1: Ma
*ENG
081 Area 2: Ma
*ENG
082 Area 3: Ma
*ENG
083 Area 4: Ma
*ENG
084 Area 5: Ma
*ENG
085 Area 6: Ma
*ENG
086 Area 7: Ma
*ENG
087 Area 8: Ma
*ENG
088 Area 9: Ma
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
131 Area 0: Cy
*ENG
132 Area 1: Cy
*ENG
133 Area 2: Cy
*ENG
134 Area 3: Cy
*ENG
135 Area 4: Cy
*ENG
136 Area 5: Cy
*ENG
137 Area 6: Cy
*ENG
138 Area 7: Cy
*ENG
139 Area 8: Cy
*ENG
Not used
Not used
System SP2-xxx
140 Area 9: Cy
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
183 Area 0: Ye
*ENG
184 Area 1: Ye
*ENG
185 Area 2: Ye
*ENG
186 Area 3: Ye
*ENG
187 Area 4: Ye
*ENG
188 Area 5: Ye
*ENG
189 Area 6: Ye
*ENG
190 Area 7: Ye
*ENG
191 Area 8: Ye
*ENG
192 Area 9: Ye
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
Not used
Not used
The main scan is divided into 16 areas. However, the image areas are limited from area 1
to area 14.
For BK and Magenta, area 1 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image) and
area 14 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image).
For Cyan and Yellow, area 1 is at the front side of the machine (right side of the image) and
area 14 is at the rear side of the machine (left side of the image).
87
88
001 Area 0: Bk
*ENG
002 Area 1: Bk
*ENG
003 Area 2: Bk
*ENG
004 Area 3: Bk
*ENG
005 Area 4: Bk
*ENG
006 Area 5: Bk
*ENG
007 Area 6: Bk
*ENG
008 Area 7: Bk
*ENG
009 Area 8: Bk
*ENG
010 Area 9: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
033 Area 0: M
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
034 Area 1: M
*ENG
035 Area 2: M
*ENG
036 Area 3: M
*ENG
037 Area 4: M
*ENG
038 Area 5: M
*ENG
039 Area 6: M
*ENG
040 Area 7: M
*ENG
041 Area 8: M
*ENG
042 Area 9: M
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
065 Area 0: C
*ENG
3
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
89
90
066 Area 1: C
*ENG
067 Area 2: C
*ENG
068 Area 3: C
*ENG
069 Area 4: C
*ENG
070 Area 5: C
*ENG
071 Area 6: C
*ENG
072 Area 7: C
*ENG
073 Area 8: C
*ENG
074 Area 9: C
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
097 Area 0: Y
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
098 Area 1: Y
*ENG
099 Area 2: Y
*ENG
100 Area 3: Y
*ENG
101 Area 4: Y
*ENG
102 Area 5: Y
*ENG
103 Area 6: Y
*ENG
104 Area 7: Y
*ENG
105 Area 8: Y
*ENG
106 Area 9: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2160
3
[50 to 150 / 100 / 1 %/step]
001 600dpi:Bk
*ENG
002 600dpi:Ma
*ENG
003 600dpi:Cy
*ENG
004 600dpi:Ye
*ENG
005 1200dpi:Bk
*ENG
006 1200dpi:Ma
*ENG
007 1200dpi:Cy
*ENG
008 1200dpi:Ye
*ENG
[10 to 15 / 13 / 1 /step]
[10 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
91
2180
004
2181
Area Magnification
Correction
DFU
92
*ENG
*ENG
003 Skew: M
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
021 Skew: C
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
93
039 Skew: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 line/step]
94
System SP2-xxx
001 M Magnification
*ENG
002 C Magnification
*ENG
003 Y Magnification
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[-15 to 15 / 0 / 1 pulse/step]
*ENG
95
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 1 / 0 / 0.001 /line]
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
2183
96
System SP2-xxx
2184
001 Execute: Bk
002 Execute: M
003 Execute: C
004 Execute: Y
2185
Displays/adjusts the target value for the main scan magnification correction of the line
position adjustment.
After replacing the laser optics housing unit, input the standard value for Bk provided with
the new unit. For details, see "Laser Optics Housing Unit" in the "Replacement Adjustment"
section. It is not necessary to input the values for the other colors; these are automatically
adjusted after doing the line position adjustment.
97
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
2186
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
001
Selection
*ENG
Enables or disables the main scan length detection for the laser.
002
2190
*ENG
[0 to 999 / 1 / 1 sec/step]
Adjusts the interval of the main scan length detection for the laser.
[Line Position Adj.] DFU
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2191
98
Paper Interval
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
0: Disable correction,
1: Enable correction
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
99
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1/step]
2192
001 ch 0: 1st
*ENG
002 ch 0: 2nd
*ENG
003 ch 0: 3rd
*ENG
004 ch 0: 4th
*ENG
005 ch 1: 1st
*ENG
006 ch 1: 2nd
*ENG
007 ch 1: 3rd
*ENG
008 ch 1: 4th
*ENG
009 ch 2: 1st
*ENG
010 ch 2: 2nd
*ENG
011 ch 2: 3rd
*ENG
012 ch 2: 4th
*ENG
2193
001
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
100
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
002 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode after
job end.
003
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode after job end.
Page: Interrupt: BW+FC
*ENG
004 Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing mode during
job.
005
Page: Interrupt: FC
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for color printing mode during jobs.
Page: Stand-By: BW
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
006 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in BW printing mode reaches
the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009 is
satisfied.
Page: Stand-By: FC
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of the line position adjustment for BW printing mode in stand-by mode.
007 The line position adjustment is done when the number of outputs in color printing mode
reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP2-193-008 or SP2-193-009
is satisfied.
Temp.
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1deg/step]
008 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment
once). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions. Section Descriptions" section.
Time
*ENG
009 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode b: adjustment once). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Magnification
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01%/step]
010 Adjusts the magnification threshold for line position adjustment. If the length of the main scan
is changed by this amount since the previous MUSIC, then MSUIC is done again.
101
Temp. 2
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1deg/step]
011 Adjust the temperature change threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment
twice). The timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several
conditions.
Time 2
*ENG
012 Adjust the time threshold for the line position adjustment (Mode a: adjustment twice). The
timing for line position adjustment depends on the combinations of several conditions.
Page: Power ON:BW+FC
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold for the condition of the line position adjustment for BW and color printing
013 mode. The condition of the line position adjustment is determined for large condition
difference and small condition difference when the number of outputs in color printing mode
reaches the value specified with this SP and the condition of SP3-510-009 or SP3-510-010
is satisfied. However, it is basically not necessary to adjust this SP.
2194
001
002
003
004
005
006
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 year/step]
*ENG
[1 to 12 / 1 / 1 month/step]
*ENG
[1 to 31 / 1 / 1 day/step]
*ENG
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1 hour/step]
*ENG
[0 to 59 / 0 / 1 minute/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
102
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Completed successfully, 1: Failed
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]
*ENG
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 times/step]
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 /step]
*ENG
0: Not done
1: Completed successfully
2: Cannot detect patterns
3: Fewer lines on the pattern than the target
*ENG
4: Not used
2197
*ENG
[10 to 40 / 20 / 10ms/step]
*ENG
2198
2199
2220
*ENG
*ENG
103
Adjusts the fixed LD power for each line speed and color.
These SPs are activated only when SP3-041-002 is set to "0".
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Development bias is automatically adjusted during process control; therefore, adjusting these
settings has no effect while Process Control (SP3-041-001 Default: ON) is activated.
After deactivating Process Control with SP3-041-001, the values in these SP modes are used
for printing.
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
104
System SP2-xxx
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2241
[Temperature/Humidity: Display]
Displays the environment temperature and humidity.
001 Temperature
2302
001
105
*ENG
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 1
*ENG
004
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 2
*ENG
005
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 3
*ENG
006
Absolute Humidity:
Threshold 4
*ENG
2308
*ENG
001 Threshold 1
*ENG
002 Threshold 2
*ENG
003 Threshold 3
*ENG
106
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
2311
*ENG
*ENG
2326
001
002
*ENG
Adjusts the positive voltage of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Negative
*ENG
Adjusts the negative current of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer roller.
Positive
*ENG
003 Adjusts the negative current limit of the paper transfer roller for cleaning the paper transfer
roller.
004 Negative
2351
001
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for plain paper.
107
002
003
2357
001
002
003
004
005
006
007
008
009
108
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt in B/W mode for thick 2 paper or FINE mode.
[Common: FC: Bias] Image Transfer Belt: Full Color: Bias Adjustment
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
ITB unit: Plain: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: M
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: C
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Plain: Y
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for plain paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: M
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: C
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 1: Y
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for thick 1 paper.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Black in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 12 / 1 A]
010 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Magenta in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
011
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 11 / 1 A]
Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Cyan in full color mode for Thick 2 and fine.
ITB unit: Thick 2 & FINE: Y
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 14 / 1 A]
012 Adjusts the current for the image transfer belt for Yellow in full color mode for Thick 2 and
fine.
2360
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 13/ 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 31 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 2 / 1 /step]
[Plain: Bias]
2401
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
109
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]
004
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for plain paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 27 / 1 A /step]
002
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
003
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]
004
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
110
System SP2-xxx
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
004
*ENG
005
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
009
*ENG
010
*ENG
011
*ENG
012
*ENG
013
*ENG
014
*ENG
015
*ENG
3
[100 to 600 / 105 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 120 / 5%/step]
297 mm > S2 size > 275 mm (Paper width)
[100 to 600 / 150 / 5%/step]
[100 to 600 / 110 / 5%/step]
275 mm > S3 size > 210 mm (Paper width)
111
016
*ENG
017
*ENG
018
*ENG
019
*ENG
020
*ENG
2421
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
2421
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2401 is multiplied by these SPs values.
005-008
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2422.
112
System SP2-xxx
005
*ENG
006
*ENG
*ENG
008
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
004
*ENG
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
113
2423
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2403 and SP2407 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2424.
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
004
*ENG
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
114
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2430
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 39 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 49 / 1 /step]
[Thin: Bias]
2451
115
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 2000 / 10 V/
step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thin paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
116
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
2471
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.
*ENG
*ENG
2471
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2451 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2472.
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed,
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
117
2473
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2453 and SP2457 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2474.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2480
118
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
System SP2-xxx
2481
001
2482
001
2483
001
2484
[Glossy: Bias]
Separation DC: Glossy: 1st Side
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in black-and-white mode.
[Glossy: Bias: FC]
Paper Transfer: Glossy: 1st Side
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for glossy paper in full color mode.
[Glossy: Paper Size Correction]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2485
2486
*ENG
*ENG
2487
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
119
*ENG
*ENG
2488
*ENG
*ENG
2489
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[Thick 1: Bias]
2501
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 24 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for thick 1 paper in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
120
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
121
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2521
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2522.
122
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
2523
Adjusts the correction coefficient to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing
edge in each mode. SP2502 and SP2507 are multiplied by these SP values.
Thick 1: Middle speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2524.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
123
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2530
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
2551
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[Thick 2: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick 2 paper.
*ENG
*ENG
2553
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
124
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 7 / 1 A /step]
System SP2-xxx
2558
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 16 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
125
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.
*ENG
*ENG
2571
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2551 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2572.
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2mm/step]
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2553 and SP2558 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2574.
126
*ENG
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2580
3
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 53 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
2601
[0 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[OHP: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for OHP.
001 Separation DC
2603
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
127
2608
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.
2621
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2601 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2622.
002 Separation DC
128
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
002 Separation DC
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2603 and SP2608 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
002 Separation DC
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
[100 to 0 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
002 Separation DC
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
001 Separation DC
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
2630
2650
[Thick3: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 3.
*ENG
*ENG
129
2651
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 12 / 1 A /step]
2652
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
130
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
003
*ENG
004
*ENG
005
*ENG
006
*ENG
007
*ENG
008
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
009
*ENG
010
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
2654
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
131
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2657.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2651 and SP2652 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2650 is multiplied by these SP values.
132
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]
System SP2-xxx
2670
*ENG
[Thick4: Bias]
Adjusts the DC voltage of the discharge plate for thick paper 4.
*ENG
*ENG
2671
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
2672
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper
size. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
001 Paper Transfer: 1st Side: S1
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
133
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2675.
*ENG
*ENG
2674
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2655.
134
System SP2-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2677.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
135
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2671 and SP2672 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 22 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the environment coefficient for each mode. When the environment is detected as
MM, SP2670 is multiplied by these SP values.
003 Paper Transfer: BW: 1st Side
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 55 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[Special1: Bias]
2751
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in black-and-white mode.
P Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
136
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
System SP2-xxx
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 1 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
137
2771
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, Fine: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2771
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2751 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2772.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
138
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
System SP2-xxx
2773
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2753 and SP2757 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2774.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2780
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
139
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
[Special 2: Bias]
2801
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 200 / 11 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 2 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
140
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
System SP2-xxx
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
141
2821
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2821
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2801 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2822.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
142
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
System SP2-xxx
2823
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2803 and SP2807 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2824.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2830
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
143
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 14 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[Special 3: Bias]
2851
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 V/step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in black-and-white mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 22 / 1 A /step]
[0 to 250 / 11 / 1 A /step]
Adjusts the current for the paper transfer roller for special paper 3 in full color mode.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
144
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 30 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 33 / 1 A /step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 15 / 1 A /step]
System SP2-xxx
Adjusts the size correction coefficient for the paper transfer roller current for each paper size.
SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
145
2871
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current at the paper leading edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
005-00
8
Adjusts the correction to the discharge plate current at the paper leading edge in each mode.
SP2851 is multiplied by these SP values.
The paper leading edge area can be adjusted with SP2872.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the bias/ voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/ discharge plate at the
paper leading edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
146
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
System SP2-xxx
2873
Adjusts the correction to the paper transfer roller current for the paper trailing edge in each
mode. SP2852 and SP2857 are multiplied by these SP values.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
The paper trailing edge area can be adjusted with SP2874.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3
[0 to 400 / 100 / 5%/step]
Adjusts the bias/voltage switch timing of the paper transfer roller/discharge plate at the
paper trailing edge between the erase margin area and the image area.
Plain: High speed, 1200: Low speed
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
2880
[0 to 50 / 0 / 2 mm/step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 32 / 1 /step]
147
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 26 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[1 to 60 / 1 / 1 /step]
[1 to 60 / 11 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the time when the OPC drum motor reverses from normal rotation after job end. DFU
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
001 Plain
*ENG
002 Thick 1
*ENG
*ENG
2902
001 All: BW
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]
002 All: FC
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 50 / 10 msec/step]
Adjusts the time when the image transfer belt motor reverses from normal rotation after job
end. DFU
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2&Fine: Low speed
148
003 Plain
*ENG
004 Thick 1
*ENG
*ENG
System SP2-xxx
2904
003 All
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 40 / 10 msec/step]
Specifies the time of the development roller reverse rotation after the development unit has
stopped. The reverse rotation of the development roller is used for removing dust from the
development roller.
001 K
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 80 / 10 msec/step]
All
*ENG
Specifies the threshold distance for the development roller reverse mode. This sp refers to
the counters for SP2905-006 to -009.
[Dev Rvs Counter]
006 K
*ENG
007 M
*ENG
008 C
*ENG
009 Y
*ENG
2906
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step]
[Phase Angle]
DFU
001 Y Drum
*ENG
002 C Drum
*ENG
003 M Drum
*ENG
004 K Drum
*ENG
[0 to 359 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
149
2906
[Amplitude Setting]
DFU
006 Y Drum
*ENG
007 C Drum
008 M Drum
009 K Drum
[ACS Setting (FC to Bk)]
2907
Adjusts the threshold for moving away the image transfer belt from the color PCDUs. This SP
moves the image transfer belt away from the color PCDUs when the number of B/W image
printouts reaches the number of sheets specified with this SP after consecutive full color image
printouts in the full color mode.
If this SP is set to "0", the image transfer belt does not move away.
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 2 / 1/step]
005 77 mm/sec
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 3 / 1/step]
2911
150
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
System SP2-xxx
001 Y Drum
*ENG
002 C Drum
*ENG
003 M Drum
*ENG
004 K Drum
*ENG
2912
001 Y Drum
*ENG
002 C Drum
*ENG
003 M Drum
*ENG
004 K Drum
*ENG
2913
3
[0 to 100 / 0.0 / 0.1 m/step]
[Drum Control]
[0 to 359 / 0 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / -/step]
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]
002 Displays the number of the ITB encodre error. SC443 is displayed if this counter counts to
"3".
[SecondaryFB: Threshold] Paper Transfer Roller Feed-back: Threshold Adjustment
2930
Adjusts the threshold between high resistance (division 1) and low resistance (division 2) at
the paper transfer roller. This SP affects SP2931 to SP2939.
001 Voltage
2960
*ENG
[Process Interval]
151
001
2970
Additional Time
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
001
[0 to 100 / 50 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning
Specifies the threshold sheets for the cleaning of the paper transfer roller without the refresh
mode.
002 Refresh
003
2971
001
Cleaning Counter
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: No cleaning, 1: Cleaning
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 page/step]
This counter is used for the cleaning of the paper transfer roller.
T1 Non Image Area ON Timing
Standard Speed
*ENG
Adjusts the timing for the non-image area bias of the image transfer roller.
*ENG
*ENG
2972
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 4000 / 0 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5000 / 0 / 10 page/step]
2973
001 Specifies the threshold pages for the forced processing stop at a continuous printing job.
0: No forced processing stop (default)
152
System SP2-xxx
2974
*ENG
[0 to 940 / 90 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1240 / 90 / 10 msec/step]
*ENG
2980
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 600 / 30 / 10 sec/step]
2990
001
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: No limit, 1: Limit
Limit or does not limit the duty control for a continuous printing job.
002
*ENG
Specifies the judgment time for the duty control for a continuous printing job.
Duty Control Thresh
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
003 Specifies the threshold for the duty control for a continuous printing job.
0: No duty control (default)
Forced CPM Down Thresh:
004 No Duty Control
*ENG
[0 to 5000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
Specifies the threshold page for the forced processing stop without the duty limit.
Drum Stop Time: No Duty
005 Control
*ENG
153
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5000 / 1 / 1 page/step]
Specifies the threshold page for the forced processing stop with the duty limit.
008
009
010
154
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
System SP3-xxx
SP3-XXX (Process)
3011
001 Normal
003 Pre-ACC
All colors are displayed. The results are displayed in the order "Y C M K"
e.g., 11 (Y) 99 (C) 11 (M) 11 (K): The self-check for Cyan failed but the others were
successful.
See the "Error Condition Tables" in the Process Control Error section for details.
155
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3013
003 Execution: Bk
004 Execution: M
005 Execution: C
006 Execution: Y
3014
*ENG
1: Success
2 to 9: Failure
001 Displays the developer initialization result. See section "Developer Initialization Result" in the
"Appendix: Process Control Error Conditions" section for details on the meaning of each
code.
All colors are displayed. Values are displayed in the order Y C M Bk.
e.g., 1 (Y) 2 (C) 1 (M) 1 (Bk): Initialization of Cyan failed but the others succeeded.
156
System SP3-xxx
3015
003 Execution: Bk
004 Execution: M
005 Execution: C
006 Execution: Y
3016
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3020
[0 to 30 / 4 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 5 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 20 / 1 time/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 times/step]
003
157
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3021
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 times/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
005-008 Sets the execution flag of the developer initialization for each color.
005 Execution Flag: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
009 Prohibition
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
3022
158
System SP3-xxx
[0 to 30 / 8 / 1 sec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 30 / 6 / 1 sec/step]
005-008 Sets the execution flag for the toner supply mode for each color.
005 Execution Flag: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3041
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
001
Voltage Control
*ENG
LD Power Control
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Permit, 1: Forbid
159
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
0: Not Executed
004
Pre-ACC
*ENG
1: Process Control
2: TC Control (TD Adjustment)
3: Not used
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1/step]
Pattern Calculation
005 Method
*ENG
0: FIXED
1: INITIALIZED
2: CALCULATED
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at power on.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
001 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: Initialization
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at the developer
initialization.
002
160
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment in stand by mode.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
003 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat Number: ACC
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 3 / 1 time/step]
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at ACC.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
004 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
005
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 time/step]
Not used
Repeat Number: Job End
Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment at job end.
0: Disabled, 1 to 3: Repeat number,
006 4: Repeat three times (No consumption mode)
5: Repeat three times (Toner is supplied only when the toner density is too low, and toner is
consumed only when the toner density is too dark.)
6 to 9: Disabled
Repeat: Interrupt
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 0 / 1 time/step]
007 Specifies the maximum number of repeats of the toner density adjustment during printing.
DFU
008
*ENG
Adjusts the time for the toner supply mode when a toner density is detected to be low.
161
Consumption pattern: Bk
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
009 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the black toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: M
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
010 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the magenta toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: C
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
011 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the cyan toner density when toner density
is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
Consumption pattern: Y
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 time/step]
012 Specifies the belt mark generating time for checking the yellow toner density when toner
density is detected to be low at the toner density adjustment.
013
014
015
016
017
T1 Bias: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
162
[0 to 80 / 25 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 80 / 28 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 250 / 10 / 1 sec/step]
018
[0 to 80 / 22 / 1 A/step]
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-001) exceed the target values (SP3611-005) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-002) exceed the target values (SP3611-006) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
Consumption Pattern: LD: DUTY: C
020
*ENG
3044
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-003) exceed the target values (SP3611-007) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
In toner consumption mode, toner is discharged when the detected development gamma
values (SP3611-004) exceed the target values (SP3611-008) by more than the specified
thresholds (SP3239-009).
[Toner Supply Type] Toner Supply Type ([Color])
Selects the toner supply method type.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3045
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the LD duty for the toner consumption mode at the toner density adjustment.
[0 to 15 / 15 / 1 /step]
[0 to 4 / 4 / 1/step] Alphanumeric
0: FIXED (with the supply rates stored with SP 3401)
1: PID (Vtref_Fixed)
2: PID (Vtref_Control)
3: MBD (Vtref_Fixed)
4: MBD (Vtref_Control)
001 ON/OFF
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Detect, 1: Not Detect
163
3101
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
009-012
Displays the remaining amount of each color toner. These are calculated by the operating
times of the toner supply pumps.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Adjusts the threshold of toner near end for each color. The toner near end message appears
on the LCD when the remaining toner amount reaches this threshold. When one of these
013-016
SPs (SP3-101-009 to 012 or -032 to -035) reaches this threshold, toner near end is
detected.
013 Near End Threshold: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
017-020 DFU
164
[0 to 600 / 30 / 1 g/step]
[0 to 600 / 25 / 1 g/step]
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Delta Vt Threshold
*ENG
021 This SP is the threshold for toner end. Delta Vt: Vt-Vtref
When both this SP and SP3-101-026 occur at same time, toner end is determined.
022-025
Displays the total delta Vt (Vt-Vtref) value for each color.These are calculated by pixel
counting.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 5 / 1 V/step]
028-031 Displays the consumed toner amount calculated with the pixel count for each color.
028 Pixel: Consumption: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
032-035 Displays the remaining toner amount for each color, using pixel count.
032 Pixel: Remaining : Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
165
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Not used
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 0xFFFFFFFF / 0 / 1 sec/step]
166
Adjusts the number of times toner supply is attempted for each color when the TD sensor
continues to detect toner end during toner recovery.
001 Repeat: Bk
*ENG
002 Repeat: M
*ENG
003 Repeat: C
*ENG
004 Repeat: Y
*ENG
[1 to 20 / 5 / 1 time/step]
System SP3-xxx
005
3131
*ENG
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3201
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1 time/step]
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: M
*ENG
003 Current: C
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3221
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[Vtcnt: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtcnt value for each color.
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: M
*ENG
003 Current: C
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
005-00
Displays or adjusts the Vtcnt value for each color at developer initialization. DFU
8
005 Initial: Bk
*ENG
006 Initial: M
*ENG
007 Initial: C
*ENG
008 Initial: Y
*ENG
3222
168
[Vtref: Display/Set]
Displays or adjusts the current Vtref value for each color.
System SP3-xxx
001 Current: Bk
*ENG
002 Current: M
*ENG
003 Current: C
*ENG
004 Current: Y
*ENG
005-00
Displays or adjusts the Vtref value for each color at developer initialization. DFU
8
005 Initial: Bk
*ENG
006 Initial: M
*ENG
007 Initial: C
*ENG
008 Initial: Y
*ENG
009-01
Displays and adjusts Vtref correction by pixel coverage for each color. DFU
2
009 Pixel Correction: Bk
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3223
001 Lower: Bk
*ENG
002 Lower: M
*ENG
003 Lower: C
*ENG
004 Lower: Y
*ENG
005 Upper: Bk
*ENG
006 Upper: M
*ENG
007 Upper: C
*ENG
008 Upper: Y
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01 V/step]
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
169
009 Initial TC
*ENG
010 Upper: TC
*ENG
011 Lower: TC
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[1 to 15 / 7 / 0.1 wt%/step]
Adjusts the upper limit of the toner concentration.
[1 to 15 / 9.5 / 0.1 wt%/step]
Adjusts the lower limit of the toner concentration.
[1 to 15 / 4 / 0.1 wt%/step]
Adjusts the upper limit of the TD sensor sensitivity.
[0.2 to 0.5 / 0.44 / 0.001 V/wt% /step]
Adjusts the lower limit of the TD sensor sensitivity.
[0.2 to 0.5 / 0.209 / 0.001 V/wt% /step]
014
*ENG
015
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3224
170
[1 to 15 / 9 / 0.1 wt%/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 /step]
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 V/step]
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 60 / 1 %/step]
011 TC Upper Limit Correction
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3230
[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.1 wt%/step]
[0 to 255 / 50 / 1 time/step]
001 ADD_TIME
*ENG
002 ADD:K
*ENG
003 ADD:C
*ENG
004 ADD:M
*ENG
005 ADD:Y
*ENG
006 ADD_MidSpd
*ENG
007 ADD:LowSpd
*ENG
008 MSEC_V
*ENG
009 N_Delay
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 27 / 1 /step]
[0 to 2 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
171
172
030 PID:I:K
*ENG
031 PID:I:C
*ENG
032 PID:I:M
*ENG
033 PID:I:Y
*ENG
034 PID:P:K
*ENG
035 PID:P:C
*ENG
036 PID:P:M
*ENG
037 PID:P:Y
*ENG
038 PID_I_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
039 PID:I:LowSpd
*ENG
040 PID_P_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
041 PID:P:LowSpd
*ENG
060 AWILOW:K
*ENG
061 AWILOW:C
*ENG
062 AWILOW:M
*ENG
063 AWILOW:Y
*ENG
064 AWPUP:K
*ENG
065 AWPUP:C
*ENG
066 AWPUP:M
*ENG
067 AWPUP:Y
*ENG
068 AWILOW_MidSpd
*ENG
069 AWPUP_MidSpd
*ENG
070 AWILOW:LowSpd
*ENG
071 AWPUP:LowSpd
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
090 SMITH:K
*ENG
091 SMITH:C
*ENG
092 SMITH:M
*ENG
093 SMITH:Y
*ENG
094 SMITH_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
095 SMITH:LowSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01 /step]
100 Int_conserve_I_K
*ENG
101 Int_conserve_I_C
*ENG
102 Int_conserve_I_M
*ENG
103 Int_conserve_I_Y
*ENG
110 ANC_ref_conserve_K
*ENG
111 ANC_ref_conserve_C
*ENG
112 ANC_ref_conserve_M
*ENG
113 ANC_ref_conserve_Y
*ENG
120 ANC_A3_K
*ENG
121 ANC_A3_C
*ENG
122 ANC_A3_M
*ENG
123 ANC_A3_Y
*ENG
124 ANC_A4_K
*ENG
125 ANC_A4_C
*ENG
126 ANC_A4_M
*ENG
127 ANC_A4_Y
*ENG
128 ANC_A3_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
129 ANCA4T_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
130 ANC_A3_LowSpd
*ENG
131 ANCA4T_LowSpd
*ENG
173
174
150 AWPNI_K
*ENG
151 AWPNI_C
*ENG
152 AWPNI_M
*ENG
153 AWPNI_Y
*ENG
154 PID
*ENG
180 ANCLA_K
*ENG
181 ANCLA_C
*ENG
182 ANCLA_M
*ENG
183 ANCLA_Y
*ENG
184 ANCLB_K
*ENG
185 ANCLB_C
*ENG
186 ANCLB_M
*ENG
187 ANCLB_Y
*ENG
188 ANCLA_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
189 ANCLB_MidSpd
*ENG
190 ANCLA_LowSpd
*ENG
191 ANCLB_LowSpd
*ENG
210 PIX_TBL_1
*ENG
211 PIX_TBL_2
*ENG
212 PIX_TBL_3
*ENG
213 PIX_TBL_4
*ENG
214 PIX_TBL_5
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
System SP3-xxx
215 PIX_TBL_6
*ENG
216 PIX_TBL_7
*ENG
217 PIX_TBL_8
*ENG
218 PIX_TBL_9
*ENG
219 PIX_TBL_10
*ENG
220 PIX_TBL_11
*ENG
221 PIX_TBL_12
*ENG
222 PIX_COR_K
*ENG
223 PIX_COR_C
*ENG
224 PIX_COR_M
*ENG
225 PIX_COR_Y
*ENG
226 SEL_PIX_AVE
*ENG
[1 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
231 PID_I_LIM1_Std
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
232 PID_I_LIM1_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
233 PID_I_LIM1_LowSpd
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]
234 PID_I_LIM2_Std
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
235 PID_I_LIM2_MidSpd
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
236 PID_I_LIM2_LowSpd
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]
237 PID_P_LIM1_Std
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.068 / 0.001/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.036 / 0.001/step]
243 PID_I_STDtoLOW
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]
244 PID_I_LOWtoSTD
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01/step]
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
175
245 PID_I_STDtoMID
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01/step]
246 PID_I_MIDtoSTD
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01/step]
247 PID_I_MIDtoLOW
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]
248 PID_I_LOWtoMID
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 2 / 0.01/step]
3231
Adjusts the coefficient of the toner supply time for each color.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3232
176
001 Vt Proportion: Bk
*ENG
002 Vt Proportion: M
*ENG
003 Vt Proportion: C
*ENG
004 Vt Proportion: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 2550 / 50 / 1 /step]
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3233
[1 to 255 / 20 / 1 time/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3234
*ENG
*ENG
3235
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
177
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3236
001 Latest: Bk
*ENG
002 Latest: M
*ENG
003 Latest: C
*ENG
004 Latest: Y
*ENG
3237
Displays the toner amount of the latest toner supply for each color.
178
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 5 / 1 sec/step]
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3239
3238
System SP3-xxx
001 (+)Consumption: Bk
*ENG
002 (+)Consumption: M
*ENG
003 (+)Consumption: C
*ENG
004 (+)Consumption: Y
*ENG
005 (-)Consumption: Bk
*ENG
006 (-)Consumption: M
*ENG
007 (-)Consumption: C
*ENG
008 (-)Consumption: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
013-014 Threshold for image density rank on the image transfer belt.
3241
*ENG
*ENG
001 Coefficient: Bk
*ENG
002 Coefficient: M
*ENG
003 Coefficient: C
*ENG
004 Coefficient: Y
*ENG
179
180
005 Offset: Bk
*ENG
006 Offset: M
*ENG
007 Offset: C
*ENG
008 Offset: Y
*ENG
3242
001 StdSpd:Coefficient: Bk
*ENG
002 StdSpd:Coefficient: M
*ENG
003 StdSpd:Coefficient: C
*ENG
004 StdSpd:Coefficient: Y
*ENG
005 StdSpd:Offset: Bk
*ENG
006 StdSpd:Offset: M
*ENG
007 StdSpd:Offset: C
*ENG
008 StdSpd:Offset: Y
*ENG
009 MidSpd:coef:Bk
*ENG
010 MidSpd:coef:M
*ENG
011 MidSpd:coef:C
*ENG
012 MidSpd:coef:Y
*ENG
013 MidSpd:offset:Bk
*ENG
014 MidSpd:offset:M
*ENG
015 MidSpd:offset:C
*ENG
016 MidSpd:offset:Y
*ENG
017 LowSpd:Coef:Bk
*ENG
018 LowSpd:Coef:M
*ENG
019 LowSpd:Coef:C
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
020 LowSpd:Coef:Y
*ENG
021 LowSpd:offset:Bk
*ENG
022 LowSpd:offset:M
*ENG
023 LowSpd:offset:C
*ENG
024 LowSpd:offset:Y
*ENG
3243
[DevBias_SpdCorrectSetting]
Adjusts the coefficient or offset value for development bias correction for each speed.
001 MidSpd:Coef:Bk
*ENG
002 MidSpd:Coef:M
*ENG
003 MidSpd:Coef:C
*ENG
004 MidSpd:Coef:Y
*ENG
005 MidSpd:offset:Bk
*ENG
006 MidSpd:offset:M
*ENG
007 MidSpd:offset:C
*ENG
008 MidSpd:offset:Y
*ENG
009 LowSpd:Coef:Bk
*ENG
010 LowSpd:Coef:M
*ENG
011 LowSpd:Coef:C
*ENG
012 LowSpd:Coef:Y
*ENG
013 LowSpd:offset:Bk
*ENG
014 LowSpd:offset:M
*ENG
015 LowSpd:offset:C
*ENG
016 LowSpd:offset:Y
*ENG
3251
[Coverage]
These (-001 to -016) are coefficients for SP3-222-009 to -012.
181
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]
*ENG
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
005-008 "Average S" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-017.
005 Average S: Bk
*ENG
006 Average S: M
*ENG
007 Average S: C
*ENG
008 Average S: Y
*ENG
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
009-012 "Average M" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3251-018.
009 Average M: Bk
*ENG
010 Average M: M
*ENG
011 Average M: C
*ENG
012 Average M: Y
*ENG
Displays the average coverage of each color for the Vtref correction.
013-016 "Average L" is defined when the number of developed pages does not reach the number
specified with SP3-251-019.
013 Average L: Bk
*ENG
014 Average L: M
*ENG
015 Average L: C
*ENG
016 Average L: Y
*ENG
182
*ENG
[1 to 100 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 100 / 40 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 500 / 10 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
[1 to 999 / 50 / 1 sheet/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
028
3311
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 20 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 0 / 0.01 V/step]
005-007 Displays the ID sensor (diffusion) offset voltage for Vsg adjustments.
005 Voffset dif: M
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
183
3321
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3323
3322
184
001 Ifsg: Bk
*ENG
002 Ifsg: M
*ENG
003 Ifsg: C
*ENG
004 Ifsg: Y
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3324
[0 to 50 / 0 / 0.1 mA/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 0.1 time/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
001 Latest
*ENG
002 Latest 1
*ENG
003 Latest 2
*ENG
004 Latest 3
*ENG
005 Latest 4
*ENG
006 Latest 5
*ENG
007 Latest 6
*ENG
008 Latest 7
*ENG
009 Latest 8
*ENG
010 Latest 9
*ENG
3361
185
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3362
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 5 / 0.01 /step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01 /step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
010
186
[0 to 5 / - / 0.0001 /step]
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0:Linear, 1: Curve
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0 / 0.01 /step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3363
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3371
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
187
3401
Adjusts the toner supply rate in the fixed toner supply mode.
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 5 / 1 %/step]
*ENG
*ENG
3411
001 Latest: Bk
*ENG
002 Latest: M
*ENG
003 Latest: C
*ENG
004 Latest: Y
*ENG
3421
[0 to 100 / - / 1 %/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
*ENG
3451
188
System SP3-xxx
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
3452
001 Maximum: Bk
*ENG
002 Maximum: M
*ENG
003 Maximum: C
*ENG
004 Maximum: Y
*ENG
3501
3
[0 to 10000 / 1000 / 1 msec/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3510
[0 to 10000 / 0 / 1 msec/step]
189
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
005 MUSIC: BW
*ENG
006 MUSIC: FC
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3511
190
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
[0 to 2000 / 0 / 1 page/step]
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Not Correct (OFF),
1: Correct (ON)
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.5 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
026
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.1 / 0.01/step]
027
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
028
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 0.25 / 0.01/step]
029
*ENG
[0 to 1 / 1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 5 / 1/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1/step]
3512
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 30 / 1 page/step]
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 10 / 1 minute/step]
001 Year
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 0 / 1/step]
002 Month
*ENG
[1 to 12 / 1 / 1/step]
003 Date
*ENG
[1 to 31 / 1 / 1/step]
004 Hour
*ENG
[0 to 23 / 0 / 1/step]
005 Minute
*ENG
[0 to 59 / 0 / 1/step]
191
001 Temperature
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / - / 0.1%RH/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
192
While making prints with low coverage, the developer is agitated with less toner consumption
and the toner carrier attraction tends to increase. This may cause low image density or poor
transfer (white dots). To prevent this, the coagulated toner or overcharged toner has to be
consumed by performing the refresh mode.
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1000 / 1 / 1 m/step]
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 2.55 / 1 / 0.01/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 100 / 40 / 1%/step]
*ENG
[0 to 56 / 12 / 1mm/step]
*ENG
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 cm2/step]
[0 to 255 / 14 / 1 cm2/m/step]
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 time/step]
193
Adjusts the threshold temperature for preventing the cleaning blade in the transfer belt
cleaning unit from being damaged. If the temperature is above this value, toner is applied
to the transfer belt at set intervals during the job to prevent the blade from flipping over.
3518
*ENG
[0 to 50 / 40 / 1C/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
*ENG
0: OFF. 1: ON
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
*ENG
0: OFF. 1: ON (once),
2: ON (twice)
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
008 MUSIC
*ENG
0: OFF. 1: ON (once),
2: ON (twice)
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3519
194
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF. 1: ON
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]
002 MUSIC
*ENG
003 TC Adj.
*ENG
3520
001 Temperature: H
*ENG
002 Temperature: M
*ENG
003 Temperature: L
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 3 / 0 / 1 revolution/step]
[Temperature Threshold]
3521
Specifies the threshold temperature for each condition. These settings affect the conditions
of SP3-520.
t1: Threshold between L (low temp.) and M (medium temp.)
t2: Threshold between M (medium temp.) and H (high temps)
001 Threshold: t2
*ENG
[20 or 30 / 25 / 1 deg/step]
002 Threshold: t1
*ENG
[0 or 15 / 15 / 1 deg/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
195
[Rapi_timer]
100 Time Setting
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 30 / 1 sec/step]
3531
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1C/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 50 / 1 %RH/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 6 / 1 g/m3/step]
*ENG
[0 to 99 / 10 / 1 time/step]
3611
196
001 Bk (Current)
*ENG
002 M (Current)
*ENG
003 C (Current)
*ENG
004 Y (Current)
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3612
[Vk Display]
Displays Vk for each color.
001 Bk
*ENG
002 M
*ENG
003 C
*ENG
004 Y
*ENG
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the development DC bias adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.
197
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3622
001 VB Limit
*ENG
[0 to 500 / 50 / 1 V/step]
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the charge DC voltage adjusted with the process control for each line speed and
color.
198
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
Plain: High speed, Thick 1: Middle speed, Thick 2 & FINE: Low speed
Displays the LD power adjusted for each environment.
001 Plain: Bk
*ENG
002 Plain: M
*ENG
003 Plain: C
*ENG
004 Plain: Y
*ENG
199
005 Thick 1: Bk
*ENG
006 Thick 1: M
*ENG
007 Thick 1: C
*ENG
008 Thick 1: Y
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
3711
200
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not Use, 1: Use
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
System SP3-xxx
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3712
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3713
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
201
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3714
202
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
001 Vcnt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.1 V/step]
002 Vt
*ENG
003 Sensitivity: HL
*ENG
004 Sensitivity: HM
*ENG
005 Sensitivity: ML
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 1 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
011 Adjustment: Vt
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 3 / 0.1 V/step]
*ENG
[0 to 5 / 4 / 0.01 V/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 9 / 1 /step]
3800
[0 to 255 / - / 1 V/step]
001 Condition
*CTL
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
*CTL
[0 to 50 / - / 1 /step]
*CTL
[0 to 1000 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
*CTL
[0 to 200000 / - / 1 cm2/step]
008 Coefficient
*ENG
Notice Setting
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Enable @Remote calling
1: Disable @Remote calling
011
NOTE:
If the toner collection bottle has been replaced before the machine detects used toner near
full when this setting is set to "0", the machine cannot detect toner collection bottle near full.
In that case, set SP3-902-017 to "1".
203
*ENG
[1 to 30 / 5 / 1 day/step]
012 Sets the threshold days for the near-full display. The near-full of the toner collection bottle is
displayed after the toner collection full sensor has detected the actuator in the toner collection
bottle.
*ENG
*ENG
3900
[0 to 999999999 / 1 / 1]
Displays the date of the full detection fot the
toner collection bottle.
3901
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
204
Turns the new unit detection flag for each PM unit on or off.
The use of these counters is explained in the PM section and in the relevant parts of section
3 (Replacement and Adjustment).
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
System SP3-xxx
005 Developer: Bk
*ENG
006 Developer: Y
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
007 Developer: C
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
008 Developer: M
*ENG
009 PCDU: Bk
*ENG
010 PCDU: Y
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
011 PCDU: M
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
012 PCDU: C
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
0: OFF, 1: ON
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
3903
*ENG
205
001 Counter 1
*ENG
002 Counter 2
*ENG
003 Counter 3
*ENG
004 Counter 4
*ENG
005 Counter 5
*ENG
006 Counter 6
*ENG
007 Counter 7
*ENG
008 Counter 8
*ENG
009 Counter 9
*ENG
010 Counter 10
*ENG
011040
Counter 11 to 40
206
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP4-xxx
System SP4-xxx
SP4-XXX (Scanner)
4008
001
*ENG
Adjusts the leading edge registration by changing the scanning start timing in the sub-scan
direction.
001
*ENG
Adjusts the side-to-side registration by changing the scanning start timing in the main scan
direction.
001 -
*ENG
Sets the blank margin at each side for erasing the original shadow caused by the gap
between the original and the scale.
*ENG
*ENG
207
Performs the scanner free run with the exposure lamp on or off in the following mode.
Full color mode / Full Size / A3 or DLT
001 Lamp: ON
002 Lamp: OFF
4014
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
[Scan]
Execute the scanner free fun with each mode.
4020
[Dust Check]
Turns the ADF scan glass dust check on/ off.
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Selects the detect level.
*ENG
[0 to 8 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: lowest detection level
8: highest detection level
Selects the level of the sub scan line correction
when using the ARDF.
[0 to 4 / 0 / 1 /step]
*ENG
0: Off
1: Weakest
2: Weak
3: Strong
4: Strongest
208
*ENG
Not used
*ENG
Not used
System SP4-xxx
Displays a code that represents the original size detected by the original sensors. (See "Input
Check Table".)
4303
001
*ENG
0: No Original
1: A5-Lengthwise (16K SEF if 4305 is set to 3)
2: A5-Sideways (16K LEF if 4305 is set to 3)
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1 /step]
4305
[8K/16K Detection]
*ENG
001 This program enables the machine to automatically recognize the 8K/16K size.
4308
*ENG
0: OFF
1: ON
001
Turns on or off the CCD original size detection. This detection is used only when an original
is scanned in book scanning mode.
4309
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 32 / 1 digit/step]
001 Specifies the threshold between an original area and non-original area for the scan original
size detection in book scanning mode.
209
002
003
Detection Time
*ENG
Specifies the detection time for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
Lamp ON:Delay Time
*ENG
[0 to 200 / 40 / 20 msec/step]
Specifies the lamp on timing for the scan original size detection in book scanning mode.
[Scan Size Detect Value]
4310
Displays the detected value by CCD. Each detection point for paper size and color is
displayed on the LCD.
001 S1:R
*ENG
002 S1:G
*ENG
003 S1:B
*ENG
004 S2:R
*ENG
005 S2:G
*ENG
006 S2:B
*ENG
007 S3:R
*ENG
008 S3:G
*ENG
009 S3:B
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
210
System SP4-xxx
4417
001
Test Pattern
Selection
0: Scanned image
6: Grid pattern
8: Gradation RGBCMYK
9: UCR pattern
001 Copy
002 Scanner
*ENG
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
003 Fax
211
4450
001
002
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ] 0: OFF, 1: ON
4460
Specifies the level of deleting the background in the ADS mode. You can adjust its level for
each scanning method (platen, ADF).
*ENG
*ENG
4501
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
4505
212
[ACC Cor:Bright]
Adjusts the offset correction for light areas of the ACC pattern.
System SP4-xxx
001 Text:K
*ENG
002 Text:C
*ENG
003 Text:M
*ENG
004 Text:Y
*ENG
005 Photo:K
*ENG
006 Photo:C
*ENG
007 Photo:M
*ENG
008 Photo:Y
*ENG
4506
[ACC Cor:Dark]
Adjusts the offset correction for dark areas of the ACC pattern.
001 Text:K
*ENG
002 Text:C
*ENG
003 Text:M
*ENG
004 Text:Y
*ENG
005 Photo:K
*ENG
006 Photo:C
*ENG
007 Photo:M
*ENG
008 Photo:Y
*ENG
This SP corrects the printer coverage of 12 hues (RY, YR, YG, etc. x 4 Colors [R, G, B,
Option]) for a total of 48 parameters.
213
*ENG
4551
4552
4553
4554
4565
4570
4571
4572
-005
*ENG
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
0: MTF Off
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
214
System SP4-xxx
-006
-007
-008
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]
Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1255
*ENG
*ENG
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
Independent Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
-009 Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
4580
4582
4583
*ENG
-005
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
0: MTF Off
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-006
-007
-008
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]
Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1255
*ENG
*ENG
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
Independent Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
215
Texture Erase: 0
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
-010 Sets the erasure level of textures. Set higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect. This
SP (suffix "-010") only exists in SP4580, 4582 and 4583.
0: Not activated
4581
4584
4585
*ENG
-005
[0 to 15 / 8 / 1 /step]
0: MTF Off
Sets the MTF level (Modulation Transfer Function) designed to improve image contrast. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
-006
-007
-008
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 4 / 1 /step]
Use to remove "jaggies" if they appear. Set higher for smoother images.
Brightness: 1255
*ENG
*ENG
Set higher for more contrast, set lower for less contrast.
Independent Dot Erase (0), 1-7 (Strong)
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 /step]
-009 Selects the contrast level for B/W the Text mode. Sets the erasure level of Irregular Dots. Set
higher for stronger effect, lower for weaker effect.
0: Not activated
4600
216
001 SBU_ID
002 GASBU-N_ID
[0 to 0xFF / - / 1 /step]
003 VSP5100_ID
[0 to 0xFF / - / 1 /step]
System SP4-xxx
4602
4603
[AGC Execution]
DFU
4604
001 -
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
4609
002 DF Read
002 DF Read
002 DF Read
4610
4611
217
4623
4624
4625
218
System SP4-xxx
4628
4629
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Green.
-
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for RE or RO.
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4635
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4633
Displays the gain value of the amplifiers on the controller for Blue.
4632
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4631
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4630
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
219
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
4636
001 Execution
Not used
4637
4638
220
System SP4-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
4639
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
4640
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
221
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4647
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 Power-ON
4654
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
4655
222
System SP4-xxx
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
4656
001
*ENG
002
*ENG
4658
4659
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
4660
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
223
4661
*ENG
*ENG
4662
*ENG
*ENG
4663
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
4673
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
4674
224
System SP4-xxx
*ENG
4675
*ENG
*ENG
4677
4678
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
225
4679
4680
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
4681
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
4682
[0 to 7 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
*ENG
*ENG
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
Adjusts the white shading parameter when scanning an image with the ARDF or 1-pass DF.
Adjusts the density level if the ID of outputs made in the DF and Platen mode is different.
001 ARDF
*ENG
002 1-pass DF
*ENG
4690
226
System SP4-xxx
001 RE
002 RO
4691
001 GE
002 GO
4692
002 BO
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 RE
002 RO
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 GE
002 GO
4695
4694
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 BE
4693
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
001 BE
002 BO
[0 to 1023 / 0 / 1 digit/step]
227
228
4700
4709
4710
4711
4712
4713
4714
4745
4746
4747
4748
4749
4750
4784
4785
4786
4787
4788
4789
4790
4791
4792
4793
4794
4795
4796
System SP4-xxx
4797
4798
4799
4802
001 Lamp ON
002 Lamp OFF
4803
[Home Position]
001 4806
001 4804
[Carriage Save]
Moves the carriage from the scanner home
position.
001 -
4807
001 -
4808
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
229
4810
001
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
0: Brand T, 1: Brand U
4902
This SP outputs the final data read at the end of ACC execution.
A zero is returned if there was an error reading the data.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 R DATA1
*ENG
002 G DATA1
*ENG
003 B DATA1
*ENG
004 R DATA2
*ENG
005 G DATA2
*ENG
006 B DATA2
*ENG
4905
*ENG
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Adjusts the offset data of the printer gamma for yellow in Photo mode.
See Printer Gamma Correction" in the Replacement and Adjustment for how to use.
009 -
4954
[Read/Restore Std]
System SP4-xxx
4958
4991
*ENG
[0 to 11 / 2 / 1 /step ]
4993
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest sensitivity
9: strongest sensitivity
Selects the range level of Highlight correction.
*ENG
[0 to 9 / 4 / 1 /step]
0: weakest skew correction,
9: strongest skew correction
4994
231
[0 to 2 / 1 / 1 /step]
001
*ENG
0: Text priority
1: Normal
2: Photo priority
4996
Selects the threshold level of the original background density. Increasing this threshold level
machine easily judge that an original is white.
[0 to 6 / 3 / 1 /step]
001 -
*ENG
0: lightest
6: Darkest
232
System SP5-xxx
System SP5-xxx
SP5-XXX (Mode)
5024
*CTL
0: mm (Europe/Asia)
1: inch (USA)
[Accounting Counter]
5045
*CTL
0: Developments
1: Prints
5047
[Paper Display]
Turns on or off the printed paper display on the LCD.
001 -
5051
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: OFF, 1: ON
*CTL
0: ON
1: OFF
5055
[Display IP Address]
Display or does not display the IP address on the LCD.
233
001 -
5056
234
0: OFF 1: ON
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display
001 -
5062
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 -
5061
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
*CTL
*CTL
009 Developer: Bk
*CTL
010 Developer: M
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
011 Developer: C
*CTL
012 Developer: Y
*CTL
System SP5-xxx
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5066
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Not display, 1: Display
001 -
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: No display, 1: Display
001 PCDU:Bk
*CTL
002 PCDU:M
*CTL
003 PCDU:C
*CTL
004 PCDU:Y
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
235
009 Developer:Bk
*CTL
010 Developer:M
*CTL
011 Developer:C
*CTL
012 Developer:Y
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5071
001
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off, 1: On
Turn on or off the paper size confirmation pop-up on the LED. This pop-up prevents
mismatching between a paper size selected by the operation panel and an actual paper
size on the by-pass tray.
[A3/DLT Double Count] SSP
5104
Specifies whether the counter is double clicked for A3/DLT size prints.
When you have to change this SP, ask your supervisor.
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: NO (Normal count)
*CTL
5104*
236
System SP5-xxx
Specifies whether the counter is doubled for A3/DLT. "Yes" counts except from the bypass
tray. When "Yes" is selected, A3 and DLT paper are counted twice, that is A4 x2 and LT
x2 respectively.
5113
001
*CTL
0: None
*CTL
1: Expansion Device 1
2: Expansion Device 2
3: Expansion Device 3
5114
5118
[Disable Copying]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5120
001
5121
001
This program updates the information on the optional counter. When you install or remove
an optional counter, check the settings.
[Counter Up Timing]
*CTL
This program specifies when the counter goes up. The settings refer to "paper feed" and
"paper exit" respectively.
237
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
5126
*ENG
5127
[APS Mode]
*CTL
*CTL
001 DFU
5131
001
*ENG
The program selects a paper size system from the following alternatives: the AB system (0),
the LT system (1), and the AF system (2).
[0: OFF/ 1: ON]
5148
*CTL
0: OFF (Detect)
1: ON (Not Detect)
001 Enables or disables the automatic paper size detection for the by-pass tray.
5150
*CTL
Determines whether the transfer sheet from the by-pass tray is used or not.
001 Normally the paper length for sub scanning paper from the by-pass tray is limited to 600
mm, but this can be extended with this SP to 1260 mm.
5162
*CTL
001 This program specifies the switch that selects an application program.
238
System SP5-xxx
Enables or disables the automatic print out without an accounting device. This SP is used
when the receiving fax is accounted by an external accounting device.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Automatic printing
1: No automatic printing
[CE Login]
5169
If you will change the printer bit switches, you must log in to service mode with this SP before
you go into the printer SP mode.
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
001 CE Login
*CTL
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
5181
[Size Adjust]
Adjusts the paper size for each tray.
001 TRAY 1
*ENG
002 TRAY 2: 1
*ENG
003 TRAY 2: 2
*ENG
004 TRAY 2: 3
*ENG
005 TRAY 2: 4
*ENG
*ENG
007 TRAY 3: 2
*ENG
239
008 TRAY 3: 3
*ENG
009 TRAY 3: 4
*ENG
010 TRAY 4: 1
*ENG
011 TRAY 4: 2
*ENG
012 TRAY 4: 3
*ENG
013 TRAY 4: 4
*ENG
018 LCT
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4 LEF, 1: LT LEF
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A3, 1: DLT
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B4, 1: LG
[0 or 1 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: B5 LEF, 1: Exe LEF
[0 to 2 / 0 (EU/ASIA), 1 (NA) / - ]
0: A4LEF, 1: LTLEF, 2: B5LEF
[RK 4]
5186
001 -
*ENG
0: Disable
1: Enable
5188
[Copy NV Version]
Displays the version number of the NVRAM on the controller board.
001 5191
240
System SP5-xxx
001
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Off, 1: On
Sets the external controller type. This setting is appropriately adjusted if an external controller
is installed in the machine.
[0 to 10 / 0 / 1/step]
001 0: No external controller installed
1: EFI controller
2: Ratio controller
3: Egret controller
4 to 10: Reserved
5195
*CTL
0: Productivity priority
1: Tray priority
Productivity priority:
This changes the feeding tray as soon as the machine detects the priority tray even the paper
still remains in the feeding tray.
Tray priority:
This changes the feeding tray after the paper in the tray where the machine has been feeding
paper has been run out of.
This SP is activated only when a customer selects the "Auto Paper Selsct".
5196
001 5199
*CTL
241
001 -
*CTL
[ 0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: OFF, 1: ON
Enables or disables the paper feeding out from the finisher without stapling.
If this setting is "1: ON", paper is fed out without stapling at the maximum number of
the finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum
number).
If this setting is "0: OFF", paper is fed out with stapling at the maximum number of the
finisher stapling when the machine gets a multiple printing job (over maximum number).
3
5212
[Page Numbering]
*CTL
This program adjusts the position of the second side page numbers.
A " value" moves the page number positions to the left edge. A "+ value" moves the page
number positions to the right edge.
003 Duplex Printout Right/Left Position
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[10 to 10 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
[Set Time]
Adjusts the RTC (real time clock) time setting for the local time zone.
Examples: For Japan (+9 GMT), enter 540 (9 hours x 60 min.)
DOM: +540 (Tokyo)
5302
242
[Summer Time]
*CTL#
System SP5-xxx
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
NA and EUR: 1, ASIA: 0
243
5401
When installing the SDK application, SAS (VAS) adjusts the following settings. DFU
Default Document ACL
*CTL
Whenever a new login user is added to the address book in external certification mode
(for Windows, LDAP, RDH), the default document ACL is updated according to this SP
setting.
103
[0 to 3 / 0 / 1]
0: View
1: Edit
2: Edit/Delete
3: Full control
Note: This SP setting is ignored on a machine that is not using document server.
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 sec./step]
104
Authentication Time
*CTL
0: 60 seconds
1 to 250 seconds
*CTL
Selects the log out type for the extend authentication device.
244
System SP5-xxx
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
Detail Option
*CTL
3
-
5404
5411
[LDAP Certification]
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Password NULL not permitted.
1: Password NULL permitted.
245
*CTL
5413
[Lockout Setting]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Off (no wait time, lockout not cancelled)
1: On (system waits, cancels lockout if correct user
ID and password are entered.
*CTL
*CTL
Not Used
[Access Mitigation]
*CTL
246
System SP5-xxx
*CTL
5415
[Password Attack]
*CTL
*CTL
5416
[Access Information]
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5417
[Access Attack]
*CTL
*CTL
247
*CTL
*CTL
[User Authentication]
5420
001 Copy
*CTL
*CTL
Enables or disables the color copy limitation for each copy mode when the user
authentication is "ON".
0: Enable (default), 1: Disable
002
*CTL
248
System SP5-xxx
021 Fax
*CTL
031 Scanner
*CTL
041 Printer
*CTL
051 SDK1
061 SDK2
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1] 0: ON. 1: OFF
*CTL
071 SDK3
5430
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
5431
010
Tag
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the tag copy permission for the external authentication.
249
011
Entry
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the entry information for the external authentication.
012
Group
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the group information for the external authentication.
3
020
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the mail information for the external authentication.
030
Fax
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax information for the external authentication.
FaxSub
*CTL
031
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the fax additional information for the external
authentication.
032
Folder
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the folder information for the external authentication.
ProtectCode
*CTL
033
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the protection code information for the external
authentication.
034
SmtpAuth
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMTP information for the external authentication.
250
System SP5-xxx
035
LdapAuth
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the LDAP information for the external authentication.
Smb Ftp Auth
*CTL
036
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the SMB/FTP information for the external
authentication.
AcntAcl
*CTL
037
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
Turns on or off the copy permission of the account ACL information for the external
authentication.
DocumentAcl
*CTL
038
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the document ACL information for the external
authentication.
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
CertCrypt
040
Turns on or off the copy permission of the authentication information for the external
authentication.
UserLimitCount
*CTL
050
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Not permit, 1: Permit
Turns on or off the copy permission of the maximum number information for the external
authentication.
5481
*CTL
251
*CTL
5490
*CTL
5501
[PM Alarm]
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 /step]
001 PM Alarm Level
0: Alarm off
1 to 9999: Alarm goes off when Value (1 to 9999) x 1000
> PM counter
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
5504
[Jam Alarm]
0: No alarm sounds
1: Alarm sounds after the number of originals passing
through the ARDF > 10,000
*CTL
Sets the alarm to sound for the specified jam level (document misfeeds are not included).
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 /step]
001
0: Zero (Off)
1: Low (2.5K jams)
2: Medium (3K jams)
3: High (6K jams)
252
System SP5-xxx
[Error Alarm]
Sets the error alarm level.
The error alarm counter counts "1" when any SC is detected. However, the error alarm
counter decreases by "1" when an SC is not detected during a set number of copied sheets
(for example, default 1500 sheets).
5505
The error alarm occurs when the SC error alarm counter reaches "5".
001 -
5507
[Supply Alarm]
*CTL
*CTL
0: Off, 1: On
[CC Call]
*CTL -
253
001*
002*
003*
Jam Remains
0: Disable, 1: Enable
0: Disable, 1: Enable
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 minute /step]
011* Sets the time a jam must remain before it becomes an "unattended paper jam". This setting
is enabled only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Jam Detection: Continuous Count
[2 to 10 / 5 / 1 /step]
012* Sets the number of consecutive paper jams required to initiate a call. This setting is enabled
only when SP5508-004 is set to "1".
Door Open: Time Length
[3 to 30 / 10 / 1 /step]
013* Sets the length of time the door remains open before the machine initiates a call.
This setting is enabled only when SP5-508-004 is set to "1".
[SC/Alarm Setting]
254
*CTL
5515
With NRS (New Remote Service) in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an SC call when
an SC error occurs. If this SP is switched off, the SC call is not issued when an SC error
occurs.
001
SC Call
002
003
004
User Call
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: Off
1: On
System SP5-xxx
006
007
008
Alarm Notice
009
010
011
012
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
5516
0: Off
1: On
*CTL
With @Remote in use, these SP codes can be set to issue an PM alarm call when one of SP
parts reaches its yield.
001
005
006
001
5611
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
*ENG
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
255
B-M
002
*ENG
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
G-C
003
*ENG
Adjusts the Cyan correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
G-Y
004
*ENG
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-M
005
*ENG
Adjusts the Magenta correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
R-Y
006
*ENG
Adjusts the Yellow correction value of the blue signal in two-color mode.
5618
*CTL
256
System SP5-xxx
001
5801
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
[Memory Clear]
001 All Clear
002 Engine
003 SCS
005 MCS
Initializes the fax reset time, job login ID, all TX/RX settings,
local storage file numbers, and off-hook timer.
Initializes the scanner defaults for the scanner and all the
scanner SP modes.
257
011 NCS
012 R-Fax
017 CCS
019 LCS
021 ECS
[Free Run]
Performs a free run on the copier engine.
5802
The machine starts free run in the same condition as the sequence of A4/LT, A3 or
A4 SEF printing from the 1st or 2nd tray. Therefore, the correct paper should be
loaded in the 1st tray or 2nd tray, but paper is not fed.
The main switch has to be turned off and on after using the free run mode for a test.
258
002 FC A4 LEF
003 FC A3 LEF
5803
[Input Check]
5804
[Output Check]
System SP5-xxx
5805
[Anti-Condensation Heater]
002 0:OFF / 1:ON
5806
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
[RFID CONT.READING]
001
002
003
TIMES
[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]
[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]
[0 to 65535 / - / 1 /step]
004 EXE.ALL
005 EXE.K
006 EXE.M
007 EXE.C
008 EXE.Y
[SC Reset]
5810
5811
5812
004 BICU
259
Service
*CTL
001 Sets the telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List, which can be printed with the users "Counter" menu.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Facsimile
*CTL
002 Sets the fax or telephone number for a service representative. This number is printed on the
Counter List.
This can be up to 20 characters (both numbers and alphabetic characters can be input).
Supply
*CTL
003 Use this to input the telephone number of your supplier for consumables. Enter the number
and press #.
Operation
*CTL
004 Use this to input the telephone number of your sales agency. Enter the number and press
#.
5816
[Remote Service]
*CTL
I/F Setting
Selects the remote service setting.
001
[0 to 2 / 2 / 1 /step]
0: Remote service off
1: CSS remote service on
2: NRS remote service on
CE Call
Performs the CE Call at the start or end of the service.
002
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Start of the service
1: End of the service
NOTE: This SP is activated only when SP 5816-001 is set to "2".
260
System SP5-xxx
Function Flag
Enables or disables the remote service function.
003 [0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disabled
1: Enabled
SSL Disable
007
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Yes. SSL not used.
1: No. SSL used.
RCG Connect Timeout
008 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the time-out when the RCG (Remote Communication
Gate) connects during a call via the @Remote network.
[1 to 90 / 30 / 1 second /step]
RCG Write Timeout
009 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the time-out when sent data is written to the RCG during
a call over the @Remote network.
[1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
RCG Read Timeout
010 Sets the length of time (seconds) for the timeout when sent data is written from the RCG
during a call over the @Remote network.
[1 to 100 / 60 / 1 second /step]
Port 80 Enable
011
Controls if permission is given to get access to the SOAP method over Port 80 on the
@Remote network.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: No. Access denied
1: Yes. Access granted.
261
RFU Timing
Selects the timing for the remote firmware updating.
013 [0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Any status of a target machine
1: Sleep or panel off mode only
RCG C Registed
021
Proxy Host
This SP sets the address of the proxy server used for communication between the RCG
device and the gateway. Use this SP to set up or display the customer proxy server address.
063
262
System SP5-xxx
Proxy PortNumber
This SP sets the port number of the proxy server used for communication between the
embedded RCG-N and the gateway. This setting is necessary to set up the embedded
064
RCG-N.
This port number is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy User Name
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification user name.
065
The length of the name is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
Proxy Password
This SP sets the HTTP proxy certification password.
066
The length of the password is limited to 31 characters. Any character beyond the 31st
character is ignored.
This name is customer information and is not printed in the SMC report.
067
CERT:Up State
Displays the status of the certification update.
0
The certification request (setAuthKey) for update has been received from the GW
URL and certification is presently being updated.
The certification update is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
successful update.
The certification update failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the failed update.
The period of the certification has expired and new request for an update is being
sent to the GW URL.
11
A rescue update for certification has been issued and a rescue certification setting
is in progress for the rescue GW connection.
263
12
The rescue certification setting is completed and the GW URL is being notified of the
certification update request.
13
The notification of the request for certification update has completed successfully,
and the system is waiting for the certification update request from the rescue GW
URL.
14
The notification of the certification request has been received from the rescue GW
controller, and the certification is being stored.
15
The certification has been stored, and the GW URL is being notified of the successful
completion of this event.
16
The storing of the certification has failed, and the GW URL is being notified of the
failure of this event.
17
The certification update request has been received from the GW URL, the GW URL
was notified of the results of the update after it was completed, but an certification
error has been received, and the rescue certification is being recorded.
18
The rescue certification of No. 17 has been recorded, and the GW URL is being
notified of the failure of the certification update.
CERT:Error
Displays a number code that describes the reason for the request for update of the
certification.
068
264
Request for certification update in progress. The current certification has expired.
An SSL error notification has been issued. Issued after the certification has expired.
069 CERT:Up ID
System SP5-xxx
Displays the start time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.
Displays the end time of the period for which the current
@Remote certification is enabled.
Selection Country
Select the country where embedded RCG-M is installed in the machine. After selecting the
country, you must also set the following SP codes for embedded RCG-M:
150
SP5816-153
SP5816-154
SP5816-161
0: Japan, 1: USA, 2: Canada, 3: UK, 4: Germany, 5: France, 6: Italy,
7: Netherlands, 8: Belgium, 9: Luxembourg, 10: Spain
265
If the execution succeeded, SP5816-153 will display the result for confirmation and
SP5816-154 will display the telephone number for the connection to the outside line.
Line Type Judgment Result
Displays a number to show the result of the execution of SP5816 151. Here is a list of what
the numbers mean.
0: Success
1: In progress (no result yet). Please wait.
2: Line abnormal
152 3: Cannot detect dial tone automatically
4: Line is disconnected
5: Insufficient electrical power supply
6: Line classification not supported
7: Error because fax transmission in progress ioctl() occurred.
8: Other error occurred
9: Line classification still in progress. Please wait.
Selection Dial/Push
This SP displays the classification (tone or pulse) of the telephone line to the access point
for embedded RCG-M. The number displayed (0 or 1) is the result of the execution of
SP5816-151. However, this setting can also be changed manually.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
153 0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone
Inside Japan "2" may also be displayed:
0: Tone Dialing Phone
1: Pulse Dialing Phone 10PPS
2: Pulse Dialing Phone 20PPS
266
System SP5-xxx
The number setting for the external line can be entered manually (including commas).
Dial Up User Name
156
Use this SP to set a user name for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Dial Up Password
157
Use this SP to set a password for access to remote dial up. Follow these rules when setting
a user name:
Name length: Up to 32 characters
Spaces and # allowed but the entire entry must be enclosed by double quotation
marks (").
Local Phone Number
161 Use this SP to set the telephone number of the line where embedded RCG-M is connected.
This number is transmitted to and used by the Call Center to return calls.
Limit: 24 numbers (numbers only)
Connection Timing Adjustment: Incoming
When the Call Center calls out to an embedded RCG-M modem, it sends a repeating ID
tone (*#1#). This SP sets the time the line remains open to send these ID tones after the
162 number of the embedded RCG-M modem is dialed up and connected.
[0 to 24 / 1 / 1 /step]
The actual amount of time is this setting x 2 sec. For example, if you set "2" the line will
remain open for 4 sec.
267
Access Point
This is the number of the dial-up access point for RCG-M. If no setting is done for this SP
163 code, then a preset value (determined by the country selected) is used.
Default: 0
Allowed: Up to 16 alphanumeric characters
164 Line Connecting
This SP sets the connection conditions for the customer. This setting dedicates the line to
RCG-M only, or sets the line for sharing between RCG-M and a fax unit.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Sharing Fax
1: No Sharing Fax
If this setting is changed, the copier must be cycled off and on.
SP5816 187 determines whether the off-hook button can be used to interrupt a RCGM transmission in progress to open the line for fax transaction.
173 Modem Serial Number
Retransmission Limit
Normally, it is best to allow unlimited time for certification and ID2 update requests, and
for the notification that the certification has been completed. However, RCG-M generates
174 charges based on transmission time for the customer, so a limit is placed upon the time
allowed for these transactions.
If these transactions cannot be completed within the allowed time, do this SP to cancel the
time restriction.
FAX TX Priority
This SP determines whether pushing the off-hook button will interrupt a RCG-M transmission
in progress to open the line for fax transaction. This SP can be used only if SP5816 164 is
187
set to "0".
[0 or 1/ 0 / - ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
200 Manual Polling
268
System SP5-xxx
Regist: Status
Displays a number that indicates the status of the @Remote service device.
0: Neither the registered device by the external nor embedded RCG device is set.
1: The embedded RCG device is being set. Only Box registration is completed. In this status,
this
unit cannot answer a polling request from the external RCG.
201
2. The embedded RCG device is set. In this status, the external RCG unit cannot answer a
polling request.
3. The registered device by the external RCG is being set. In this status the embedded RCG
device cannot be set.
Allows entry of the number of the request needed for the RCGN device.
269
Register Result
Displays a number that indicates the registration result.
0: Succeeded
2: Registration in progress
3: Proxy error (proxy enabled)
207 4: Proxy error (proxy disabled)
Code
Meaning
-11001
-11003
Unexpected error
-12002
-12003
-12005
270
System SP5-xxx
-12006
-12007
-12010
-2385
-2387
-2389
-2390
-2391
5821
Parameter error
Basil not managed
-2394
-2395
-2396
-2397
-2398
*CTL
271
Uploads the UP and SP mode data (except for counters and the serial number) from the
NVRAM to an SD card. For details, see the "NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the
"System Maintenance Reference" of the Field Service Manual.
001 NV-RAM Data Upload
Downloads the UP and SP mode data from an SD card to the NVRAM. For details, see the
"NVRAM Data Upload/Download" in the "System Maintenance Reference" of the Field
Service Manual.
001 NV-RAM Download
5828
[Network Setting]
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
Enables or disables ECP Compatibility.
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
This SP is activated only when SP5-828-50 is set
to "1".
Enables/disables Job Spooling.
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1 / step]
0: Disabled, 1: Enabled
272
System SP5-xxx
bit1: FTP
bit2: IPP
bit3: SMB
bit4: BMLinkS
bit5: DIPRINT
bit6: sftp
bit7: (Reserved)
Enables or disables the Telnet protocol.
090 TELNET (0: OFF 1: ON)
[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
Enables or disables the Web operation.
[0 or 1 / 1 / ]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
This is the IPv6 local address link referenced on the
Ethernet or wireless LAN (802.11b) in the format:
273
274
System SP5-xxx
Same as "-239"
Same as "-240"
Same as "-241"
5832
*CTL
3
-
[Capture Settings]
Capture Function (0:Off 1:On)
*CTL
0: Disable, 1: Enable
001 With this function disabled, the settings related to the capture feature cannot be initialized,
displayed, or selected.
002
Panel Setting
275
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
This SP is not used in this model.
276
System SP5-xxx
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
0: JFIF/JPEG, 1: TIFF/MMR,
2: TIFF/MH, 3: TIFF/MR
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step]
091 Sets the JPEG format default for documents sent to the document management server via
the MLB with JPEG selected as the format.
Enabled only when optional MLB (Media Link Board) is installed.
101 Primary srv IP address
113 Secondary srv port number This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
114 Secondary srv URL path
[0 to 3 / 2 / 1/step]
121 Selects the resolution for color copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Copy (Mono)
[0 to 5 / 3 / 1/step]
122 Selects the resolution for BW copy mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
277
Selects the resolution for color print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 300dpi/ 2: 150dpi/ 3: 75dpi
Reso: Print (Mono)
124
Selects the resolution for BW print mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi
Reso: Fax (Color)
125
Selects the resolution for color fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Selects the resolution for BW fax mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Color)
127 Selects the resolution for color scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
Reso: Scan (Mono)
128 Selects the resolution for BW scanning mode. This is basically adjusted by the remote
system.
0: 600dpi/ 1: 400dpi/ 2: 300dpi/ 3: 200dpi/ 4: 150dpi/ 5: 100dpi/ 6: 75dpi
141
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
0: Off, 1: On
Turns on or off the all address information transmission for the captured resources.
278
System SP5-xxx
142
5840
*CTL
Europe/Asia: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the maximum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
006 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the maximum end of the range for each area. Adjust the upper 4 bits to set the maximum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.
[1 to 11 or 13 / 1 / 1 /step]
Channel Min
*CTL
Europe: 1 to 13
NA/ Asia: 1 to 11
Sets the minimum number of channels available for data transmission via the wireless LAN.
007 The number of channels available varies according to location. The default settings are set
for the minimum end of the range for each area. Adjust the lower 4 bits to set the minimum
number of channels. DFU
Do not change the setting.
279
[0 x 00 to 0 x FF / 0 x FF to Auto / -]
0 x FF to Auto [Default]
0 x 11 55M Fix
0 x 10 48M Fix
0 x 0F 36M Fix
0 x 0E 18M Fix
0 x 0D 12M Fix
008 Transmission Speed
*CTL
0 x 0B 9M Fix
0 x 0A 6M Fix
0 x 07 11M Fix
0 x 05 5.5M Fix
0 x 08 1M Fix
0 x 13 0 x FE (reserved)
0 x 12 72M (reserved)
0 x 09 22M (reserved)
Selects the WEP key.
[00 to 11 / 00 / 1 binary]
*CTL
00: Key #1
01: Key #2 (Reserved)
10: Key #3 (Reserved)
11: Key #4 (Reserved)
Adjusts the fragment threshold for the IEEE802.11
card.
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 1 / 1 / 1] 0: Off, 1: On
This SP is displayed only when the IEEE802.11
card is installed.
280
*CTL
System SP5-xxx
*CTL
5841
007 OrgStamp
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
0: Date/Hour/Minute/Second
1: Minute/Second/Msec.
0 to 6: Not used
5844
[USB]
281
001
Transfer Rate
*CTL
002 Vendor ID
*CTL
003 Product ID
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
100
Notify Unsupport
[0 or 1 / 1 / -]
*CTL
0: Disable, 1: Enable
5845
*CTL
Sets the FTP port number used when image files to the Scan Router Server.
IP Address (Primary)
002 Use this SP to set the Scan Router Server address. The IP address under the transfer tab can
be referenced by the initial system setting.
Delivery Error Display Time
006 Use this setting to determine the length of time the prompt message is displayed when a
test error occurs during document transfer with the NetFile application and an external
device.
IP Address (Secondary)
008 Specifies the IP address assigned to the computer designated to function as the secondary
delivery server of Scan Router. This SP allows only the setting of the IP address without
reference to the DNS setting.
282
System SP5-xxx
[0 to 4/ 0 / 1 /step]
Allows changing the model of the delivery server registered by the I/O device.
0: Unknown
009 1: SG1 Provided
2: SG1 Package
3: SG2 Provided
4: SG2 Package
Delivery Svr Capability
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
Bit7 = 1 Comment information exits
Bit6 = 1 Direct specification of mail address possible
010
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
Changes the capability of the registered that the I/O device registered.
011
Bit7 = 1 Address book usage limitation (Limitation for each authorized user)
Bit6 = 1 RDH authorization link
Bit5 to 0: Not used
013
014
283
015
016
017
3
018
022
Enables or disables the prevention function for the continuous data sending error.
[0 to 1 / 0 / -]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
5846
[UCS Settings]
*CTL
Displays ID
001 Displays the unique device ID in use by the delivery server directory. The value is only
displayed and cannot be changed. This ID is created from the NIC MAC or IEEE 1394
EUI. The ID is displayed as either 6-byle or 8-byte binary.
Machine ID Clear (For Delivery Server)
Clears ID
002 Clears the unique ID of the device used as the name in the file transfer directory. Execute
this SP if the connection of the device to the delivery server is unstable. After clearing the
ID, the ID will be established again automatically by cycling the machine off and on.
Maximum Entries
003 Changes the maximum number of entries that UCS can handle.
If a value smaller than the present value is set, the UCS managed data is cleared, and the
data (excluding user code information) is displayed.
Delivery Server Retry Timer
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
006 Sets the interval for retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery
server address book.
284
System SP5-xxx
[0 to 255 / 0 / 1 /step]
007 Sets the number of retry attempts when the delivery server fails to acquire the delivery server
address book.
Delivery Server Maximum Entries
008
010
020
040
Sets the maximum number account entries of the delivery server user information managed
by UCS.
LDAP Search Timeout
[1 to 255 / 60 / 1 /step]
Sets the length of the timeout for the search of the LDAP server.
WSD Maximum Entries
Sets the maximum entries for the address book of the WSD (WS-scanner).
Addr Book Migration (USB => HDD)
Not used in this machine.
Fill Addr Acl Info.
This SP must be executed immediately after installation of an HDD unit in a basic machine
that previously had no HDD. The first time the machine is powered on with the new HDD
installed, the system automatically takes the address book from the NVRAM and writes it
onto the new HDD. However, the new address book on the HDD can be accessed only
by the system administrator at this stage. Executing this SP by the service technician
immediately after power on grants full address book access to all users.
041
Procedure
1. Turn the machine off.
2. Install the new HDD.
3. Turn the machine on.
4. The address book and its initial data are created on the HDD automatically.
5. However, at this point the address book can be accessed by only the system
administrator or key operator.
6. Enter the SP mode and do SP5846 041. After this SP executes successfully, any user
can access the address book.
285
1: SD Slot 1
2: SD Slot 2
4: USB Flash ROM
20: HDD
30: Nothing
047 Initialize Local Addr Book
048
286
System SP5-xxx
Search Option
This SP uses bit switches to set up the fuzzy search options for the UCS local address book.
Bit: Meaning
060
4 to 7: Not Used
Complexity Option 1
Use this SP to set the conditions for password entry to access the local address book.
Specifically, this SP limits the password entry to upper case and sets the length of the
password.
062 [0 to 32 / 0 / 1 /step]
This SP does not normally require adjustment.
This SP is enabled only after the system administrator has set up a group password
policy to control access to the address book.
063 Complexity Option 2 DFU
064 Complexity Option 3 DFU
065 Complexity Option 4 DFU
287
*CTL
5847 1 through 5847 8 changes the default settings of image data transferred externally
by the Net File page reference function.
5847
[0 to 5 / 2 / 1 /step]
5847 21 sets the default for JPEG image quality of image files handled by NetFile.
"Net files" are jobs to be printed from the document server using a PC and the
DeskTopBinder software.
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
0: 1x
1: 1/2x
2: 1/3x
3: 1/4x
4: 1/6x
5: 1/8x
288
System SP5-xxx
[Web Service]
*CTL
5848 2 sets the 4-bit switch assignment for the access control setting. Setting of 0001 has
no effect on access and delivery from Scan Router.
5848
5848 100 sets the maximum size allowed for downloaded images. The default is equal
to 1 gigabyte.
Access Ctrl: Repository (only
002
Lower 4 bits)
003
004
007
099
DFU
Specifies the max size of the image data that the
machine can download.
[1 to 1024 / 1024 / 1 MB /step]
289
NIA
[Installation Date]
5849 1 Display
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 1 / - ]
0: OFF (No Print)
1: ON (Print)
*CTL
Sets the operation mode for the Bluetooth Unit. Press either key.
[0:Public] [1: Private]
290
System SP5-xxx
5853
Allows the technician to upgrade the firmware using a local port (IEEE1284) when
updating the remote ROM.
[0 to 1 / 0 / 1/step]
002 Local Port
*CTL
0: Disable
1: Enable
5857
*CTL
0: OFF, 1: ON
001 Switches the debug log feature on and off. The debug log cannot be captured until this
feature is switched on.
Target (2: HDD 3: SD)
2: HDD, 3: SD Card
002 Selects the storage device to save debug logs information when the conditions set with
SP5-858 are satisfied.
[ 2 to 3 / 2 / 1 /step]
Save to HDD
005
006
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the HDD.
A unique file name is generated to avoid overwriting existing file names on the SD Card.
Up to 4MB can be copied to an SD Card. 4 MB segments can be copied one by one to
each SD Card.
Save to SD Card
Saves the debug log of the input SC number in memory to the SD card.
*CTL
These SPs select the content of the debugging information to be saved to the destination
selected by SP5857-002.
SP5858-3 stores one SC specified by number. Refer to Section 4 for a list of SC error codes.
[0 to 65535 / 0 / 1 /step]
Turns on/off the debug save for jam errors.
004 Jam
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/ step]
0: OFF, 1: ON
5859
292
*CTL
System SP5-xxx
001 Key 1
002 Key 2
003 Key 3
004 Key 4
005 Key 5
These SPs allow you to set up to 10 keys for log files for
functions that use common memory on the controller board.
006 Key 6
[9999999 to 9999999 / 0 / ]
007 Key 7
008 Key 8
009 Key 9
010 Key 10
5860
[SMTP/POP3/IMAP4]
*CTL
[1 to 168 / 72 / hour/step]
Sets the amount of time to wait before saving a mail that breaks up during reception. The
received mail is discarded if the remaining portion of the mail is not received during this
prescribed time.
021 MDN Response RFC2298 Compliance
[0 to 1 / 1 / ]
[0 to 1 / 0 / ]
Determines whether the FROM item of the mail header is switched to the validated account
after the SMTP server is validated.
0: No. "From" item not switched.
1: Yes. "From item switched.
025 SMTP Auth. Direct Setting
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
293
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1]
0: Microsoft Outlook Express standard
1: Internet Draft standard
2: RFC standard
5866
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
0: Enable, 1: Disable
*CTL
5870
001 Writing
*CTL
003 Initializing
*CTL
5873
294
System SP5-xxx
5875
*CTL
*CTL
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Manual reboot, 1: Automatic reboot
5878
[Option Setup]
5881
001 -
5883
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1 /step]
001 Middle Thick
5885
Bit Meaning
0: Forbid all document server access (1)
1: Forbid user mode access (1)
020 Document Server ACC Ctrl
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Setting for each e-mail
1: Signature for all
2: No signature
296
System SP5-xxx
*CTL
5887
001 -
*CTL
5888
001 -
*CTL
5893
*CTL
001
SDK-1
002
SDK-2
003
SDK-3
004
SDK-4
297
005
SDK-5
006
SDK-6
5894
[Test Name1]
-
*ENG
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1/step]
[Application Invalidation]
5895
001
Printer
*CTL
002
Scanner
*CTL
5907
[0 or 1 / 0 / -]
0: Enable
1: Disable
Selects the brand name and the production name for Windows Plug & Play. This information
is stored in the NVRAM. If the NVRAM is defective, these names should be registered again.
After selecting, press the "Original Type" key and "#" key at the same time. When the setting
is completed, the beeper sounds five times.
5913
*CTL
[3 to 30 / 3 / 1 second /step]
002 Sets the amount of time to elapse while the machine is in standby mode (and the operation
panel keys have not been used) before another application can gain control of the display.
5967
*CTL
0: ON, 1: OFF
Enables and disables the document server. This is a security measure that prevents image
data from being left in the temporary area of the HDD. After changing this setting, you must
switch the main switch off and on to enable the new setting.
298
System SP5-xxx
5974
[Cherry Server]
Specifies which version of ScanRouter, "Lite" or "Full", is installed.
[0 or 1 / 0 / ]
*CTL
0: Lite
1: Full
[Device Setting]
5985
The NIC and USB support features are built into the GW controller. Use this SP to enable
and disable these features. In order to use the NIC and USB functions built into the controller
board, these SP codes must be set to "1".
[0 to 2 / 0 / 1 /step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable, 2: Function limitation
When the "Function limitation" is set, "On board NIC" is limited only
for the NRS or LDAP/NT authentication.
001 On Board NIC
Other network applications than NRS or LDAP/NT
authentication are not available when this SP is set to "2". Even
though you can change the initial settings of those network
applications, the settings do not work.
002 On Board USB
5987
[0 or 1 / 0 / 1/step]
0: Disable, 1: Enable
[Mech. Counter]
001 0: OFF / 1: ON
5990
299
006 Non-Default
022 Scanner SP
5998
001 fast/silent
*ENG
300
System SP6-xxx
System SP6-xxx
SP6-XXX (Peripherals)
6006
Side-to-Side Registration
(2nd side)
*ENG
Adjusts the amount of paper buckle to correct original skew for the front and rear sides.
005 Buckle: Duplex Front
006 Buckle: Duplex Rear
*ENG
*ENG
Displays the signals received from the sensors and switches of the ARDF. Only Bit 0 is used
for ADF input check ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[ADF Output Check]
6008
6009
p.392 "Input
301
6010
*ENG
6011
6012
Specifies the original size for a size detected by the original sensor, since original sensors
cannot recognize all sizes.
*ENG
NA
EU/
ASIA
6017
0: Setting 1, 1: Setting 2
Setting 1
Setting 2
DLT SEF
LG SEF
Foolscap SEF
LT SEF
LT LEF
US EXE LEF
DLT SEF
8K 267 x 390 mm
LT SEF
LT LEF
302
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
*CTL
System SP6-xxx
6020
001 -
*ENG
6128
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
6129
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
6130
303
001 A3T
*ENG
002 B4T
*ENG
003 A4T
*ENG
004 A4Y
*ENG
005 B5T
*ENG
006 B5Y
*ENG
007 DLT-T
*ENG
008 LG-T
*ENG
009 LT-T
*ENG
010 LT-Y
*ENG
*ENG
012 Other
*ENG
6131
304
System SP6-xxx
001 A3T
*ENG
002 B4T
*ENG
003 A4T
*ENG
004 A4Y
*ENG
005 B5T
*ENG
006 B5Y
*ENG
007 DLT-T
*ENG
008 LG-T
*ENG
009 LT-T
*ENG
010 LT-Y
*ENG
*ENG
012 Other
*ENG
[0 or 1 / 1 / 1/step]]
0: No (No skew correction)
This SP adjusts the distance between the jogger fences and the sides of the stack on the
finisher stapling tray in the Booklet Finisher B793. The adjustment is done perpendicular to
the direction of paper feed.
305
001 A3T
*ENG
002 B4T
*ENG
003 A4T
*ENG
004 A4Y
*ENG
005 B5T
*ENG
006 B5Y
*ENG
007 DLT-T
*ENG
008 LG-T
*ENG
009 LT-T
*ENG
010 LT-Y
*ENG
*ENG
012 Other
*ENG
306
*ENG
6134
User SP
Use this SP to adjust the stapling position of the booklet stapler when paper is stapled and
folded in the Booklet Finisher B793.
System SP6-xxx
001 A3T
002 B4T
003 A4T
004 B5T
005 DLT-T
006 LG-T
007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"
009 Other
6135
User SP
This SP corrects the folding position when paper is stapled and folded in the Booklet Finisher
B793.
001 A3T
002 B4T
003 A4T
004 B5T
005 DLT-T
006 LG-T
007 LT-T
008 12" x 18"
009 Other
6136
[Folding Number]
User SP
Sets the number of times that folding is done in the Booklet Finisher B793.
001 -
[2 to 30 / 2 / 1 time/step]
307
6137
3
6138
DFU
6139
6140
6141
6143
308
p.392
p.392
6145
p.392
6144
p.392
p.392
System SP6-xxx
6146
6149
*ENG
001 -
[0 to 3 / 3 / 1 sheet/step]
[INPUT Check]
6150
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[OUTPUT Check]
6151
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the bridge unit (D386)/ side tray
(D542) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[INPUT Check]
6152
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[OUTPUT Check]
6153
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the shift tray (D388) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[INPUT Check]
6154
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D536) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").
309
[OUTPUT Check]
6155
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the 1 bin tray (D414) (
p.392 "Input and Output Check").
6157
[OUTPUT Check]
Not used in this machine
[INPUT Check]
6160
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
[OUTPUT Check]
6161
Displays the signals received from sensors and switches of the two-tray paper feed unit
(D537), LCT 2000 (D538) and LCT 1200 (D539) ( p.392 "Input and Output Check").
6801
6830
6900
001 A3T
*ENG
310
System SP7-xxx
System SP7-xxx
SP7-XXX (Data Log)
7401
[Total SC Counter]
Displays the number of SC codes detected.
001 SC Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1/step ]
[SC History]
7403
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
006 Latest 5
*CTL
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
[SC991 History]
7404
311
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
006 Latest 5
*CTL
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
7502
7503
* CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 original/step ]
312
System SP7-xxx
001 At Power On
*CTL
003 Tray 1: ON
*CTL
004 Tray 2: ON
*CTL
005 Tray 3: ON
*CTL
006 Tray 4: ON
*CTL
007 LCT : ON
*CTL
008 Bypass: ON
*CTL
009 Duplex: ON
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
017 Registration: ON
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
313
314
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
System SP7-xxx
7505
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
001 At Power On
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
315
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
7506
316
Not used
Not used
System SP7-xxx
005 A4 LEF
006 A5 LEF
014 B5 LEF
038 LT LEF
044 HLT LEF
132 A3 SEF
133 A4 SEF
134 A5 SEF
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step ]
141 B4 SEF
142 B5 SEF
160 DLT SEF
164 LG SEF
166 LT SEF
172 HLT SEF
255 Others
7507
317
001 Latest
002 Latest 1
003 Latest 2
004 Latest 3
005 Latest 4
006 Latest 5
*CTL
007 Latest 6
008 Latest 7
009 Latest 8
010 Latest 9
7508
001 Latest
002 Latest-1
003 Latest-2
004 Latest-3
005 Latest-4
006 Latest-5
*CTL
007 Latest-6
008 Latest-7
009 Latest-8
010 Latest-9
7624
318
System SP7-xxx
001
Drum Unit: Bk
002
Drum Unit: M
003
Drum Unit: C
004
Drum Unit: Y
005
Development Unit: Bk
006
Development Unit: M
007
Development Unit: C
008
Development Unit: Y
009
Developer: Bk
010
Developer: M
011
Developer: C
012
Developer: Y
013
014
015
Fusing Unit
016
017
018
Fusing Roller
019
Pressure Roller
7801
7803
[0 or 1 / 1 -]
0: No (Not PM maintenance)
[0 or 1 / 1 -]
0: Not PM maintenance
1: PM maintenance
*CTL
319
Displays the number of sheets printed for each current maintenance unit.
PM counters click up based on the number of A4 (LT) LEF size sheets printed. Therefore,
the A3 (DLT) Double Count is activated. The Double Count cannot be deactivated.
When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-1 to 10) and is reset to 0.
320
The total number of sheets printed with the last unit replaced can be checked with
SP7-906-1 to 10.
NOTE: The LCT is counted as the 3rd feed station.
001 Paper
*CTL
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP7-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Displays the number of revolutions of motors or clutches for each current maintenance unit.
[ 0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1 revolution/step ]
When a unit is replaced, the machine automatically detects that the new unit is installed.
Then, the current PM counter value is automatically moved to the PM Counter - Previous
(SP7-906-11 to 20) and is reset to 0. The total number of revolutions made with the last
unit replaced can be checked with SP7-906-11 to 20.
031 Rotation: PCU: Bk
032 Rotation: PCU: M
033 Rotation: PCU: C
034 Rotation: PCU: Y
035 Rotation: Development Unit: Bk
036 Rotation: Development Unit: M
037 Rotation: Development Unit: C
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
321
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mg/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
322
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
System SP7-xxx
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
323
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
7804
324
System SP7-xxx
012 Developer: Bk
013 Developer: M
014 Developer: C
015 Developer: Y
016 Developer: All
017 Image Transfer Belt
018 Cleaning Unit
7807
7832
*CTL
325
7835
*CTL
*CTL
7836
7852
Counts the number of occurrences (0 to 65,535) when dust was detected on the scanning
glass of the ADF or resets the dust detection counter. Counting is done only if SP4-020-1
(ADF Scan Glass Dust Check) is switched on.
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]
*CTL
[0 to 9999 / - / 1 /step]
7853
326
[ACC Counter]
[Replacement Counter]
Displays the PM parts replacement number.
System SP7-xxx
001 PCU: Bk
*CTL
002 PCU: M
*CTL
003 PCU: C
*CTL
004 PCU: Y
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
009 Developer: Bk
*CTL
010 Developer: M
*CTL
011 Developer: C
*CTL
012 Developer: Y
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]
[0 to 255 / - / 1 /step]
327
[Coverage Range]
Sets the color coverage threshold.
Coverage rate = Coverage per page / A4 full coverage (dots) x 100
There are three coverage counters: Color 1, Color 2, and Color 3
[A] 5% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-001.
[B] 20% (default) is adjustable with SP7855-002.
7855
*CTL
[1 to 200 / 5 /1]
*CTL
[1 to 200 / 20 /1]
Records the location where a problem is detected in the program. The data stored in this
SP is used for problem analysis.
001 File Name
002 Number of Lines
*CTL
003 Location
[Prev. Unit PM Counter]
7906
328
*CTL
System SP7-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
Displays the number of revolutions for motors or clutches in the previous maintenance units.
329
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mg/step ]
*ENG
[0 to 999999999 / - / 1 mm/step ]
Displays the number of sheets printed with the previous maintenance unit or toner cartridge.
330
System SP7-xxx
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
331
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
*ENG
[0 to 255 / - / 1 %/step]
7931
332
*ENG
*ENG
003 Brand ID
*ENG
004 Area ID
*ENG
005 Product ID
*ENG
System SP7-xxx
7932
006 Color ID
*ENG
007 Maintenance ID
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
010 Date
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[Toner Bottle M]
Displays the toner bottle information for M.
001 Machine Serial ID
*ENG
*ENG
003 Brand ID
*ENG
004 Area ID
*ENG
005 Product ID
*ENG
006 Color ID
*ENG
007 Maintenance ID
*ENG
333
7933
334
*ENG
*ENG
010 Date
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[Toner Bottle C]
Displays the toner bottle information for C.
001 Machine Serial ID
*ENG
*ENG
003 Brand ID
*ENG
004 Area ID
*ENG
005 Product ID
*ENG
006 Color ID
*ENG
007 Maintenance ID
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
System SP7-xxx
7934
010 Date
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
[Toner Bottle Y]
Displays the toner bottle information for Y.
001 Machine Serial ID
*ENG
*ENG
003 Brand ID
*ENG
004 Area ID
*ENG
005 Product ID
*ENG
006 Color ID
*ENG
007 Maintenance ID
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
010 Date
*ENG
*ENG
335
7935
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
336
System SP7-xxx
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
337
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
338
System SP7-xxx
7938
*ENG
3
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
*ENG
339
*ENG
*ENG
7951
340
System SP7-xxx
341
7952
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
004
021
022
023
024
Day Threshold:
025
Development Unit: Bk
342
026
Day Threshold:
Development Unit: M
027
Day Threshold:
Development Unit: C
028
Day Threshold:
Development Unit: Y
*CTL
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.
System SP7-xxx
029
030
031
032
033
034
*CTL
Adjusts the threshold day for the near end fro each
PM unit.
[1 to 30 / 15 / 1 day/step]
These threshold days are used for @Remote alarms.
038
039
042
Rotation: Development
Unit: Bk
043
Rotation: Development
Unit: M
Rotation: Development
044
Unit: C
045
*CTL
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*CTL
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
Rotation: Development
Unit: Y
343
*CTL
[0 to 999999999 / 0 / 1 mm/step]
*CTL
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
*CTL
[0 to 999999 / 0 / 1 sheet/step]
344
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 99999999 / - / 1 mm/step]
System SP7-xxx
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
*CTL
7954
7955
345
System SP8-xxx
SP8-xxx: Data Log2
Many of these counters are provided for features that are currently not available, such as sending color
faxes, and so on. However, here are some Group 8 codes that when used in combination with others, can
provide useful information.
SP Numbers
What They Do
346
What it means
T:
C:
Copy application.
F:
Fax application.
P:
Print application.
S:
Scan application.
System SP8-xxx
L:
O:
Other applications
(external network
applications, for
example)
The Group 8 SP codes are limited to 17 characters, forced by the necessity of displaying them on the small
LCDs of printers and faxes that also use these SPs. Read over the list of abbreviations below and refer to it
again if you see the name of an SP that you do not understand.
Key for Abbreviations
Abbreviation
What it means
>
AddBook
Address Book
Apl
Application
B/W
Bk
Black
Cyan
ColCr
Color Create
ColMode
Color Mode
Comb
Combine
Comp
Compression
Deliv
Delivery
347
Abbreviation
348
What it means
DesApl
Dev Counter
Dup, Duplex
Emul
Emulation
FC
Full Color
FIN
Full Bleed
No Margins
GenCopy
GPC
Get Print Counter. For jobs 10 pages or less, this counter does not count
up. For jobs larger than 10 pages, this counter counts up by the number
that is in excess of 10 (e.g., for an 11-page job, the counter counts up
11-10 =1)
IFax
Internet Fax
ImgEdt
Image Edit performed on the original with the copier GUI, e.g. border
removal, adding stamps, page numbers, etc.
Black (YMCK)
LS
LSize
Mag
Magnification
MC
NRS
Org
OrgJam
Original Jam
Palm 2
Print Job Manager/Desk Top Editor: A pair of utilities that allows print jobs
to be distributed evenly among the printers on the network, and allows files
to moved around, combined, and converted to different formats.
System SP8-xxx
Abbreviation
What it means
PC
Personal Computer
PGS
Pages. A page is the total scanned surface of the original. Duplex pages
count as two pages, and A3 simplex count as two pages if the A3/DLT
counter SP is switched ON.
PJob
Print Jobs
Ppr
Paper
PrtJam
PrtPGS
Print Pages
Red (Toner Remaining). Applies to the wide format model A2 only. This
machine is under development and currently not available.
Rez
Resolution
SC
Scn
Scan
Sim, Simplex
S-to-Email
Scan-to-E-mail
SMC
SMC report printed with SP5990. All of the Group 8 counters are recorded
in the SMC report.
Svr
Server
TonEnd
Toner End
TonSave
Toner Save
TXJob
Send, Transmission
YMC
YMCK
All of the Group 8 SPs are reset with SP5 801 1 Memory All Clear.
349
T:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 002
C:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 003
F:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 004
P:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 005
S:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 006
L:Total Jobs
*CTL
8 001
These SPs reveal the number of times an application is used, not the number of pages processed.
When an application is opened for image input or output, this counts as one job.
Interrupted jobs (paper jams, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
Only jobs executed by the customer are counted. Jobs executed by the customer engineer using the
SP modes are not counted.
When using secure printing (when a password is required to start the print job), the job is counted at
the time when either "Delete Data" or "Specify Output" is specified.
A job is counted as a fax job when the job is stored for sending.
When a fax is received to fax memory, the F: counter increments but the L: counter does not (the
document server is not used).
A fax broadcast counts as one job for the F: counter (the fax destinations in the broadcast are not
counted separately).
A fax broadcast is counted only after all the faxes have been sent to their destinations. If one
transmission generates an error, then the broadcast will not be counted until the transmission has been
completed.
A printed fax report counts as one job for the F: counter.
The F: counter does not distinguish between fax sending or receiving.
When a copy job on the document server is printed, SP8022 also increments, and when a print job
stored on the document server is printed, SP8024 also increments.
When an original is both copied and stored on the document server, the C: and L: counters both
increment.
When a print job is stored on the document server, only the L: counter increments.
When the user presses the Document Server button to store the job on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.
When the user enters document server mode and prints data stored on the document server, only the
L: counter increments.
350
System SP8-xxx
When an image received from Palm 2 is received and stored, the L: counter increments.
When the customer prints a report (user code list, for example), the O: counter increments. However,
for fax reports and reports executed from the fax application, the F: counter increments.
8 011
T:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 012
C:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 013
F:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 014
P:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 015
S:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 016
L:Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 017
O:Jobs/LS
*CTL
When a scan job is sent to the document server, the S: counter increments. When you enter document
server mode and then scan an original, the L: counter increments.
When a print job is sent to the document server, the P: counter increments.
When a network application sends data to the document server, the O: counter increments.
When an image from Palm 2 is stored on the document server, the O: counter increments.
When a fax is sent to the document server, the F: counter increments.
8 021
T:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 022
C:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 023
F:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 024
P:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 025
S:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 026
L:Pjob/LS
*CTL
8 027
O:Pjob/LS
*CTL
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the C: counter
increments.
When an application like DeskTopBinder merges a copy job that was stored on the document server
with a print job that was stored on the document server, the C: and P: counters both increment.
When a job already on the document server is printed with another application, the L: counter
increments.
351
When a scanner job stored on the document server is printed with another application, the S: counter
increments. If the original was scanned from within document server mode, then the L: counter
increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application (including Palm 2), are printed
with another application, the O: counter increments.
When a copy job stored on the document server is printed with a network application (Web Image
Monitor, for example), the C: counter increments.
When a fax on the document server is printed, the F: counter increments.
8 031
T:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 032
C:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 033
F:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 034
P:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 035
S:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 036
L:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
8 037
O:Pjob/DesApl
*CTL
When documents already stored on the document server are printed, the count for the application
that started the print job is incremented.
When the print job is started from a network application (Desk Top Binder, Web Image Monitor, etc.)
the L: counter increments.
8 041
T:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 042
C:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 043
F:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 044
P:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 045
S:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 046
L:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
8 047
O:TX Jobs/LS
*CTL
When a stored copy job is sent from the document server, the C: counter increments.
When images stored on the document server by a network application or Palm2 are sent as an email, the O: counter increments.
352
System SP8-xxx
8 051
T:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 052
C:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 053
F:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 054
P:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 055
S:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 056
L:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
8 057
O:TX Jobs/DesApl
*CTL
If the send is started from Desk Top Binder or Web Image Monitor, for example, then the O: counter
increments.
T:FIN Jobs
8 061
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for copy jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
F:FIN Jobs
8 063
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total the finishing methods. The finishing method is specified by the
application.
C:FIN Jobs
8 062
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for fax jobs only. The finishing method is specified by
the application.
Note: Finishing features for fax jobs are not available at this time.
P:FIN Jobs
8 064
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for print jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
S:FIN Jobs
8 065
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for scan jobs only. The finishing method is specified
by the application.
Note: Finishing features for scan jobs are not available at this time.
353
L:FIN Jobs
8 066
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs executed by an external application, over the
network. The finishing method is specified by the application.
8 06x 1 Sort
Number of jobs started in Sort mode. When a stored copy job is set for
Sort and then stored on the document server, the L: counter increments.
(See SP8 066 1)
8 06x 2 Stack
8 06x 3 Staple
8 06x 4 Booklet
8 06x 5 Z-Fold
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Z-fold).
8 06x 6 Punch
Number of jobs started in Punch mode. When Punch is set for a print job,
the P: counter increments. (See SP8 064 6.)
8 06x 7 Other
8 06x 8
8 06x 9
8 06x 10
InsideFold
ThreeIN-Fold
ThreeOUT-Fold
T:Jobs/PGS
8 071
354
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs total finishing methods for jobs output from within the document server mode
screen at the operation panel. The finishing method is specified from the print window
within document server mode.
O:FIN Jobs
8 067
*CTL
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Inside-fold).
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Inside-IN-fold).
Number of jobs started In any mode other than the Booklet mode and set
for folding (Inside-OUT-fold).
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs broken down by the number of pages in the job,
regardless of which application was used.
System SP8-xxx
C:Jobs/PGS
8 072
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of jobs printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel, by the number of pages in the job.
O:Jobs/PGS
8 077
These SPs count and calculate the number of scan jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
L:Jobs/PGS
8 076
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of print jobs by size based on the number of
pages in the job.
S:Jobs/PGS
8 075
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of fax jobs by size based on the number of
pages in the job.
P:Jobs/PGS
8 074
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of copy jobs by size based on the number
of pages in the job.
F:Jobs/PGS
8 073
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count and calculate the number of "Other" application jobs (Web Image
Monitor, Palm 2, etc.) by size based on the number of pages in the job.
8 07x 1 1 Page
8 07x 8
21 to 50 Pages
8 07x 2 2 Pages
8 07x 9
51 to 100 Pages
8 07x 3 3 Pages
8 07x 10
8 07x 4 4 Pages
8 07x 11
8 07x 5 5 Pages
8 07x 12
8 07x 6 6 to 10 Pages
8 07x 13
8 07x 7 11 to 20 Pages
8 07x 14
1001 to Pages
For example: When a copy job stored on the document server is printed in document server mode,
the appropriate L: counter (SP8076 0xx) increments.
Printing a fax report counts as a job and increments the F: counter (SP 8073).
Interrupted jobs (paper jam, etc.) are counted, even though they do not finish.
355
When printing the first page of a job from within the document server screen, the page is counted.
T:FAX TX Jobs
8 111
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax, either
directly or using a file stored on the document server, on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
F: FAX TX Jobs
8 113
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent by fax directly
on a telephone line.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 11x 1 B/W
8 11x 2 Color
These counters count jobs, not pages.
This SP counts fax jobs sent over a telephone line with a fax application, including documents stored
on the document server.
If the mode is changed during the job, the job will count with the mode set when the job started.
If the same document is faxed to both a public fax line and an I-Fax at a destination where both are
available, then this counter increments, and the I-Fax counter (8 12x) also increments.
The fax job is counted when the job is scanned for sending, not when the job is sent.
T:IFAX TX Jobs
8 121
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent, either directly
or using a file stored on the document server, as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
356
System SP8-xxx
F: IFAX TX Jobs
8 123
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) sent (not stored on the
document server), as fax images using I-Fax.
Note: Color fax sending is not available at this time.
8 12x 1 B/W
8 12x 2 Color
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and
attached to an e-mail, regardless of whether the document server was used or not.
S: S-to-Email Jobs
8 135
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and attached
to e-mail, without storing the original on the document server.
8 13x 1 B/W
8 13x 2 Color
8 13x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
If the job is stored on the document server, after the job is stored it is determined to be color or blackand-white then counted.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
sent, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
If several jobs are combined for sending to the Scan Router, Scan-to-Email, or Scan-to-PC, or if one
job is sent to more than one destination. each send is counted separately. For example, if the same
document is sent by Scan-to-Email as well as Scan-to-PC, then it is counted twice (once for Scan-toEmail and once for Scan-to-PC).
357
T:Deliv Jobs/Svr
8 141
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a Scan Router server.
S: Deliv Jobs/Svr
8 145
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned in scanner mode
and sent to a Scan Router server.
8 14x 1 B/W
8 14x 2 Color
8 14x 3 ACS
These counters count jobs, not pages.
The jobs are counted even though the arrival and reception of the jobs at the Scan Router server
cannot be confirmed.
If even one color image is mixed with black-and-white images, then the job is counted as a "Color"
job.
If the job is cancelled during scanning, or if the job is cancelled while the document is waiting to be
delivered, the job is not counted.
If the job is cancelled during sending, it may or may not be counted, depending on what stage of the
process had been reached when the job was cancelled.
Even if several files are combined for sending, the transmission counts as one job.
T:Deliv Jobs/PC
8 151
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
to a folder on a PC (Scan-to-PC).
Note: At the present time, 8 151 and 8 155 perform identical counts.
S:Deliv Jobs/PC
8 155
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of jobs (color or black-and-white) scanned and sent
with Scan-to-PC.
8 15x 1 B/W
8 15x 2 Color
8 15x 3 ACS
358
*CTL
System SP8-xxx
T:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
8 163
F:PCFAX TX Jobs
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
T:Deliv Jobs/WSD
*CTL
8 175
S:Deliv Jobs/WSD
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
-001 B/W
-002 Color
-003 ACS
8 181
*CTL
8 185
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
-001 B/W
-002 Color
-003 ACS
359
8 191
*CTL
8 192
*CTL
8 193
*CTL
8 195
*CTL
8 196
*CTL
SP 8 191 to 8 196 count the number of scanned sides of pages, not the number of physical pages.
These counters do not count reading user stamp data, or reading color charts to adjust color.
Previews done with a scanner driver are not counted.
A count is done only after all images of a job have been scanned.
Scans made in SP mode are not counted.
Examples
If 3 B5 pages and 1 A3 page are scanned with the scanner application but not stored, the S: count
is 4.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server using the Store File button
in the Copy mode window, the C: count is 6 and the L: count is 6.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied but not stored, the C: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
T:LSize Scan PGS
8 201
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan and
copy jobs. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
F: LSize Scan PGS
8 203
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for fax
transmission.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
S:LSize Scan PGS
8 205
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of large pages input with the scanner for scan jobs
only. Large size paper (A3/DLT) scanned for fax transmission are not counted.
Note: These counters are displayed in the SMC Report, and in the User Tools display.
360
System SP8-xxx
8 211
T:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 212
C:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 213
F:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 215
S:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
8 216
L:Scan PGS/LS
*CTL
If the scanner application scans and stores 3 B5 sheets and 1 A4 sheet, the S: count is 4.
If pages are copied but not stored on the document server, these counters do not change.
If both sides of 3 A4 sheets are copied and stored to the document server, the C: count is 6 and the
L: count is 6.
If you enter document server mode then scan 6 pages, the L: count is 6.
ADF Org Feeds
8 221
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages fed through the ADF for front and back side
scanning.
Number of front sides fed for scanning:
8 221 1
Front
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count is
the same as the number of pages fed for either simplex or duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Front side count
is the same as the number of pages fed for duplex front side scanning. (The
front side is determined by which side the user loads face up.)
Number of rear sides fed for scanning:
8 221 2
Back
With an ADF that can scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is the
same as the number of pages fed for duplex scanning.
With an ADF that cannot scan both sides simultaneously, the Back count is
the same as the number of pages fed for duplex rear-side scanning.
When 1 sheet is fed for duplex scanning the Front count is 1 and the Back count is 1.
If a jam occurs during the job, recovery processing is not counted to avoid double counting. Also, the
pages are not counted if the jam occurs before the first sheet is output.
361
Scan PGS/Mode
8 231
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each ADF mode to determine the
work load on the ADF.
8 231 2 SADF
8 231 5 Platen
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
The user cannot select mixed sizes or non-standard sizes with the fax application so if the original's
page sizes are mixed or non-standard, these are not counted.
If the user selects "Mixed Sizes" for copying in the platen mode, the Mixed Size count is enabled.
In the SADF mode if the user copies 1 page in platen mode and then copies 2 pages with SADF, the
Platen count is 1 and the SADF count is 3.
T:Scan PGS/Org
8 241
8 242
8 243
8 245
362
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of scanned pages by original type for all jobs,
regardless of which application was used.
C:Scan PGS/Org
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Copy jobs.
F:Scan PGS/Org
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Fax jobs.
S:Scan PGS/Org
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by original type for Scan jobs.
System SP8-xxx
L:Scan PGS/Org
8 246
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned and stored from within the document
server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button from within
the Copy mode screen
8 241
8 242
8 243
8 245
8 246
8 24x 1: Text
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 24x 2: Text/Photo
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
8 24x 3: Photo
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
8 24x 5: Map
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
8 24x 6: Normal/Detail
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
8 24x 8: Binary
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
8 24x 9: Grayscale
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
No
No
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
If the scan mode is changed during the job, for example, if the user switches from ADF to Platen mode,
the count is done for the last selected mode.
363
8 251
T:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 252
C:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 255
S:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
8 256
L:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
Centering
8 257
O:Scan PGS/ImgEdt
*CTL
Positive/Negative
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: The count totals the number of times the edit
features have been used. A detailed breakdown of
exactly which features have been used is not given.
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from within the Copy mode screen.
8 261
T:Scan PGS/ColCr
*CTL
8 262
*CTL
8 265
S:Scn PGS/Color
*CTL
8 266
L:Scn PGS/ColCr
*CTL
8 26x 3 Background
8 26x 4 Other
364
8 281
T:Scan PGS/TWAIN
*CTL
8 285
S:Scan PGS/TWAIN
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Note: At the present time, these counters perform
identical counts.
System SP8-xxx
8 291
T:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
8 293
F:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
8 295
S:Scan PGS/Stamp
*CTL
T:Scan PGS/Size
8 301
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Scan application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP
8-445].
L:Scan PGS/Size
8 306
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Fax application. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output page size [SP 8-443].
S:Scan PGS/Size
8 305
*CTL
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by the Copy application.
Use these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page
size [SP 8-442].
F:Scan PGS/Size
8 303
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
The L: counter counts the number of pages stored from
within the document server mode screen at the
operation panel, and with the Store File button from
within the Copy mode screen
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned by all applications. Use
these totals to compare original page size (scanning) and output (printing) page size
[SP 8-441].
C:Scan PGS/Size
8 302
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by size the total number of pages scanned and stored from within the
document server mode screen at the operation panel, and with the Store File button
from within the Copy mode screen. Use these totals to compare original page size
(scanning) and output page size [SP 8-446].
365
8 30x 1 A3
8 30x 2 A4
8 30x 3 A5
8 30x 4 B4
8 30x 5 B5
8 30x 6 DLT
8 30x 7 LG
8 30x 8 LT
8 30x 9 HLT
8 30x 10 Full Bleed
8 30x 254 Other (Standard)
8 30x 255 Other (Custom)
T:Scan PGS/Rez
8 311
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
S: Scan PGS/Rez
8 315
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by resolution setting the total number of pages scanned by applications
that can specify resolution settings.
Note: At the present time, SP8-311 and SP8-315 perform identical counts.
8 31x 1
1200dpi <
8 31x 2
600dpi to 1199dpi
8 31x 3
400dpi to 599dpi
8 31x 4
200dpi to 399dpi
8 31x 5
< 199dpi
System SP8-xxx
8 381
T:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 382
C:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 383
F:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 384
P:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 385
S:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 386
L:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
8 387
O:Total PrtPGS
*CTL
When the A3/DLT double count function is switched on with SP5104, 1 A3/DLT page is counted as
2.
When several documents are merged for a print job, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
These counters are used primarily to calculate charges on use of the machine, so the following pages
are not counted as printed pages:
- Blank pages in a duplex printing job.
- Blank pages inserted as document covers, chapter title sheets, and slip sheets.
- Reports printed to confirm counts.
- All reports done in the service mode (service summaries, engine maintenance reports, etc.)
- Test prints for machine image adjustment.
- Error notification reports.
- Partially printed pages as the result of a copier jam.
LSize PrtPGS
8 391
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count pages printed on paper sizes A3/DLT and larger.
Note: In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are also
displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
367
8 401
T:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 402
C:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 403
F:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 404
P:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 405
S:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
8 406
L:PrtPGS/LS
*CTL
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the L: count.
Fax jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the F: count.
8 411
Prints/Duplex
*CTL
T:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 421
368
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the printer application.
S:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 425
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 424
*CTL
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the copier application.
F:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 423
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing. This is the total for all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 422
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by the scanner application.
System SP8-xxx
L:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing from within the document server mode window at the operation
panel.
8 426
O:PrtPGS/Dup Comb
8 427
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by binding and combine, and n-Up settings the number of pages
processed for printing by Other applications
8 42x 7 4>
8 42x 8 6>
8 42x 9 8>
8 42x 10 9>
8 42x 11 16>
8 42x 12 Booklet
8 42x 13 Magazine
These counts (SP8 421 to SP8 427) are especially useful for customers who need to improve their
compliance with ISO standards for the reduction of paper consumption.
Pages that are only partially printed with the n-Up functions are counted as 1 page.
Here is a summary of how the counters work for Booklet and Magazine modes:
Booklet
Magazine
Original Pages
Count
Original Pages
Count
369
T:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 431
370
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output from within the document server mode
window at the operation panel with the three features below.
O:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 437
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
print application.
L:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 436
*CTL
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with the
copy application.
P:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 434
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below,
regardless of which application was used.
C:PrtPGS/ImgEdt
8 432
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total number of pages output with the three features below with
Other applications.
8 43x 2 Series/Book
System SP8-xxx
8 441
T:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 443
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 447
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the printer
application.
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 446
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the fax application.
S:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 445
*CTL
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by the copy
application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 444
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
8 442
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
O:PrtPGS/Ppr Size
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by print paper size the number of pages printed by Other applications.
371
8 44x 1 A3
8 44x 2 A4
8 44x 3 A5
8 44x 4 B4
8 44x 5 B5
8 44x 6 DLT
8 44x 7 LG
8 44x 8 LT
8 44x 9 HLT
8 44x 10 Full Bleed
8 44x 254 Other (Standard)
8 44x 255 Other (Custom)
These counters do not distinguish between LEF and SEF.
8 451
372
PrtPGS/Ppr Tray
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of sheets fed from each paper feed station.
8 451 1 Bypass
Bypass Tray
8 451 2 Tray 1
Copier
8 451 3 Tray 2
Copier
8 451 4 Tray 3
8 451 5 Tray 4
8 451 6 Tray 5
LCT (Option)
8 451 7 Tray 6
8 451 8 Tray 7
8 451 9 Tray 8
8 451 10 Tray 9
System SP8-xxx
T:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by all applications.
8 461
These counters are not the same as the PM counter. The PM counter is based on
feed timing to accurately measure the service life of the feed rollers. However,
these counts are based on output timing.
Blank sheets (covers, chapter covers, slip sheets) are also counted.
During duplex printing, pages printed on both sides count as 1, and a page printed
on one side counts as 1.
8 462
8 463
8 464
C:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the copy application.
F:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the fax application.
P:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed by the printer application.
L:PrtPGS/Ppr Type
8 466
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by paper type the number pages printed from within the document
server mode window at the operation panel.
8 46x 1 Normal
8 46x 2 Recycled
8 46x 3 Special
8 46x 4 Thick
8 46x 5 Normal (Back)
8 46x 6 Thick (Back)
8 46x 7 OHP
8 46x 8 Other
8 471
PrtPGS/Mag
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
373
Counts are done for magnification adjusted for pages, not only on the operation panel but performed
remotely with an external network application capable of performing magnification adjustment as
well.
Magnification adjustments done with printer drivers with PC applications such as Excel are also
counted.
Magnification adjustments done for adjustments after they have been stored on the document server
are not counted.
Magnification adjustments performed automatically during Auto Reduce/Enlarge copying are
counted.
The magnification rates of blank cover sheets, slip sheets, etc. are automatically assigned a rate of
100%.
8 481
T:PrtPGS/TonSave
*CTL
8 484
P:PrtPGS/TonSave
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages printed with the Toner Save feature switched on.
Note: These SPs return the same results as this SP is limited to the Print application.
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 491
T:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 492
C:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 493
F:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 496
L:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 497
O:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 49x 1 B/W
8 49x 2 Single Color
374
System SP8-xxx
T:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 504
P:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 057
O:PrtPGS/Col Mode
*CTL
8 50x 1 B/W
8 50x 2 Mono Color
8 50x 3 Full Color
8 50x 4 Single Color
8 50x 5 Two Color
8 511
8 514
T:PrtPGS/Emul
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.
P:PrtPGS/Emul
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by printer emulation mode the total number of pages printed.
375
8 514 1
RPCS
8 514 2
RPDL
8 514 3
PS3
8 514 4
R98
8 514 5
R16
8 514 6
GL/GL2
8 514 7
R55
8 514 8
RTIFF
8 514 9
8 514 10
PCL5e/5c
8 514 11
PCL XL
8 514 12
IPDL-C
8 514 13
BM-Links
8 514 14
Other
8 514 15
IPDS
Japan Only
SP8 511 and SP8 514 return the same results as they are both limited to the Print application.
Print jobs output to the document server are not counted.
8 521
T:PrtPGS/FIN
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Copy
application.
F:PrtPGS/FIN
8 523
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by all applications.
C:PrtPGS/FIN
8 522
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Fax
application.
NOTE: Print finishing options for received faxes are currently not available.
376
System SP8-xxx
P:PrtPGS/FIN
8 524
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Scanner
application.
L:PrtPGS/FIN
8 526
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed by the Print
application.
S:PrtPGS/FIN
8 525
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count by finishing mode the total number of pages printed from within the
document server mode window at the operation panel.
8 52x 1 Sort
8 52x 2 Stack
8 52x 3 Staple
8 52x 4 Booklet
8 52x 5 Z-Fold
8 52x 6 Punch
8 52x 7 Other
8 52x 8 Inside-Fold
8 52x 9 Three-IN-Fold
8 52x 10 Three-OUT-Fold
8 52x 11 Four-Fold
8 52x 12 KANNON-Fold
8 52x 13 Perfect-Bind
8 52x 14 Ring-Bind
If stapling is selected for finishing and the stack is too large for stapling, the unstapled pages are still
counted.
The counts for staple finishing are based on output to the staple tray, so jam recoveries are counted.
377
8 531
Staples
*CTL
T:Counter
8 581
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999 / 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output broken down by color output, regardless of the
application used. In addition to being displayed in the SMC Report, these counters are
also displayed in the User Tools display on the copy machine.
8 581 1 Total
8 581 2 Total: Full Color
8 581 3 B&W/Single Color
8 581 4 Development: CMY
8 581 5 Development: K
8 581 6 Copy: Color
8 581 7 Copy: B/W
8 581 8 Print: Color
8 581 9 Print: B/W
8 581 10 Total: Color
8 581 11 Total: B/W
8 581 12 Full Color: A3
8 581 13 Full Color: B4 JIS or Smaller
8 581 14 Full Color Print
8 581 15 Mono Color Print
8 581 16 Full Color GPC
8 581 17 Twin Colour Mode Print
8 581 18 Full Colour Print (Twin)
8 581 19 Mono Colour Print (Twin)
8 581 20 Full Colour Total (CV)
378
System SP8-xxx
C:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the copy application broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
F:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the fax application broken down by color output.
8 583 1 B/W
8 583 2 Single Color
8 584
P:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the print application broken down by color output.
8 584 1 B/W
8 584 2 Mono Color
8 584 3 Full Color
8 584 4 Single Color
8 584 5 Two Color
8 586
L:Counter
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total output of the local storage broken down by color output.
8 582 1 B/W
8 582 2 Single Color
379
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the totals for A3/DLT paper use, number of duplex pages printed, and
the number of staples used. These totals are for Other (O:) applications only.
8 591 1 A3/DLT
8 591 2 Duplex
Coverage Counter
8 601
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the total coverage for each color and the total printout pages for each
printing mode.
8 601 1 B/W
8 601 2 Color
8 601 11 B/W Printing Pages
8 601 12 Color Printing Pages
8 601 21 Coverage Counter 1
8 601 22 Coverage Counter 2
8 601 23 Coverage Counter 3
8 617
*CTL
These SPs count the total printout pages for each SDK applicaion.
8 617 1 SDK-1
8 617 2 SDK-2
8 617 3 SDK-3
8 617 4 SDK-4
8 617 5 SDK-5
8 617 6 SDK-6
380
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
System SP8-xxx
8 631
8 633
T:FAX TX PGS
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
F:FAX TX PGS
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to a telephone number.
8 63x 1 B/W
8 63x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8631 and SP8633 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
Polling transmissions are counted but polling RX are not.
Relay, memory, and confidential mailbox transmissions and are counted for each destination.
T:IFAX TX PGS
8 641
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by fax to as fax images using
I-Fax.
F:IFAX TX PGS
8 643
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the number of pages sent by Fax as fax images using
I-Fax.
8 64x 1 B/W
8 64x 2 Color
If a document has color and black-and-white pages mixed, the pages are counted separately as B/
W or Color.
At the present time, this feature is provided for the Fax application only so SP8641 and SP8643 are
the same.
The counts include error pages.
If a document is sent to more than one destination with a Group transmission, the count is done for
each destination.
381
8 655
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for both
the Scan and document server applications.
S:S-to-Email PGS
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages attached to an e-mail for the
Scan application only.
8 65x 1 B/W
8 65x 2 Color
The count for B/W and Color pages is done after the document is stored on the HDD. If the job is
cancelled before it is stored, the pages are not counted.
If Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to 5 addresses, the count is 10 (the pages are
sent to the same SMTP server together).
If Scan-to-PC is used to send a 10-page document to 5 folders, the count is 50 (the document is sent
to each destination of the SMB/FTP server).
Due to restrictions on some devices, if Scan-to-Email is used to send a 10-page document to a large
number of destinations, the count may be divided and counted separately. For example, if a 10-page
document is sent to 200 addresses, the count is 10 for the first 100 destinations and the count is also
10 for the second 100 destinations, for a total of 20.).
T:Deliv PGS/Svr
8 661
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by the Scan application.
8 66x 1 B/W
8 66x 2 Color
382
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a Scan Router server
by both Scan and LS applications.
S:Deliv PGS/Svr
8 665
*CTL
System SP8-xxx
The B/W and Color counts are done after the document is stored on the HDD of the Scan Router
server.
If the job is canceled before storage on the Scan Router server finishes, the counts are not done.
The count is executed even if regardless of confirmation of the arrival at the Scan Router server.
T:Deliv PGS/PC
8 671
*CTL
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent to a folder on a PC (Scanto-PC) with the Scan and LS applications.
S:Deliv PGS/PC
8 675
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count by color mode the total number of pages sent with Scan-to-PC with the
Scan application.
8 67x 1 B/W
8 67x 2 Color
8 681
T:PCFAX TXPGS
*CTL
8 683
F:PCFAX TXPGS
*CTL
This counts pages sent from a PC using a PC fax application, from the PC through the copier to the
destination.
When sending the same message to more than one place using broadcasting, the pages are only
counted once. (For example, a 10-page fax is sent to location A and location B. The counter goes
up by 10, not 20.)
8 691
T:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 692
C:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 693
F:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 694
P:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 695
S:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
8 696
L:TX PGS/LS
*CTL
383
Print jobs done with Web Image Monitor and Desk Top Binder are added to the count.
If several documents are merged for sending, the number of pages stored are counted for the
application that stored them.
When several documents are sent by a Fax broadcast, the F: count is done for the number of pages
sent to each destination.
TX PGS/Port
8 701
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages sent by the physical port used to send them. For
example, if a 3-page original is sent to 4 destinations via ISDN G4, the count for ISDN
(G3, G4) is 12.
8 701 1 PSTN-1
8 701 2 PSTN-2
8 701 3 PSTN-3
8 701 4 ISDN (G3,G4)
8 701 5 Network
8 711
8 715
T:Scan PGS/Comp
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
S:Scan PGS/Comp
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages sent by each compression mode.
8 715 1 JPEG/JPEG2000
8 715 2 TIFF(Multi/Single)
8 715 3 PDF
8 715 4 Other
8 715 5 PDF/Comp
8 721
8 725
T:Deliv PGS/WSD
*CTL
S: Dvliv PGS/WSD
*CTL
These SPs count the number of pages scanned by each scanner mode.
x 1 B/W
384
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
System SP8-xxx
x 2 Color
8 731
8 735
8 741
T:Scan PGS/Media
*CTL
S:Scan PGS/Media
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages scanned and saved in a meia by each scanner
mode.
x 1 B/W
x 2 Color
RX PGS/Port
*CTL
3
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the number of pages received by the physical port used to receive them.
8 741 1 PSTN-1
8 741 2 PSTN-2
8 741 3 PSTN-3
8 741 4 ISDN (G3,G4)
8 741 5 Network
Dev Counter
8 771
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the frequency of use (number of rotations of the development rollers)
for black and other color toners.
8 771 1 Total
8 771 2 K
8 771 3 Y
8 771 4 M
8 771 5 C
385
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
8 781 1 Toner: BK
8 781 2 Toner: Y
8 781 3 Toner: M
8 781 4 Toner: C
8 791
LS Memory Remain
*CTL
Toner Remain
8 801
*CTL
[0 to 100/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the percent of toner remaining for each color. This SP allows the user
to check the toner supply at any time.
Note: This precise method of measuring remaining toner supply (1% steps) is better than
other machines in the market that can only measure in increments of 10 (10% steps).
8 801 1 K
8 801 2 Y
8 801 3 M
8 801 4 C
Coverage Count: 0-10%
8 851
386
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 0% to 10%.
8 851 11 0 to 2%: BK
8 851 31 5 to 7%: BK
8 851 12 0 to 2%: Y
8 851 32 5 to 7%: Y
8 851 13 0 to 2%: M
8 851 33 5 to 7%: M
8 851 14 0 to 2%: C
8 851 34 5 to 7%: C
System SP8-xxx
8 851 21 3 to 4%: BK
8 851 41 8 to 10%: BK
8 851 22 3 to 4%: Y
8 851 42 8 to 10%: Y
8 851 23 3 to 4%: M
8 851 43 8 to 10%: M
8 851 24 3 to 4%: C
8 851 44 8 to 10%: C
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 11% to 20%.
8 861 1 BK
8 861 2 Y
8 861 3 M
8 861 4 C
Coverage Count: 21-30%
8 871
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is from 21% to 30%.
8 871 1 BK
8 871 2 Y
8 871 3 M
8 871 4 C
Coverage Count: 31%8 881
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the number of scanned sheets on which the coverage of each color
is 31% or higher.
8 881 1 BK
8 881 2 Y
8 881 3 M
8 881 4 C
387
8 891
Page/Toner Bottle
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining current toner for each color.
8 891 1 BK
8 891 2 Y
8 891 3 M
8 891 4 C
8 901
Page/Toner_prev1
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining previous toner for each color.
8 901 1 BK
8 901 2 Y
8 901 3 M
8 901 4 C
8 911
Page/Toner_prev2
*ENG
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs display the amount of the remaining 2nd previous toner for each color.
8 911 1 BK
8 911 2 Y
8 911 3 M
8 911 4 C
8 921
388
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
System SP8-xxx
8 921 1 BK (%)
8 921 2 Y (%)
8 921 3 M (%)
8 921 4 C (%)
8 921 11 Coverage /P: Bk
8 921 12 Coverage /P: Y
*CTL
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
These SPs count the amount of time the machine spends in each operation mode. These
SPs are useful for customers who need to investigate machine operation for
improvement in their compliance with ISO Standards.
8 941 6 SC
8 941 7 PrtJam
8 941 8 OrgJam
389
8 951
AddBook Register
*CTL
These SPs count the number of events when the machine manages data registration.
8 951 4 Group
8 951 6 F-Code
8 999
390
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
[0 to 9999999/ 0 / 1]
Displays the total coverage and total printout number for each color.
System SP8-xxx
8 999 1 Total
8 999 2 Copy: Full Color
8 999 3 Copy: BW
8 999 4 Copy: Single Color
8 999 5 Copy: Two Color
8 999 6 Printer Full Color
8 999 7 Printer BW
391
Bit No.
Result
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
0 or 1
Copier
5803
Description
Not set
No paper
Paper remaining
No paper
Paper remaining
Upper limit
Upper limit
392
Reading
Paper remaining
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper full
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Set
Not set
Toner end
Toner remaining
Toner end
Toner remaining
Toner end
Toner remaining
Toner end
Toner remaining
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Closed
Open
Closed
Open
393
394
Set
Not set
Not full
Full
Not new
New
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Not used
Not used
Not contact
Contact
Not contact
Contact
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
Normal
Lock
SC detected
No SC
SC detected
No SC
SC detected
No SC
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
New
Not new
Actuator not
detected
Actuator detected
Not contact
Contact
Closed
Open
(LD5V ON)
(LD5V OFF)
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
Set
Not set
Not HP
HP
Open
Closed
Full
Nearly full
Near end
Almost empty
Switch Location
Europe/Asia
4 (bit0)
3 (bit1)
2 (bit2)
A3 SEF*1
(A3 SEF)
B4 SEF*2
(B4 SEF)
A4 SEF
A4 SEF
B5 SEF
B5 SEF
A4 LEF*3
(A4 LEF)
B5 LEF*4
(B5 LEF)
A5 LEF
A5 LEF
*1: The machine detects either 11" x 17" SEF or A3 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-003.
*2: The machine detects either 8.5" x 14" SEF or B4 SEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-004.
*3: The machine detects either 11" x 81/2" LEF or A4 LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-002.
*4: The machine detects either B5 LEF or 10.5" x 7.25" LEF, depending on the setting of SP 5-181-005.
ADF (D541)
6007
396
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
6007 16 Lift Up
6138
6138 1
6138 2
6138 3
6138 4
6138 5
6138 6
Description
Interference Escape Sensor
(Stapler Safety Sensor)
Staple Moving HP Sensor
(Staple Unit HP Sensor)
Stuck Relay1 Release HP Sensor (Stopper
S HP Sensor)
Exit Junction Gate HP Sensor
(Stack Feed Out HP Sensor)
Jogger HP Sensor
(Jogger Fence HP Sensor)
Staple Tray Paper Sensor
(Staple Tray Paper Sensor)
Reading
0
Not interfered
Interfered
Home position
Home position
Home position
Home position
Paper detected
397
6138
6138 7
Description
Rear Edge Fence HP Sensor
(Paper Stack Stopper HP Sensor)
6138 9
6138 10
6138 11
6138 12
6138 13
6138 14
6138 15
6138 16
6138 21
398
Entrance Sensor
(Finisher Entrance Sensor)
Shift Exit Sensor
(Shift Tray Exit Sensor)
Reading
0
Home position
Paper detected
Home position
Full
Not full
Not full
Full
Home position
Paper detected
Home position
Paper detected
Full
Nor full
Home position
Paper detected
Paper detected
6138
6138 22
Description
Proof Exit Sensor
(Proof Tray Exit Sensor)
Door SW
(Front Door Switch)
Reading
0
Paper detected
Home position
Not full
Full
Open
Close
Close
Open
Encoder
Home position
Encoder
Staple remaining
Staple detected
Home position
Home position
Home position
Home position
6138 35
6138 36
6138 37
6138 38
Encoder
Not full
Full
Paper detected
399
6139
Bit
Description
6139 2
6139 3
6139 4
6139 5
6139 14
6139 15
400
Paper Sensor
(Stack Height Sensor)
Tray Lower Sensor
(Lower Tray Lower Limit Sensor)
Proof Full Sensor
(Paper Limit Sensor)
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Home position
Home position
Home position
Paper detected
Home position
Staple detected
Staple detected
Home position
Home position
Output tray
detected
Lower limit
Not full
Full
6145
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Home position
Home position
Paper detected
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
Paper detected
HP
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
Not HP
HP
Not HP
Not full
Full
6145 3
6145 4
6150
Description
Reading
0
Paper detected
Paper detected
Set
Not set
Closed
Open
401
Closed
Open
Paper detected
6152
Description
Reading
0
Set
Not Set
6154
Description
Reading
0
Set
Not Set
Paper detected
One or Two-Tray PFU (D387/D537)/ LCIT 2000 (D538)/ LCIT 1200 (D539)
6160
Description
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Paper detected
Closed
Open
402
Reading
Closed
Open
Closed
Open
Display
Description
403
404
5804 83
5804 89
Duplex Reverse
M:CCW:MiddleSpeed
5804 90
Middle Speed
Low Speed
Polygon Motor: LL
Polygon Motor: L
Polygon Motor: HH
IH Coil Fan
405
5804 122
Development Clutch-K
Development Clutch-M
Development Clutch-C
Development Clutch-Y
IH Inverter Fan
TD Sensor:Bk
TD Sensor: M
TD Sensor: C
TD Sensor: Y
ID Sensor: Front
ID Sensor: Center
ID Sensor: Rear
ID Sensor: M
ID Sensor: C
ID Sensor: Y
407
408
5804 231
PP: ChargeDC: K
5804 232
PP: ChargeDC: M
5804 233
PP: ChargeDC: C
5804 234
PP: ChargeDC: Y
5804 237
PP:Charge AC:K:HighSpeed
5804 238
PP:Charge AC:K:MiddleSpeed
5804 239
5804 244
PP:Charge AC:M:HighSpeed
5804 245
PP:Charge AC:M:MiddleSpeed
5804 246
5804 251
PP:Charge AC:C:HighSpeed
5804 252
PP:Charge AC:C:MiddleSpeed
5804 253
ARDF (D541)
6008
Display
Description
Pick-up Solenoid
6008 12 Stamp
Stamp Solenoid
Display
Description
409
Jogger Motor
410
Display
Description
Stapler Motor
Stapler Hammer
Display
Description
Transport Motor
Stapler Motor
411
Display
Bridge/Left: Feed Motor: Current
Selection
Description
Bridge: Feed Motor: Current switching signal
6151 7
Display
Description
-
Display
Description
-
One or Two-Tray PFU (D387/D537)/ LCIT 2000 (D538)/ LCIT 1200 (D539)
6161
Display
412
Description
Feed Motor:242mm/s
(D537/ D538)
413
Bit Switch
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
DFU
bit 3
No I/O Timeout
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: The MFP I/O Timeout setting will have no effect. I/O Timeouts will never occur.
bit 4
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: Print jobs will be saved to an SD Card in the GW SD slot (* "Card Save
Function" in the System Maintenance Reference of the Field Service Manual).
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: The machine prints all RPCS and PCL jobs with a border on the edges of the
printable area.
1001
414
Bit Switch
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
Shift Collate
Normal Collate
A collation type (shift or normal) will be applied to all jobs that do not already have a
Collate Type configured.
0: Enable
1: Disable
1001
bit 4
DFU
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
DFU
Bit Switch
415
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
0: Disable
1: Enable
Enable: Uses the same left margin as older HP models such as HP4000/HP8000.
In other words, the left margin defined in the job (usually "<ESC>*r0A") will be changed
to "<ESC>*r1A"
1001
bit 3
DFU
bit 4
DFU
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
DFU
Bit Switch
416
Bit Switch
Disable
Enable
If enabled, users will be able to configure a Collate Type, Staple Type, and Punch Type
from the operation panel. The available types will depend on the device and configured
options.
After enabling the function, the settings will appear under:
DFU
bit 2
DFU
bit 3
[PS] PS Criteria
Pattern3
Pattern1
Disable
(100)
Enable (1000)
Enable: Changes the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the HDD via Job
Type settings to 1000. The default is 100.
bit 5
Face-up output
Disable
Enable
Enable: All print jobs will be output face-up in the destination tray.
1001
bit 6
DFU
bit 7
DFU
Bit Switch
Bit Switch
417
1001
Bit Switch
bit 0
DFU
bit 1
DFU
bit 2
DFU
bit 3
Disable
Enable
Enable: BW jobs submitted without a user code will be printed even if usercode
authentication is enabled.
Color jobs will not be printed without a valid user code.
bit 4
DFU
bit 5
DFU
bit 6
Enable
Disable
Enable
Disable
[Clear Setting]
Initialize Printer System
Initializes settings in the "System" menu of the user mode.
418
[Print Summary]
Print Summary
Prints the service summary sheet (a summary of all the controller settings).
1005
1005 1
1006
[Display Version]
Disp. Version
Displays the version of the controller firmware.
[Sample/Locked Print]
*CTL
0: Linked, 1: On
Enables and disables the document server. When you select "0," the document server is
1006 1 enabled or disabled in accordance with Copy Service Mode SP5-967. When you select
"1," the document server is enabled regardless of Copy Service Mode SP5-967.
[Data Recall]
1101
Recalls a set of gamma settings. This can be either a) the factory setting, b) the previous
setting, or c) the current setting.
1101 1 Factory
1101 2 Previous
1101 3 Current
*CTL
1101 4 ACC
1102
1102 1
1103
[Resolution Setting]
Selects the printing mode (resolution) for the printer gamma adjustment.
2400x600 Photo, 1800x600 Photo, 600 x 600 Photo, 2400x600 Text, 1800x600, Text,
600x600 Text
[Test Page]
Prints the test page to check the color balance before and after the gamma adjustment.
1104
[Gamma Adjustment]
Adjusts the printer gamma for the mode selected in the "Mode Selection" menu.
419
*CTL
[0 to 30 / 15 / 1/step ]
Stores the print gamma adjusted with the "Gamma Adj." menu item as the current setting.
Before the machine stores the new "current setting", it moves the data currently stored as the
"current setting" to the "previous setting" memory storage location.
1106
[Toner Limit]
Adjusts the maximum toner amount for image development.
420
*CTL
Scanner SP Mode
Scanner SP Mode
SP1-xxx (System and Others)
1004
[Compression Type]
Selects the compression type for binary picture processing.
*CTL
[1 to 3 / 1 / 1/step ]
1: MH, 2: MR, 3: MMR
[Erase margin]
1005
1009
*CTL
*CTL
[0 to 5 / 0 / 1 mm/step ]
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: enable, 1: disable
1010
[0 or 1 / 0 / - ]
0: Display, 1: No display
Selects the compression ratio for grayscale processing mode (JPEG) for the three settings that
can be selected at the operation panel.
421
[5 to 95 / 40 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 50 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 30 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 60 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
Selects the compression ratio for clearlight PDF for the two settings that can be selected at
the operation panel.
422
*CTL
*CTL
[5 to 95 / 25 / 1 /step ]
[5 to 95 / 20 / 1 /step ]
Pattern
No.
Pattern
None
11
12
13
14
Triming Area
16
423
424
17
Band (Horizontal)
18
Band (Vertical)
19
20
21
10
23